Professional Documents
Culture Documents
MM
MM
MM
Editors
Debasish Basu | P.K. Dalal | Y.P.S. Balhara
Editors
Debasish Basu
P.K. Dalal
Y.P.S. Balhara
Published by
Indian Psychiatric Society
INDIA
Clinical Practice Guidelines on
Newer and Emerging Addictive Disorders in India
Editors:
Debasish Basu
P.K. Dalal
Y.P.S. Balhara
First Edition: January, 2016
Price : Rs.500/-
Rs.100/- for IPS Members
Editorial Office:
Dr. Debasish Basu
Professor of Psychiatry, Drug De-addiction & Treatment Centre,
Department of Psychiatry,
Postgraduate Institute of Medical Education & Research,
Chandigarh-160012, India.
Email: db_sm2002@yahoo.com
Prepared by:
Indian Psychiatric Society
Speciality Section on Substance Use Disorders
For copies:
Dr. Gautam Saha
Chair, IPS Publication Committee
Printed at:
Repro Digital Pvt. Ltd.
192B S.P. Mukherjee Road, Kolkata 700026
ii
INDIAN PSYCHIATRIC SOCIETY
OFFICE BEARERS AND EXECUTIVE COUNCIL MEMBERS (2015-16)
President : Dr. Vidyadhar Watve
Vice-President : Dr. G. Prasad Rao
General Secretary : Dr. N. N. Raju
Hon. Treasurer : Dr. Vinay Kumar
Hon. Editor : Dr. T.S.S. Rao
EXECUTIVE COUNCIL
Immediate Past President : Dr. T. V. Asokan
Immediate Past Secretary : Dr. Asim Kumar Mallick
Zonal Representatives
Central Zone : Dr. Sarvesh Chandra, Dr. Jai Prakash Narayan
East Zone : Dr. C L Narayan, Dr. Hiranya Goswami
West Zone : Dr. D M Dhavle, Dr. Mukesh Jagiwala
North Zone : Dr. R K Solanki, Dr. Chander Mohan
South Zone : Dr. A J John, Dr. Abhay Matkar
AUTHORS
Atul Ambekar
Additional Professor
National Drug Dependence Treatment Centre
Department of Psychiatry
All India Institute of Medical Sciences (AIIMS), New Delhi 110029
atul.ambekar@gmail.com
Aniruddha Basu
Senior Resident and DM Addiction Psychiatry Candidate
Drug De-addiction & Treatment Centre
Department of Psychiatry
Postgraduate Institute of Medical Education & Research (PGIMER)
Chandigarh 160012
draniruddhabasu@gmail.com
Debasish Basu
Professor of Psychiatry
Drug De-addiction & Treatment Centre
Department of Psychiatry
Postgraduate Institute of Medical Education & Research (PGIMER)
Chandigarh 160012
db_sm2002@yahoo.com
Kaustav Chakraborty
Assistant Professor
Department of Psychiatry
College of Medicine and J.N.M. Hospital, Kalyani
West Bengal University of Health Sciences, West Bengal
drkaustav2003@yahoo.co.in
iv
Prabhat Chand
Additional Professor of Psychiatry
Centre for Addiction Medicine
Department of Psychiatry
National Institute of Mental Health and Neuro Sciences (NIMHANS),
Bangalore 560029
prabhatkumarchand@gmail.com
P.K. Dalal
Professor and Head
Department of Psychiatry
King George's Medical University
Lucknow 226003
docpkdalal@gmail.com
Abhishek Ghosh
Senior Resident and DM Addiction Psychiatry Candidate
Drug De-addiction & Treatment Centre
Department of Psychiatry
Postgraduate Institute of Medical Education & Research (PGIMER)
Chandigarh 160012
ghoshabhishek12@gmail.com
Shrigopal Goyal
Assistant Professor
Shiv Kishan Midaram Dammani Government Institute of Mental Health,
Allied & Neuro Sciences (DIMHANS),
Department of Psychiatry & De-addiction, PBM Hospital
S.P. Medical College and Associated Groups Hospitals, Bikaner (Rajasthan)
shrigopalgoyal@gmail.com
Arun Kandasamy
Assistant Professor of Psychiatry
Centre for Addiction Medicine
Department of Psychiatry
National Institute of Mental Health and Neuro Sciences (NIMHANS)
Bangalore 560029
arunnimhans05@gmail.com
Ananya Mahapatra
Senior Resident
National Drug Dependence Treatment Centre
Department of Psychiatry
All India Institute of Medical Sciences (AIIMS)
New Delhi 110029
nnyaa09@gmail.com
v
Surendra K. Mattoo
Professor Psychiatry
Drug De-addiction & Treatment Centre
Department of Psychiatry
Postgraduate Institute of Medical Education & Research (PGIMER)
Chandigarh 160012
skmattoo@ymail.com
Pratima Murthy
Professor of Psychiatry
Centre for Addiction Medicine
Department of Psychiatry
National Institute of Mental Health and Neuro Sciences (NIMHANS)
Bangalore 560029
pratimamurthy@gmail.com
Subodh B.N.
Associate Professor of Psychiatry
Drug De-addiction & Treatment Centre
Department of Psychiatry
Postgraduate Institute of Medical Education & Research (PGIMER)
Chandigarh 160012
drsubodhbn2002@gmail.com
Rajarshi Neogi
Assistant Professor
Institute of Psychiatry
Institute of Postgraduate Medical Education & Research and
SSKM Hospital
Kolkata 700020
neogi123@gmail.com
Sathya Prakash
Senior Resident
National Drug Dependence Treatment Centre
Department of Psychiatry
All India Institute of Medical Sciences (AIIMS)
New Delhi 110029
dr.sathyaprakashtbts@gmail.com
Siddharth Sarkar
Assistant Professor
National Drug Dependence Treatment Centre
Department of Psychiatry
All India Institute of Medical Sciences (AIIMS)
New Delhi 110029
sidsarkar22@gmail.com
vi
Lekhansh Shukla
Senior Resident and DM Addiction Psychiatry Candidate
Centre for Addiction Medicine
Department of Psychiatry
National Institute of Mental Health and Neuro Sciences (NIMHANS)
Bangalore 560029
drlekhansh@gmail.com
vii
PREFACE
It gives me great pleasure to write the Preface of the book
“Clinical Practice Guidelines on Newer and Emerging Addictive
Disorders in India”, published by the Indian Psychiatric Society.
In 2014, the IPS Specialty Section on Substance Use Disorders
had brought out an entirely new set of comprehensive Clinical
Practice Guidelines (CPGs) on the assessment and management
of common substance use disorders. This is a rich and updated
source of knowledge and skills, comprehensive in its width as well as depth of
coverage. However, a need was felt to produce an evidence-based synopsis of the
previous exhaustive reference book, targeted directly for the practitioners and
students, for an easy checking and implementation. This brief “Synopsis” was
published in 2015.
Moving on from there, this current set of CPGs focuses on four newer and emerging
areas of direct concern to the Indian scenario: New Psychoactive Substances,
emerging drugs in the Indian context, a more in-depth focus on dual disorders, and
last but not the least, the new group of addictive disorders called “Behavioural
Addictions.” All these are important for Indian psychiatrists as well as medical
specialists likely to come across addictive disorders more often than ever. Despite
the lack of rigorous evidence in some of these areas, the eminent authors of this book
have done their best by highlighting the emergent gravity of the problems, collating
the updated evidence to the extent possible, and making recommendations for
practice concordant with the current state of knowledge and expertise.
I congratulate the IPS Specialty Section on Substance Use Disorders on this
ambitious task. I also thank the Publication Committee of IPS for publishing this
useful book with great care. I wish that IPS should come up with more such volumes
on various important psychiatric topics in future, setting a healthy and helpful
tradition.
Dr. Vidyadhar Watve
President, Indian Psychiatric Society
January, 2016
viii
FOREWORD
It is a matter of pleasure to know that Indian Psychiatric Society is
bringing out yet another useful book on “Clinical Practice
Guidelines on Newer and Emerging Addictive Disorders in India”.
Drug addiction is an important psychosocial problem from time
immemorial and is found amongst all cultures and civilizations
across the world throughout history. Drug addiction causes
immense human distress and unfortunately there is no part of the
world that is free from it. Millions of people all over the world are
leading very miserable and pathetic lives. The drug abuse is a complex phenomenon
with involvement of social, cultural, biological, geographical, historical and economic
aspects.
All of us know that there are innumerable varieties of drugs which are abused but most
commonly used include alcohol, nicotine, cannabis, opioids, inhalants, and
benzodiazepines. Earlier, The IPS Specialty Section on Substance Use Disorders brought
out Clinical Practice Guidelines (CPGs) on the assessment and management of these
common substance use disorders in two volumes. The Comprehensive handbook was
released at the Annual National Conference of the IPS (ANCIPS) in 2014, and the
Synopsis of the same was released at ANCIPS 2015.
Of late there have been several developments in this area. Newer psychoactive
substances have been emerging on the Indian scene, some of them old but used more
often in India lately (like cocaine), and others are so new that they are not even
mentioned in the legal statutory schedules of controlled drugs. Patients with co-
occurring psychiatric disorders and drug addictions are seen and recognized more
frequently. Finally, a newly designated group of behavioural problems, termed as
'behavioural addictions', is making the mark, most notable of them being Pathological
Gambling and Pathological Internet Use (or Internet addiction), but there are many
others although they are more controversial at present. It is difficult to treat these
conditions, firstly because these are newer entities and challenges in the Indian scenario
and secondly because strong evidence base is often lacking.
Given this important but difficult development, the IPS Specialty Section on Substance
Use Disorders have again risen to the challenge and have produced a CPG book, written
by experts in the field, to bring these issues to the forefront.
Indian Psychiatric Society is happy to involve in bringing out the latest developments in
the field of addictions and I am sure the handbook will be very useful to experienced
clinicians, young postgraduates and serious researchers. I thank Dr. P.K. Dalal, Dr.
Debasish Basu, Dr. Gautam Saha and Dr. Sandeep Shah in addition to all authors for
completing such a daunting task. Of course such a dream would not have been reality but
for the support extended by Dr. Vidyadhar Watve and the EC members.
Long live IPS!
Dr. N.N. Raju
Indian Psychiatric Society
ix
FROM THE DESK OF IPS PUBLICATION COMMITTEE
Dear Member,
The landscape of medical education has
changed rapidly in recent years and will
continue to do so into the future. In addition,
the composition of our continuing medical
education will continue to change, with
increasing numbers and shares of the
population coming from communities of color. In this publication we use
experimental clinical projection techniques to capture the impact of these changes
on the size and ethnic composition of medical education to the members of each
state, each zone, and nationally the Indian Psychiatric Society as a whole.
A number of individuals were instrumental in the preparation of this publication.
First and foremost among them were authors who played critical roles at several
steps along the way to publication. Special thanks to Dr. P.K. Dalal and Dr. Debasish
Basu who designed and produced the layout and graphics; who edited the text and
helped proof the data; who built the interactive tool providing readers with
customizable data and graphics for our Society; and we also like to design in the web
environment for the online version of the publication.
We would also like to thank those individuals who gave of their time and expertise in
serving on the technicalities over the past few months. Finally, our thanks go to all
the senior members for their generous support of the preparation, publication, and
dissemination of this edition.
IPS Publication Committee prepares the white paper that formed the foundation of
the methodology review component of this work. In short, we hope the future is a
brighter one than what we experience here – for all members.
All the authors earn our sincere gratitude for their efforts on this publication.
We thank our President Dr. Vidyadhar Watve, Vice-President Dr. G. Prasad Rao,
Hony General Secretary Dr. N.N. Raju, Hony Treasurer Dr. Vinay Kumar, Hony
Editor Dr. T.S.S. Rao, and grateful to all Council Members for helping and
cooperating us to run the Publication Committee at ease.
Long live I.P.S.
x
INDIAN PSYCHIATRIC SOCIETY –
SPECIALTY SECTION ON SUBSTANCE USE DISORDERS (IPS-SS-SUD)
CONTENTS
Title Author Page No.
Front Matter i-x
Section A: General Overview
Clinical practice guidelines on newer Debasish Basu, PK Dalal, 5
and emerging addictive disorders: YPS Balhara
Overview of IPS guidelines 2016
Addiction – a hydra-headed problem Pratima Murthy 15
Section B: Newer and Emerging Substances
New Psychoactive Substances: Debasish Basu, 27
An overview, with focus on synthetic Abhishek Ghosh
cannabinoids and cathinones
Cocaine Subodh BN, 51
Aniruddha Basu
Amphetamine-type Stimulants Atul Ambekar, 87
Shrigopal Goyal
“Club Drugs” Kaustav Chakraborty, 121
Rajarshi Neogi
Section C: Behavioural Addictions
Gambling disorder Abhishek Ghosh, Debasish Basu, 181
PK Dalal
Pathological Internet Use Prabhat Chand, Arun Kandasamy, 221
(“Internet Addiction”) Pratima Murthy
Other putative behavioural Arun Kandasamy, 237
addictions Lekhansh Shukla
Section D: Dual Diagnosis
Dual Diagnosis: Psychotic disorders YPS Balhara, Sathya Prakash, 263
Ananya Mahapatra, Siddharth Sarkar
Dual Diagnosis: Shubhmohan Singh, SK Mattoo 309
Non-psychotic disorders
xi
SECTION A :
GENERAL OVERVIEW
CLINICAL PRACTICE GUIDELINES ON
NEWER AND EMERGING ADDICTIVE DISORDERS:
OVERVIEW OF IPS GUIDELINES 2016
Debasish Basu
P.K. Dalal
Y.P.S. Balhara
On behalf of
Indian Psychiatric Society
Specialty Section on Substance Use Disorders
2016
Overview
BACKGROUND
Following the reconstitution of the Specialty Section on Substance Use Disorders of the
Indian Psychiatric Society (IPS-SS-SUD) in 2011, the members of the Specialty Section
strongly felt the need for formulating a set of evidence-based, methodologically sound
and updated Clinical Practice Guidelines (CPG) for the assessment and management of
the common substance use disorders in India. Following a long and rigorous process of
development, a book was finally released at the Inauguration Ceremony of the 66th
Annual National Conference of the Indian Psychiatric Society (ANCIPS) held in Pune in
January 2014. It was an official publication of the IPS, brought out by IPS-SS-SUD,
named “Clinical Practice Guidelines for the Assessment and Management of Substance
Use Disorders” (referred hereafter as the “CPG-SUD book”).1 The following areas were
covered in the CPG-SUD book of 2014: assessment of substance use disorders in
general; alcohol use disorders; opioid use disorders; cannabis use disorders; sedative-
hypnotic use disorders; tobacco use disorders; inhalant use disorders; and dual
diagnosis. It was a comprehensive book running into 531 pages, with a masterly
compendium of references and updated knowledge crystallized into practical
recommendations.
Later, however, it was felt that there was a need for a more concise, practice-oriented,
easy-to-follow “Synopsis” of the comprehensive CPG-SUD book as well, which would
be a set of compact, precise, yet evidence- and expertise-based guidelines. Again an
official publication of the IPS, the “Synopsis” book was released at the Inauguration
Ceremony of the 67th Annual National Conference of the Indian Psychiatric Society
(ANCIPS) held in Hyderabad in January 2015.2 Easy-to-carry in a pocketbook sized
format, and easy-to-use with clear tables, panels, boxes and algorithms, it was a perfect
supplementary companion of the comprehensive CPG-SUD book. It synthesized all the
practice-relevant information necessary for the assessment and management of
common substance use disorders and dual diagnosis. In order to maintain
comparability and consistency with the CPG-SUD book, it contained the same chapters
in the same order: assessment of substance use disorders in general; alcohol use
disorders; opioid use disorders; cannabis use disorders; sedative-hypnotic use
disorders; tobacco use disorders; inhalant use disorders; and dual diagnosis.
Since the publication of the CPG-SUD book in 2014 and the Synopsis book in 2015,
both have been well received by clinical practitioners, researchers, academicians, and
psychiatric students, i.e., by all the target groups these two books were meant for. They
have provided the clinicians with updated and evidence-based guidelines for
assessment and management of substance use disorders, and others with a
comprehensive compendium of updated knowledge that can be a rich resource for
academic purposes of teaching, learning, and research.
book. The CPG-SUD book was the culmination of intensive year-long efforts of a group
of dedicated psychiatrists working in the field of substance use disorders in various
reputed academic medical institutes of India. The development, refinement and
finalization of these Clinical Practice Guidelines (CPGs) was the result of an arduous,
long-drawn and rigorous process following a pre-defined iterative strategy involving
progressively widening circles of peer review.
The pre-defined strategy for the process of development, refinement and finalization of
these CPGs has been mentioned in details in the “Overview” chapter of the CPG-SUD
book.3 The process is recapitulated briefly here.
Although all the members of the IPS-SS-SUD were variably involved in the process of
development and/or refinement of the each of the CPGs, one senior author (a Faculty
Member of a teaching medical institute with special interest and expertise in addictive
disorders) was designated as the “Lead Author” for each of these CPGs. They co-opted
additional contributors, not below the rank of a Senior Resident in psychiatry and
working in the area of addictive disorders. These authors developed their respective
CPG assigned to them.
In the process of development, we were guided by: (a) an extensive review of the
relevant literature, including Indian data wherever available in published and
retrievable form; (b) pre-existing recent guidelines in this area; (c) an awareness of the
local needs and priorities whenever applicable (e.g., the need to focus on smokeless
tobacco use in India); (d) need to balance the rigor and extensiveness of data coverage
with the pragmatic considerations of condensing and filtering the data for practical use
by clinicians; (e) need to rate the category of evidence and the strength of
recommendations as per internationally accepted norms;4 and (f) the Appraisal of
Guidelines for Research and Evaluation II (AGREE-II) instrument.5 These (strength of
evidence and recommendations, and AGREE-II instrument, with degree of compliance
displayed by most of these CPGs) are mentioned in the Appendix, and have been
followed throughout all the CPGs.
The CPGs thus developed were finalized through an iterative process of progressively
widening circles of peer review. Ethical issues and potential conflicts of interest were
also taken care of, as mentioned explicitly in the “Overview” chapter of the CPG-SUD
book.3
The Organization of the Book Chapters and the CPGs
Following this overview chapter, the next chapter is called “Addiction – a hydra headed
problem.” Written by an eminent addiction psychiatrist who has been working in the
area for many decades, it is really an experiential overview that sets the tone for the rest
of the book, focusing on the essential roles and challenges of the psychiatrist in
addiction psychiatry, especially in view of newer addictions and dual diagnosis.
The next Section of the book starts with an overview of the “New Psychoactive
Substances (NPS)” and their relevance for the emerging Indian scenario. This chapter
defines and classifies all categories of NPS but focuses on only those not covered in later
chapters. It especially covers synthetic cannabinoids and synthetic cathinones
(especially mephedrone, colloquially known as “meow meow”, which has already
emerged as a major threat in several parts of India).
The following three chapters are on cocaine, amphetamine-type stimulants (ATS), and
“club drugs” respectively. Together with the NPS overview, these chapters cover the (a)
and (b) of the changes noted in the Indian substance use horizon as mentioned above. It
is to be noted that these are not watertight mutually exclusive subjects. Cocaine and
some older ATS drugs like amphetamines are not NPS because they are regulated under
the schedules of the International Conventions and the Indian Narcotic Drug and
Psychotropic Substances Act 1985. Club drugs comprise a loosely defined
heterogeneous group of substances that can include cocaine and ATS. Thus, these
chapters have been artificially carved out more out of practical necessities than for any
basic underlying principles, except for the fact that these do cover the newer and
emerging substances of use and their patterns of use in India.
The next Section focuses on the newer and again somewhat loosely defined entity
called “Behavioural Addictions”. The first chapter in this Section, Gambling Disorder, is
also the only one to have made the final mark by being included in the “Substance Use
and Related addictive Disorders” section of the Diagnostic and Statistical Manual, 5th
edition (DSM-5) of the American Psychiatric Association. Pathological Internet Use,
also popularly known as “Internet addiction” could not make the final mark in DSM-5 as
a definitive disorder but one sub-portion of it (Internet Gaming Disorder) has been
relegated to the last section of DSM-5 as “conditions that need further study”. This has
been covered in the next chapter in this book keeping in view its rising importance both
in the popular media as well in the clinical and scientific circles. The last chapter in this
section covers all those so-called behavioural addictions which are still best categorized
as “putative” but nevertheless has an emerging body of research backup and can be a
clinically encountered problem.
The final Section is on assessment and management of dual diagnosis disorders.
Although covered in a general manner in the previous two CPG books,1,2 the need was
felt to deliberate upon this area in a more comprehensive manner because of their
increasing prominence in clinical setups. One chapter in this Section focuses on dual
diagnosis psychotic disorders while the other focuses on non-psychotic disorders.
Each chapter begins with a clinically useful “Executive Summary” that summarizes the
key recommendations and issues. Individual “Key Recommendations” are mentioned
at the end of each major subsection of the chapters, occasionally also marking areas of
present uncertainty. These summary points and recommendations come with the
grading of evidence and strength as mentioned in the Appendix of this chapter.
everything under the sun related to SUDs. We had to necessarily prioritize the content
and coverage of the areas, and, in this process, some sections might have been missed.
Another important limitation has to be kept in mind while interpreting the
recommendations made in this book. Many of these subject areas are new and
emerging, and rigorous 'double-blind randomized controlled trials' – the cornerstone of
evidence-based medicine – are often absent, rare, or of small size or poor quality.
Hence, the evidence ratings in many areas are of a low grade. Accordingly, the
recommendations are necessarily of a “D” or “S” category, and many times no specific
recommendations can be made at this level of knowledge and experience. Perhaps the
situation may change by the time a later edition of this book is published. This statement
does not reduce the value of this book but rather puts in proper perspective.
With this statement of the scope, declarations and limitations as a 'disclaimer', we
would like to end by reiterating that if used for the correct purpose and in the correct
manner, we hope that these CPGs should prove useful to both their primary as well as
secondary readerships.
REFERENCES
1. Basu D, Dalal PK (eds). Clinical Practice Guidelines for the Assessment and
Management of Substance Use Disorders. Delhi: Indian Psychiatric Society, 2014.
2. Dalal PK, Basu D (eds). Synopsis of the Clinical Practice Guidelines on Substance Use
Disorders. Delhi: Indian Psychiatric Society, 2015.
3. Basu D, Dalal PK. Clinical practice guidelines for the assessment and management of
substance use disorders: overview of IPS guidelines 2014. In, Basu D, Dalal PK (eds).
Clinical Practice Guidelines for the Assessment and Management of Substance Use
Disorders. Delhi: Indian Psychiatric Society; 2014, pp. 1-12.
4. Shekelle PG, Woolf SH, Eccles M, Grimshaw J. Clinical guidelines: developing
guidelines. BMJ 1999; 318: 593–596.
5. Brouwers MC, Kho ME, Browman GP, Burgers JS, Cluzeau F, Feder G, et al. AGREE Next
Steps Consortium. AGREE II: advancing guideline development, reporting and
evaluation in health care. CMAJ 2010; 182: E839-E842.
6. Field MJ, Lohr KN (eds). Clinical Practice Guidelines: Directions of a new Program.
Committee to advise the Public Health Service on Clinical Practice Guidelines, Institute
of Medicine. Washington DC: National Academy Press; 1990.
APPENDICES
Appendix 1. AGREE-II instrument, and compliance of CPGs developed by IPS-SS-SUD
The methods for formulating the This guideline is based on the synthesis and
recommendations interpretation of available evidence obtained
from studies across the world, especially in light
of the Indian context, rating them on strength of
evidence and combining this strength with the
perceived importance and relevance in the
Indian context to finally arrive at specific key
recommendations as well as identifying current
areas of uncertainty where applicable.
The health benefits, side effects, and risks Yes
have been considered in formulating
the recommendations
There is an explicit link between the Yes. Further, it has been clearly pointed out
recommendations and the supporting where no specific recommendations can be
evidence made at this time because of lack of supporting
evidence of acceptable quality.
The potential resource implications of This issue has not been specifically addressed
applying the recommendations have been in these CPGs.
considered.
C o m p e t i n g i n t e r e s t s o f g u i d e l i n e All authors declared “No conflicts of interest.”
development group members have been
recorded and addressed.
Categories of evidence
Ia : evidence from meta-analysis of randomised controlled trials
Ib : evidence from at least one randomised controlled trial
IIa : evidence from at least one controlled study without randomisation
IIb : evidence from at least one other type of quasi-experimental study
III : evidence from non-experimental descriptive studies, such as comparative
studies, correlation studies and case-control studies
12 © Indian Psychiatric Society 2016
Overview
Pratima Murthy
On behalf of
Indian Psychiatric Society
Specialty Section on Substance Use Disorders
2016
Addiction
1. INTRODUCTION
The American Society of Addiction Medicine in 20111 redefined addiction as a chronic
brain disorder. An editorial close on the heels of this proclamation in the Lancet2,
cautioned that the over-medicalisation of addiction could have its downsides.
Whatever the position, there is general agreement that being addicted is really like
being in a maze, with confusing signals emitted both from within the individual (from
biological predisposition and temperament) as well as from external factors (family,
society and other aspects of the environment)3. An understanding of vulnerability, effect
of substances on the body and mind, effective medical and psychosocial interventions,
family support and follow-up support are all important for restitution and recovery.
Who can better balance the science and art of addiction management than the
psychiatrist!
2. ADDICTION - A COMPLEX HYDRA HEADED PROBLEM
During residency training in the 1980's, my tryst with addiction was predominantly
with alcohol dependence. We saw persons with alcohol dependence and treated them
with disulfiram and psycho-social interventions. We saw nicotine dependence, but did
precious little except giving half-hearted advice to quit smoking. A lot has changed in
the three subsequent decades. In fact, change has been the only constant in the area of
addiction and its management.
2.1 What has changed?
1. The nature of chemical addictions has changed- since the first case report of heroin
use in India in the 1970's, the problem of opiate use has been escalating
throughout the country, and both illicit and pharmaceutical opioids dominate the
landscape4. We are increasingly encountering sedative/hypnotic dependence,
particularly benzodiazepine dependence in clinical practice5. Many young people
are brought to treatment settings with inhalant misuse and dependence. Cannabis
use and cannabis related problems continue to be present. Clinics are starting to
see cocaine, LSD and stimulant abuse. The use of ketamine has been reported
nearly two decades ago6 and continues to be prevalent. Instances of diversion of
opioid substitution medications like buprenorphine, newer opioid drugs including
tramadol abuse7 and news reports of novel psychoactive substances like
mephedrone (colloquially known as “meow meow”)8 are increasing.
2. We have learnt that licit drugs like nicotine and alcohol are associated with greater
public health problems in comparison to illicit drugs whose supply is more
strongly controlled. There is now a national tobacco control programme and
tobacco cessation clinics and treatments are becoming more readily available in
hospitals and practice settings.
3. In the last two decades, the face of addiction has changed. The scenario has moved
beyond chemical addictions to various kinds of behavioural addictions. These
Addressing SUDs from a life stage perspective with assessment and treatment
approaches incorporating co-occurring disorders are necessary to successfully impact
overall health26.
Treatment of dual diagnosis [co-occurrence of a substance use disorder (SUD) in
patients with mental illness] poses several challenges for mental health professionals27.
In spite of the high association between substance use and psychiatric disorders, there is
a surprising paucity of studies related to treatment and outcome.
4. CHALLENGES BEFORE THE PSYCHIATRIST
With the definition of addiction broadening beyond the use of chemical substances to a
range of behaviours that also possess similar characteristics, research is moving from a
system that classifies addiction according to clinical symptoms to one more rooted in a
mechanistic understanding of the disease, with a greater role for genetic imaging and
cognitive science28.
Newer drug and behavioural addictions: Improving professional knowledge and
competencies
However, while treatment options have expanded quite a bit in the last few decades, the
generally established set of psychosocial and pharmacological approaches used for
substance addiction form the mainstay of treatment even for the newer addictions. The
current day psychiatrist is best advised to be well informed of the changing patterns of
addictions, special populations requiring specialised care, behavioural and other newer
addictions, co-morbidities and their management and the social and legal ramifications
of the newer addictions. Thus contemporary psychiatry will have to constantly adapt
itself to understanding the dynamic and hydra-headed problem of addiction in order to
provide effective management.
REFERENCES
1. American Society of Addiction Medicine. Definition of Addiction. 2011.
http://www.asam.org/pdf/Advocacy/PressReleases/20110815_DefofAddiction.PR.pdf
2. The Lancet. Addiction: a complex disorder. Editorial. The Lancet, 2011; 378:742.
3. Murthy P. Addiction: Is there light at the end of the tunnel? Indian Psychiatric Society
mid-term CME publication, September 2011.
4. Larance B, Ambekar A, Azim T, Murthy P, Panda S, Degenhardt L, Mathers B. The
availability, diversion and injection of pharmaceutical opioids in South Asia. Drug
Alcohol Rev 2011; 30 (3): 246-254.
5. Chand PK, Murthy P. Megadose lorazepam dependence. Addiction 2003; 98
(11):1635-1636.
6. Singh S, Murthy P. Ketamine Dependence. Indian J Psychiatry 2001; 43(2):175-177.
7. Chand PK, Jayaram N, Murthy P. Iatrogenic tramadol addiction. Indian J Med Sci 2015,
in press.
8. Yahoo News. Meow Meow and the walking dead: India's newest drug. November 12,
2015. http://news.yahoo.com/meow-meow-walking-dead-indias-080000387.html
9. Rosenberg KP and Feder LC. An introduction to behavioural addictions. In, Behavioural
Addictions. First Edition. Criteria, Evidence and Treatment. Rosenberg KP and Feder LC
(Eds). London: Academic Press, 2014.
10. Indian Council for Medical Research. Behavioural addiction in the community: an
exploration. Sharma MK, Benegal V, Girish N, Thennarasu K.
http://www.icmr.nic.in/final/Behavioural%20addiction%20in%20the%20community
.pdf
11. Murthy P (Principal author and scientific editor). Women and Drug Use in India:
Substance, Women and High-Risk Assessment Study. United Nations Office on Drugs
and Crime, Ministry of Social Justice and Empowerment, United Nations Development
Fund for Women 2008.
12. Nayak R , Murthy P, Girimaji S, Navaneetham J. Foetal alcohol spectrum disorders. J
Trop Paediatr 2012; 58 (1): 19-24.
13. Nadkarni A, Murthy P , Crome IB, Rao R. Alcohol use and alcohol-use disorders
among older adults in India: a literature review, Aging Ment Health 2013; 17 (8):979-
91.
14. McLellan AT, O'Brien C P, Lewis D, Kleber HD. Drug addiction as a chronic medical
illness: implications for treatment, insurance and evaluation. JAMA 2000; 284:
1689–1695.
15. Murthy P, Chand PK, Harish MG, Thennarasu K, Prathima S, Karappuchamy,
Janakiramiah N. Outcome of alcohol dependence: The role of continued care. Indian J
Community Med 2009; 34 (2): 148-151.
16. Rosenberg KP and Feder LC (Eds). Behavioural addiction. Criteria, evidence and
treatment. London: Academic Press, 2014.
17. Van Praag HM. Impact of classification on psychiatry. Dialogues Clin Neurosci 1999;
3(1):141-151.
18. Young K. Psychology of computer use: Addictive use of the Internet: A case that breaks
the stereotype. Psychol Rep 1996; 79: 899-902.
19. Griffith M. A 'components' model of addiction within a biopsychosocial framework. J
Subst Use 2005; 10: 191-197.
20. Wang GJ, Volkow ND, Thanos PK, Fowler JS. Similarity between obesity and drug
addiction as assessed by neurofunctional imaging: a concept review. J Addict Dis 2004;
23: 39-53.
21. Grant JE, Steinberg MA. Compulsive sexual behaviour and pathological gambling. Sex
Addiction Compulsivity 2005; 12: 235-244.
22. Bostwick JM, Hecksel KA, Stevens SR, Bower JH, Ahlskog JE. Frequency of new-onset
Debasish Basu
Abhishek Ghosh
On behalf of
Indian Psychiatric Society
Specialty Section on Substance Use Disorders
2016
New Psychoactive Substances
CONTENTS
Executive Summary
1. Introduction
2. Scope and methodology of the guideline
3. Profile of NPS users
4. Assessment of suspected cases of NPS intoxication
4.1. Clinical assessment
4.2. Laboratory assessment
5. Management of synthetic cannabinoids/cathinone intoxication or toxicity
5.1. Treatment setting
5.2. Management of sympathomimetic toxidrome
5.3. Management of psychiatric symptoms
5.4. Management of withdrawal symptoms
6. Long term management for NPS use disorders
7. Conclusion
EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
Introduction - New psychoactive substances (NPS) refer to a large and ever-increasing
rubric of chemicals with pharmacological properties and clinical effects resembling a
known illicit substance. During 2014, 500 psychoactive substances were officially
notified for the first time in the European Union (EU). Since then, the EU's early warning
system has updated the list on a number of occasions. NPS are classified broadly into
five categories: ketamine, piperazine, synthetic cathinones, synthetic cannabinoids,
and plant based substances. These drugs might cause significant health hazards and also
have the potential to cause addiction. Although there is no general population based
survey on NPS, data from the emergency departments, poison research centers, and
Internet surveys indicate an increasing trend of NPS use.
Methodology - This chapter focuses on two NPS, i.e. Synthetic cannabinoids and
Synthetic cathinones. There are no published meta-analysis, reviews, open-label trials,
randomized double-blind trials, and placebo-controlled trials with regard to the
management of NPS intoxication. Hence, the evidence of this guideline is based on
case reports, case series, and expert opinions. Therefore as per the Appraisal of
Guidelines for Research & Evaluation (AGREE) Instrument II the level of evidence is
mostly at level D.
Profile of NPS users - NPS use has been observed in a distinctive group of population.
Hence, identifying this group would be important for managing suspected NPS toxicity.
Demographically most of them are adolescent or young adult males, with mostly
homosexual orientation. A majority of these individuals are also regular cannabinoids
or cocaine users. A substantial majority uses these drugs in the night clubs and procures
it through online purchasing.
Assessment of suspected case of NPS intoxication - Most of the patients with NPS use
would be encountered in the emergency departments. Manifestations of the adverse
effects due to these groups of drugs could be psychiatric or due to physiological.
Detection of such cases with NPS intoxication/toxic effects depends on obtaining a
recent intake of these substances. However, many a time history is not available or even
there is a history of recent ingestion, effects of these drugs could be modified by other
confounding variables due to simultaneous intake of other illicit substances.
Nevertheless there are certain clinical indicators which suggest NPS toxicity. A
sympathomimetic toxidrome is almost universal for all types of NPS (especially for
synthetic cannabinoids/cathinones). NPS intoxication might also present with
behavioural manifestations like, sudden onset unprecedented violence, suicidal
behaviour and hallucinations. In addition to these, there are demographic indicators as
mentioned already. In presence of these clinical indicators, laboratory analysis of
biological specimens should be sent for identification of NPS or other illicit substances.
However, major limitations of these laboratory procedures are the availability and the
time and expertise required to analyze and interpret results. In addition to direct
detection of the chemical in the sample, there are certain laboratory changes (like
hyperglycemia, hyponatremia, increased creatinine, changes in ECG) that have been
detected in Spice/Bath salt intoxication. Although these all are non-specific changes
which can happen in plethora of other medical conditions, in the presence of other
clinical/historical evidence these laboratory parameters might have some supportive
role to play.
Management of NPS intoxication/toxicity - Diagnosis of exposure, intoxication, and or
toxicity can be challenging, as patients may be unable to share key historical details. The
emergency and acute care physician must maintain a high index of suspicion for these
toxins. No specific antidotes exist for NPS toxicity. Hence, management is always
supportive. Most cases could be managed in the emergency with regular
monitoring/observation. Patients need to be admitted in the intensive care unit, if they
required to be intubated, with severe hyperthermia, recurrent seizures, coma, and
arrhythmia. In case patients have predominant psychiatric symptoms, they could be
transferred to a special psychiatric unit. Management might be grossly divided into
three categories, treatment of sympathomimetic toxicity, behavioural/psychiatric
problems, and withdrawal symptoms. The mainstay of treatment is benzodiazepines.
Anti-psychotics are not the first preferred option for psychotic symptoms or violence, as
these might lower the seizure threshold.
Treatment of withdrawal - Treatment of withdrawal symptoms is supportive and
gradual dose reduction is not necessary.
Long term management - Evidence is limited to make any comments.
1. INTRODUCTION
New psychoactive substance (NPS) is the term which encompasses a huge rubric of
chemicals with pharmacological properties and clinical effects resembling a known
illicit substance.1 The actual 'image' of these groups of psychoactive substances
masquerades as common, apparently harmless consumer goods (like bath salts,
incense, plant food, herbal products, etc.) or aura of science (research products) or
substances which are 'legal' (hence also known as legal highs). The last point is
important because many of these 'NPS's are still elusive to the legal watchdog agencies
and thus could not be brought under proscription. This might be as a result of the
discrepancy between ever emerging, fast growing innovative chemical tampering of
NPS and slow, tedious, and convoluted drug policy.2 Thus the data regarding NPS are
still underestimated and underappreciated.
Recognizing the salience of NPS, European Monitoring Centre for Drugs and Drug
Addiction (EMCDDA) was perhaps the first official organization to respond and furnish
a special investigation report which described the new emerging phenomenon of NPS.3
During 2012, 57 psychoactive substances were officially notified for the first time in the
European Union, with the EU's early warning system reporting the appearance of more
than one new psychoactive drug on the market every week.4 The recent number has
reached up to 500.4 Moreover NPS are usually sold online through an amount of
unregulated websites and are almost unknown to health professionals who may not be
technically up to date/conversant, given the typical absence of up-to-date scientific
literature and reliable sources of information.1,5,6 Thereafter classifying this ever
increasing, broad, and mixed bag of NPS has been attempted by United Nations Office
of Drug and Crimes (UNODC), as ketamine, Piperazines, Synthetic Cathinones,
Synthetic cannabinoids, and plant based substances (Kratom, Salvia divinorum) (Panel
1).7 This could one hand improve research and recognition of these groups of
substances but on the other might limit the exploration by drawing an artificial
boundary.
The initial surveillance and tracking of NPSs took place in the European Union (EU) via
an early warning network (Reitox), as well as an innovative Internet investigative project
(Psychonaut) searching proactively for emerging patterns of drug abuse. A similarly
coordinated early warning network exists in the USA called the Community
Epidemiology Work Group (CEWG). The CEWG identified the emerging Synthetic
cannabinoids (K2) epidemic in the Midwestern USA in 2010.7 In March 2011, the
United States Drug Enforcement Administration (DEA) temporarily placed 5 synthetic
cannabinoids (SC) into Schedule 1 of the Controlled Substances Act “to avoid imminent
hazard to the public safety.8Amongst all exposures reported to American Association of
Poison Control Centers between January 1, 2009, to April 30, 2012, Bath salts and
synthetic THC exposures totaled 7467 and 11561, respectively. Bath salts exposures
were 0 in 2009, 298 in 2010, and 6062 in 2011. Synthetic THC exposures were 14 in
2009, 2821 in 2010, and 6255 in 2011.9 This data although might represent the
minuscule fraction of the actual threat definitely represent an increasing trend in the use
of NPS (Bath salt and Spice to be precise).
For a clinician or a psychiatrist all these data could only be meaningful if the relevance
of NPS in clinical practice could be demonstrated either in the form of health hazards or
addictive potential. In the index chapter, we will be discussing about their health
hazards at length. However, only handful of published literature addresses the issue
regarding the addictive potential. A study amongst US dance drug users reported
mephedrone, when used intranasal, to be perceived as more addictive and more risky
than cocaine.10 A strong subjective 'intoxicating effect' of Spice has been demonstrated
in another study.11 More studies are needed to settle this important issue.
1
Ketamine
l
Piperazines-
l BZP, mcPP, TFMPP
Synthetic
l cathinones (Commercial or colloquial name: Bath salt)-
Mephedrone,2 Flephedrone, MDPV, Naphyrone
Synthetic
l cannabinoids (Commercial or colloquial name: Spice)- JWH-018,
JWH-073, JWH-200, CP-47,497, and (C8)-CP47,497
Plant
l based substances- Kratom, Salvia divinorum
Amino-indanes
l (Commercial or colloquial name: 'pink champagne')- 2-AI
Tryptamine(Commercial
l or colloquial name: 'Foxy-methoxy' or 'alpha o
alpha')- 5-MeO-DMT, 5-MeO-DPT, AMT, 4-AcO-DMT
Other
l substances- 1,3-dimethylamylamine (DMAA)
SPECIAL NOTES for Indian scenario:
1. Since November 2013, ketamine hydrochloride has been placed in the
Schedule X of the Drugs and Cosmetics Rules (Sixth Amendment, 2013),
meaning thereby that, in view of of its serious abuse potential, it is now placed
under the most stringent schedule though still legal to prescribe with prescribed
precautions
2. Since February 2015, mephedrone and its salts and preparations have been
placed in Schedule I of the Psychotropic Substances of the Narcotic Drugs and
Psychotropic Substances (Amendment) Rules, 2015, thus making their use etc.
illegal other than for medicinal and scientific purposes as per the provisions of
the NDPS Act 1985.
reasons for use were curiosity, positive drug effect, relaxation, and to get high without
having a positive drug test.14 Moreover, acute subjective effects were reported to be
similar to known effects of cannabis. In addition to this survey, a recent report has shown
that use of Spice is widely prevalent amongst cannabis users.15 Whether NPS is a
supplement or substitution for the existing illicit substance use, to find out an answer to
this important issue, a study has been conducted in the UK. The results show that NPS
are likely to be added to drug repertoires rather than replacing it, particularly amongst
experienced users with consequent health risks for individuals and resource
implications for services.16 As college goers fall in the vulnerable age group for Spice,
studies amongst college students appear to be well justified. In a longitudinal study
conducted in two colleges in the US has revealed that weighted lifetime prevalence of
K2 and Spice use at college entry was 7.6%. An additional 6.6% of students reported first
use during college. By the cohort's fourth year, 17.0% reported lifetime K2 and Spice
use. K2 and Spice use at college entry was associated with sensation seeking; hookah,
marijuana, and illicit drug use; and low religiosity, which further substantiates the
previous findings from the general population or poison centers.17 A potential space in
which NPS might be used is in the discos. In a study from US night life scenes, 8.2%
reported use of synthetic cannabinoids and 1.1% reported the use of mephedrone. Gay
and bisexual men reported higher prevalence of mephedrone use. Latinos reported
higher prevalence of synthetic cannabinoid use.18 A study of mephedrone use among
dance drug users in the UK suggests that users of this substance are likely to be younger
and male. Over 40% of these UK dance drug users reported the use of mephedrone.
Additionally, other research indicates that many users in the UK continued the use of
mephedrone after its ban despite a subsequent price increase, suggesting that the
substance may be becoming entrenched within a broader class of club drugs within
some scenes.10It has been cited as popular in some European nightclubs, such as in
London, even after its prohibition with prevalence in one sample of attendees of gay-
friendly clubs at 41%.9 From these studies it is quite apparent that in both sides of the
Atlantic, Spice and mephedrone are used extensively by a special group of population.
Due to difficulties with its detection through standard testing, it may be an attractive
substance of abuse for military personnel. However, few studies have examined the
consequences of its use in this population. In one of the US surveys conducted amongst
treatment seeking military personnel, 11% reported using SC in the last 90 days and
more than 65% of them reported Spice as their preferred drug.19 (Panel 2)
water pipe, although they can be consumed orally or intranasally. Acute effects are
similar to cannabis, including alteration in mood, conjunctival injection, and
tachycardia. Effects are reported to start within 10 minutes after inhalation, and most
effects appear to dissipate 2-6 hours after use.20
Following physical parameters must be examined in a suspected case of NPS use: body
temperature, pulse (tachycardia), blood pressure (hypertension), monitoring urine
output (oliguria/ anuria), general physical examination (for diaphoresis, needle marks,
ecchymosis, conjunctival injection), ENT examination (nasal perforation, poor oral
hygiene), examination for muscle tenderness (rhabdomyolysis), abdominal
examination (hepatomegaly and tenderness),and neurological examination (clonus).
Acute onset agitation or hallucination (or other psychotic symptoms) in a patient
without any prior psychiatric history and with a history of recent drug/herbal product
consumption must raise the suspicion of NPS toxicity. Synthetic cathinone
hallucinations are frequently auditory and tactile in nature and paired with psychoses
that can be severe and long lasting; many patients are admitted days after cessation of
drug use and psychotic symptoms persist for several days thereafter while receiving
treatment.27-28
Table 1. Physical findings associated with New Psychoactive Substance (NPS) use
Body systems Physical findings/ Suspected NPS Association with
Clinical syndromes the NPS
General Hyperthermia Synthetic hallucinogens, Intoxication
bath salts
Cardiac Tachycardia, Any NPS Recent use
Hypertension Bath salts, synthetic
Chest pain: might cannabinoids
indicate cardiac
ischaemia/myocarditis
Neurologic Clonus Synthetic hallucinogens Recent use
Seizures Bath salts, synthetic Intoxication
hallucinogens, synthetic
cannabinoids
Historical
l evidence- recent intake of some unknown commercial herbal
product purchased online or definitive history of consumption of Spice/Bath
salts; individual with history of regular intake of cannabis, stimulants or other
psychoactive substance
Demographic
l pointers- young adults or adolescent males, with a homosexual
orientation hailing from a night club
Evidence
l from physical findings- conjunctival injection, odor of smoky
chemical in the breath, perforated/ulcerated nasal septum, increased body
temperature, palpitation, high blood pressure, decreased urine output,
bruxism, muscle tenderness
Suggestive
l clinical features- seizure in an individual, who is a known
cannabis user; acute renal failure and rhabdomyolysis without any apparent
physical cause
Behavioural
l indicators- acute onset agitation, hallucination, self mutilating
behaviour in an individual without any prior psychiatric history
samples of subjects supposedly had consumed some of these products before landing
up in the emergency. For the purpose of current practice guideline, by the phrase
detection in laboratory, would be referred to the latter. Detection of NPS in the
laboratory is always a challenging task. Whereas cases of intoxication and death have
been reported, the phenomenon appears to be largely underestimated and is a matter of
concern for Public Health. One of the major points of concern depends on the
substantial ineffectiveness of the current methods of toxicological screening of
biological samples to identify the new compounds entering the market.29 As stated
earlier, the focus of the discussion would be on synthetic cannabinoids/cathinones (SC).
There are a number of unique challenges to the laboratory detection of these substances
present in the urine, oral fluid, and serum samples of people who have consumed
Spice/Bath salt.
l Contains synthetic cannabinoids/cathinones from different chemical classes
l Contains minimal amount of these substances
l Composition that is constantly changing
Therefore, a laboratory test that is to be of clinical utility would require a single or battery
of tests that could detect cannabinoids/cathinones or their metabolites belonging to
several chemical classes. The most common biological sample analyzed for the
assessment of SCs is blood. Other samples which have been tested are urine and oral
fluid.20
Several synthetic cannabinoids including JWH-018 and many of their downstream
metabolites can be measured in the serum through liquid chromatography tandem mass
spectrometry (LC-MS/MS) and gas chromatography mass spectrometry (GC/MS).
However, LC-MS/MS and GC/MS methods require extraction, concentration, or
derivation techniques that are time consuming. There are no commercially available
laboratory tests for the detection of synthetic cannabinoids. These tests cannot be
performed on-site at most institutions. Thus, the results would not be immediately
available and would be unlikely to inform clinical decision-making.30-32 Synthetic
cathinones can be identified using gas chromatography–mass spectrometry or liquid
chromatography–mass spectrometry techniques. They can be measured in blood,
urine, and stomach contents in both pre and postmortem specimens. Correlation of
concentrations with clinical effects is not well understood. Blood concentrations of
methedrone in specimens taken from suspected drug offenders ranged in one series
from 0.2 to 4.8 ìg/g blood. Mephedrone concentrations in urine specimens taken after
use in the preceding 24 h ranged from 0.6 to 7.35 mg/Ml. Synthetic cathinones can be
analyzed in hair. A rat model suggests that cathinone and methcathinone are poorly
incorporated into hair, but that methylone is well incorporated.33-36
As already mentioned one of the major limitations of these laboratory procedures is the
time and expertise required to analyze and interpret results. A recent study has
demonstrated the feasibility of a simple liquid chromatography-tandem mass
40 © Indian Psychiatric Society 2016
New Psychoactive Substances
episodes the safety of the patient and the people around would inevitably become the
cornerstone of treatment. Patients need to be isolated in a safe and calm place with
minimal environmental stimulation. Benzodiazepines could be prescribed if violence
could not be managed by conservative means. The dose and the choice of
benzodiazepines remain speculative. However, based on the treatment experience
with other violent patients, perhaps lorazepam in a slow intra-venous route with
periodic monitoring of vitals might be considered.38,44
Psychosis due to synthetic cannabinoids (SC) and cathinone intoxication have been
managed with monitored observation. For psychopathological clinical features,
benzodiazepines have been used to treat anxiety, agitation, and seizures.
Antipsychotics are second-line agents for agitation, due to the lowered seizure
threshold with use of cathinone and phenethylamine designer drugs. Sedation may be
required if the patient is markedly agitated and at risk for harm to self or health-care staff.
Since some designer drug-associated psychosis may be severe and require prolonged
inpatient treatment, psychiatric consultation is indicated, in particular for those with
persistent symptoms.20,45
If marked psychiatric symptoms persist longer than one or more weeks after
discontinuation, the patient should be evaluated carefully to determine whether he or
she has a co-occurring primary psychiatric disorder, which then should be treated with
specific therapy. Treatment of prolonged anxiety, depression, or psychosis is the same
as when these conditions are not associated with recent designer drug use.46-47
The recommendations have been mentioned in the management algorithm.
5.4 Management of withdrawal symptoms:
Abrupt discontinuation of stimulants or hallucinogens does not cause gross physiologic
sequelae, so they are not tapered off or replaced with a cross-tolerant drug during
medically supervised withdrawal. Abrupt discontinuation of SC could result in
withdrawal symptoms such as nausea and irritability, similar to that with cannabis
cessation. However, there is no indication for pharmacologic replacement (e.g.,
dronabinol), since SC withdrawal is not life-threatening. Patients can be treated with
supportive care by intravenous fluids and antiemetics if necessary.48-49
The recommendations have been mentioned in the management algorithm.
Management algorithm
Withdrawal symptoms:
l Abrupt stoppage of the substance (NPS)
l Manage anxiety with benzodiazepine
l Manage nausea/vomiting with anti emetics
[D]
3. European Monitoring Centre for Drugs and Drug Addiction E. Thematic paper —
Understanding the 'Spice' phenomenon. Office for Official Publications of the
European Communities; Luxembourg: 2009.
4. UNODC early warning system advisory on New Psychoactive Subatances. Accessed
from: https://www.unodc.org/LSS/Announcement?type=NPS (accessed on 02.11.15)
5. Foreman RF, Marlow DB, McLellan AT. The Internet a source of drugs of abuse. Curr
Psych Rep. 2006; 8: 377-82.
6. Littlejohn C, Baldacchino A, Schifano F, Deluca P. Internet pharmacies and online
prescription drug sales: A cross-sectional study. Drugs Educ Prev and Policy. 2005;12:
75-80.
7. Hammond B. New and emrging psychoactive substance- Global perspective. United
Nations Office of Drug and Crimes, UNODC, 2013. Accessed from:
http://www.unodc.org/southeastasiaandpacific/en/smart.html
8. Lank PM, Pines E, Mycyk MB. Emergency physicians' knowledge of cannabinoid
designer drugs. West J Emerg Med. 2013;14:467-70.
9. Wood KE. Exposure to bath salts and synthetic tetrahydrocannabinol from 2009 to
2012 in the United States. J Pediatr. 2013; 163:213-6.
10. Winstock AR, Mitcheson LR, Deluca P, Davey Z, Corazza O, Schifano F. Mephedrone,
new kid for the chop? Addiction. 2011; 106:154-61.
11. Kjellgren A, Henningsson H, Soussan C. Fascination and Social Togetherness-
Discussions about Spice Smoking on a Swedish Internet Forum. Subst Abuse.
2013;7:191-8.
12. Barratt MJ, Cakic V, Lenton S. Patterns of synthetic cannabinoid use in Australia. Drug
Alcohol Rev. 2013; 32:141–6.
13. Donnelly, MT. Services MDoHaS. Health advisory: K2 synthetic marijuana use among
teenagers and young adults in Missouri. 2010.
14. Vandrey R, Dunn KE, Fry JA, Girling ER. A survey study to characterize use of Spice
products (synthetic cannabinoids). Drug Alcohol Depend. 2012; 120:238-41.
15. Gunderson EW, Haughey HM, Ait-Daoud N, Joshi AS, Hart CL. A survey of synthetic
cannabinoid consumption by current cannabis users. Subst Abus. 2014; 35:184-9.
16. Moore K, Dargan PI, Wood DM, Measham F. Do novel psychoactive substances displace
established club drugs, supplement them or act as drugs of initiation? The relationship
between mephedrone, ecstasy and cocaine. Eur Addict Res. 2013;19:276-82.
17. Egan KL, Suerken CK, Reboussin BA, Spangler J, Wagoner KG, Sutfin EL, et al. K2 and
Spice use among a cohort of college students in southeast region of the USA. Am J Drug
Alcohol Abuse. 2015:1-6.
18. Kelly BC, Wells BE, Pawson M, Leclair A, Parsons JT, Golub SA. Novel psychoactive
drug use among younger adults involved in US nightlife scenes. Drug Alcohol Rev.
2013; 32:588-93.
19. Walker D, Neighbors C, Walton T, Pierce A, Mbilinyi L, Kaysen D, et al. Spicing up the
military: Use and effects of synthetic cannabis in substance abusing army personnel.
Addict Behav. 2014; 39:1139-44.
20. Weaver MF, Hopper JA, Gunderson EW. Designer drugs 2015: assessment and
management. Addict Sci Clin Pract. 2015;10:8-16.
21. Loeffler G, Hurst D, Penn A, Yung K. Spice, bath salts, and the U.S. military: the
emergence of synthetic cannabinoid receptor agonists and cathinones in the U.S.
Armed Forces. Mil Med. 2012; 177:1041-8.
22. Aromatario M, Bottoni E, Santoni M, Ciallella C. New "lethal highs": a case of a deadly
cocktail of GHB and Mephedrone. Forensic Sci Int. 2012;223:e38–e41.
23. Marinetti LJ, Antonides HM. Analysis of Synthetic Cathinones Commonly Found in
Bath Salts in Human Performance and Postmortem Toxicology: Method Development,
Drug Distribution and Interpretation of Results. J Anal Toxicol. 2013
24. Maskell PD, De Paoli G, Seneviratne C, Pounder DJ. Mephedrone (4-
methylmethcathinone)-related deaths. J Anal Toxicol. 2011;35:188–191.
25. Schifano F, Corkery J, Ghodse AH. Suspected and confirmed fatalities associated with
mephedrone (4-methylmethcathinone, "meow meow") in the United Kingdom. J Clin
Psychopharmacol. 2012;32:710–714.
26. Angoa-Perez M, Kane MJ, Francescutti DM, Sykes KE, Shah MM, Mohammed AM, et
al. Mephedrone, an abused psychoactive component of 'bath salts' and
methamphetamine congener, does not cause neurotoxicity to dopamine nerve
endings of the striatum. J Neurochem. 2012;20:1097–1107.
27. Kasick DP, McKnight CA, Klisovic E. "Bath salt" ingestion leading to severe
intoxication delirium: two cases and a brief review of the emergence of mephedrone
use. Am J Drug Alcohol Abuse. 2012;38:176–180.
28. Stoica MV, Felthous AR. Acute Psychosis Induced by Bath Salts: A Case Report with
Clinical and Forensic Implications. J Forensic Sci. 2013
29. Favretto D, Pascali JP, Tagliaro F. New challenges and innovation in forensic
toxicology: focus on the "New Psychoactive Substances". J Chromatogr A. 2013;
1287:84-95.
30. Frison G, Gregio M, Zamengo L, et al. Gas chromatography/mass spectrometry
determination of mephedrone in drug seizures after derivatization with 2,2,2-
trichloroethyl chloroformate. Rapid Commun Mass Spectrom. 2011;25:387–90.
31. Maheux CR, Copeland CR. Characterization of three methcathinone analogs: 4-
methylmethcathinone, methylone, and bk-MBDB. DEA Microgram J. 2010;7:42–9.
32. Wissenbach DK, Meyer MR, Remane D, Philipp AA, Weber AA, Maurer HH. Drugs of
abuse screening in urine as part of a metabolite-based LC-MS(n) screening concept.
Anal Bioanal Chem. 2011;400:3481–89.
33. Spaderna M, Addy PH, D'Souza DC. Spicing things up: synthetic cannabinoids.
Psychopharmacology (Berl). 2013; 228:525-40.
34. Prosser JM, Nelson LS. The toxicology of bath salts: a review of synthetic cathinones. J
Med Toxicol. 2012;8:33-42.
35. Torrance H, Cooper G. The detection of mephedrone (4-methylmethcathinone) in 4
fatalities in Scotland. Forensic Sci Int. 2010;202:e62–e63.
36. Lusthof KJ, Oosting R, Maes A, et al. A case of extreme agitation after use of
mephedrone in the Netherlands. Forensic Sci Int. 2011;206:e9395.
37. Adamowicz P, Tokarczyk B. Simple and rapid screening procedure for 143 new
psychoactive substances by liquid chromatography-tandem mass spectrometry. Drug
Test Anal. 2015 May 14. doi: 10.1002/dta.1815. [E-pub ahead of print]
38. Simmons J, Cookman L, Kang C, Skinner C. Three cases of “spice” exposure. Clin
Toxicol (Phila) 2011;49:431–433.
39. Synthetic cathinone derivatives. In: POISINDEX® System [Internet database]. Thomson
Reuters (Healthcare) Inc. Accessed 20 June 2015
40. James D, Adams RD, Spears R, Cooper G, Lupton DJ, Thompson JP et al. Clinical
characteristics of mephedrone toxicity reported to the UK National Poisons
Information Service. Emerg Med J 2010; 28:686–9.
41. Rosenbaum CD, Carreiro SP, Babu KM. Here today, gone tomorrow…and back again?
A review of herbal marijuana alternatives (K2, Spice), synthetic cathinones (bath salts),
kratom, Salvia divinorum, methoxetamine, and piperazines. J Med Toxicol.
2012;8:15-32.
42. Center for Disease Control and Prevention Emergency department visits after use of a
drug sold as “bath salts”—Michigan, November 13, 2010–March 31, 2011. MMWR.
2011;60:624–7.
43. Olives T, Orozeo B, Stellpflug S. Bath salts update: meow meow and MTV. ACEP
Toxiciology Section 2011, Newsletter.
44. Hill SL, Doris T, Gurung S, Katebe S, Lomas A, Dunn M. Severe clinical toxicity
associated with analytically confirmed recreational use of 25I-NBOMe: case series.
Clin Toxicol (Phila) 2013;51:487–92.
45. Spiller HA, Ryan ML, Weston RG, Jansen J. Clinical experience with and analytical
confirmation of “bath salts” and “legal highs” (synthetic cathinones) in the United
States. Clin Toxicol (Phila) 2011;49:499–505.
46. Stellpflug SJ, Kealey SE, Hegarty CB, Janis GC. 2-(4-iodo-2,5-dimethoxyphenyl)-N-[(2-
methoxyphenyl) methyl] ethanamine (25I-NBOMe): clinical case with unique
confirmatory testing. J Med Toxicol. 2014;10:45–50.
47. Gunderson EW, Kirkpatrick MG, Willing LM, Holstege CP. Intranasal substituted
cathinone “bath salts” psychosis potentially exacerbated by diphenhydramine. J
Addict Med. 2013;7:163–8.
48. German CL, Fleckenstein AE, Hanson GR. Bath salts and synthetic cathinones: an
emerging designer drug phenomenon. Life Sci. 2014; 97:2-8.
49. Weaver MF, Schnoll SH. In Addictions: A Comprehensive Guidebook. In: McCrady
BS, Epstein EE, editors. Stimulants: amphetamines and cocaine. New York: Oxford
University Press USA; 1999. pp. 105–20.
50. Martins SS, Copersino ML, Soderstrom CA, Smith GS, Dischinger PC, McDuff DR.
Sociodemographic characteristics associated with substance use status in a trauma
inpatient population. J Addict Dis. 2007;26:53–62.
51. Weaver MF, Jarvis MA, Schnoll SH. Role of the primary care physician in problems of
substance abuse. Arch Intern Med. 1999;159:913–24.
Subodh B.N.
Aniruddha Basu
On behalf of
Indian Psychiatric Society
Specialty Section on Substance Use Disorders
2016
Cocaine
CONTENTS
Executive Summary
1. Introduction
1.1 Epidemiology
1.2 Pharmacology
1.3 Mechanism of action
1.4 Consequences of cocaine use
2. Cocaine use disorders
3. Scope and methodology of the guideline
3.1 Scope of the Guidelines
3.2 Methodology of Guideline development
4. Review of treatment modalities
4.1 General Issues
4.2 Treatment Aims / Goals
5. Assessment of cocaine use disorders
5.1 Brief Overview
5.2 Clinical History
5.3 Physical Examination
5.4 Instruments
5.5 Investigations
6. Short term management
6.1 Management of cocaine intoxication
6.2 Management of cocaine withdrawal
7. Long term management of cocaine use disorders
7.1 Pharmacological agents
7.1.1 Topiramate
7.1.2 Modafinil
7.1.3 Disulfiram
7.1.4 Stimulants
7.1.5 Anticonvulsants
7.1.6 Antipsychotics
7.1.7 Antidepressants
EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
Cocaine a classic stimulant has emerged as one of the most common drugs used
worldwide. Cocaine use disorders are associated with high mortality and morbidity
worldwide. There is not much data on use of cocaine in India. Recently in last few years
there are literature on use in media and one case series. As cocaine dependence
syndrome like any other addictive disorders is a chronic relapsing and recurring
condition, patients with cocaine use disorders will require a comprehensive
multipronged care for continuous and prolonged period of time. An integrated bio-
psychosocial approach to care is needed to address several aspects of the treatment. An
active collaboration with the family while planning and delivering treatment is
required.
The main goal of treatment is to maintain abstinence and if not possible decrease the
frequency and severity of relapses and maximize functioning in between. The goals of
treatment vary according to time frame, across individual patients and can be revised
from time to time. It has been broadly divided into short term and long term goals. The
short goals are management of intoxication, management of withdrawal symptoms,
motivation enhancement, treatment of acute medical sequel and crisis intervention.
Long term treatment goals are relapse prevention, maintenance of abstinence,
occupational rehabilitation, social reintegration, abstinent life style and improving the
quality of life of a person. This guideline will focus on the evidence available for the
management of intoxication, management of withdrawal symptoms, and management
of cocaine dependence. The current guideline used the AGREE II guidelines as template
for proposing the guideline.
Assessment of Cocaine use disorders
A thorough and good assessment will help in diagnosing, establishing rapport,
motivating the person and in formulating the plan of the management. The goal of
assessment also varies in different phases of the treatment. During the first contact it is to
establish rapport, diagnosis and plan of management, and during intervention it is
monitoring the progress and assessing abstinence. The goal also depends on the
context, motivation and cooperativeness of the client. If the client is uncooperative the
aim of assessment is to retain the client in the treatment. During this time the information
can be collected in pieces and information can be added when patient is co-operative.
A detailed assessment should include substance related factors (age of initiation,
frequency, amount, tolerance, craving, withdrawal symptoms, salience, last dose,
motivation, consequences of substance use), history of other substance use, physical
and psychiatric comorbidity if any, abstinence related factors (past abstinence,
duration, reasons for relapse, past treatment/s, methods used for controlling craving). It
also includes history of high risk behaviours, presence of any externalizing disorders,
physical and psychiatric comorbidity, family history of substance abuse and psychiatric
illness, assessing social support, current living arrangements and reasons for current
visit. A thorough physical examination is needed to assess for intoxication, withdrawal
symptoms and evidence of physical damage due to alcohol use or other substance use.
Investigations are used to confirm the presence of the cocaine, assess the degree of the
physical damage and to confirm the presence of sexually transmitted disorders.
Some issues to be considered before arriving at recommendations
The proposed guideline is based on evidence obtained from developed countries
(particularly USA) and none from India. Manifestations of cocaine intoxication and
withdrawal are non- specific and are mostly self-limiting. Psychosocial interventions
have reasonable evidence base and are recommended for cocaine use disorders.
Short term Management
The short term management is aimed towards medical stabilisation and engaging
patient in process of treatment. The management of cocaine intoxication should include
general assessment as described in 'assessment' with particular emphasis placed on
physical status, mental status, substance use history and associated consequences. The
acute effects of cocaine generally subside with time and they do not warrant any specific
treatment. Specific pharmacological treatment is necessary when there is a history of
recent use of other substance with physical consequences (e.g., respiratory depression,
stroke, arrhythmias, etc.). In mild intoxicated state general measures like reassurance
and maintenance in a safe and monitored environment do decrease external
stimulation. Adequate hydration and nutrition should be provided. After the patient
stabilizes then we need to assess the patient comprehensively and also assess for
withdrawal and further management.
Management of cocaine withdrawal requires constant monitoring of signs and
symptoms of withdrawal. The goals of the withdrawal are a) To relieve patient's
discomfort, prevent the occurrence of more serious symptoms, and forestall cumulative
effects that might worsen future withdrawal; b) To utilise the withdrawal treatment
opportunity to engage patients in long-term management. The withdrawal symptoms
are self limiting. There are no well studied pharmacological agents to relieve symptoms
of cocaine withdrawal. There is some evidence base for dopamine agonists like
amantadine and bromocriptine, propranolol and other drugs. These drugs have given
mixed results. The strength of evidence for these is at best (D) level and needs further
studies for management of cocaine withdrawal.
Long term Management
Cocaine dependence is a chronic illness with lapses and relapses. Medications and
psychosocial strategies are used for promoting abstinence and preventing relapse in
patients with cocaine dependence. All the pharmacological agents used in cocaine use
disorders have been studied along with psychosocial interventions. Hence patients
should use whichever psychosocial approach they think beneficial or is available along
with pharmacological agents.
Psychosocial treatments are the main stay of treatment - contingency management,
community based reinforcement approaches and CBT have the highest efficacy (A).
Other therapies like MET, mindfulness based therapies need further research (C).
Evidence for drug treatment is still preliminary – pharmacological treatment should be
used in combination with psychosocial therapies (A). Modafinil and topiramate are
emerging as prospective medications though currently evidence is not unequivocal and
contradictory evidences exist (C). Currently disulfiram, dopamine agonists,
antidepressants, anticonvulsants (except topiramate), psychostimulants, neither any
combination of these medications are recommended. Cocaine vaccine has been found
to be safe and shown promising results in Phase 1 & 2 research but not so promising
response in Phase 3.
1. INTRODUCTION
Cocaine is one of the classic stimulants is a potent alkaloid derived from the leaves of
coca plant grown by ancient Incas in Andes mountain1. Through explorers it travelled
from South America to Europe. In the beginning of the twentieth century in the United
States coca extracts was banned due to harmful consequences. In mid 1980s two new
forms of cocaine emerged namely freebase cocaine and crack cocaine which are easily
available 'smokable' forms making it easily available to the masses and thereby fuelling
the 'cocaine epidemic'2.
1.1 Epidemiology
Cocaine is one of the most common stimulant drugs used world-wide. The recent World
Drug report states that 13.2 to 19.7 million cocaine users worldwide among adults aged
15 to 64 years (0.3%-0.4%)3. There is significant regional variation and cocaine is the
second most common illicit drug in both the Americas. In Europe it is the most common
illicit stimulant. In the Africa particularly in west and south it is common illicit drug4. For
South Asia it has also entering into the scenario of drug problem. However, it is still
restricted to mostly urban adolescents belonging to high socio-economic class who
mostly visit rave parties or similar social gatherings. A case-series from India illustrates
the recent development of such a problem5. Successive United Nations World Drug
Report had cautioned about the emerging dangers of cocaine in south Asia. The indirect
indicators like drug seizures and media highlights show that cocaine has already
emerged in the India as burgeoning problem particularly among high risk groups like
injection drug users6.
1.2 Pharmacology
Cocaine is extracted from the leaves of the erythroxylon coca by soaking leaves in
organic solvent to form a thick paste7. If it is extracted with hydrochloric acid then the
hydrochloride salt can be snorted, inhaled or taken by intravenous route8. The
hydrochloride salt if treated with cocaine – benzoylmethylecgonine – is a naturally
occurring crystalline alkaloid of the tropane family. It is a relatively small lipophilic
molecule that is absorbed through mucous membranes and alveoli. About one-third of
an oral or nasal dose of powered and up to 95% of an inhaled dose of freebase or crack
cocaine may be bioavailable. Binding of cocaine to plasma proteins is minimal and its
volume of distribution is low. Cocaine has a short half-life of 0.7 to 1.5 hours and is
rapidly metabolized by plasma and liver cholinesterases to the major metabolites of
benzoylecgonine and ecgonine-methyl ester. Benzoylecgonine is a
neuropharmacologically active and cardiotoxic agent. These water-soluble metabolites
are excreted in the urine. The time course of the physiologic effects of cocaine varies
9
with the route of use, form of cocaine used, and concomitant use of other drugs . The
onset of effects occurs most rapidly with inhaled cocaine (3–5 seconds) followed by
intravenous injection (10–60 seconds). The onset of effects is delayed with intranasal
Continuing
l to use, even when it causes withdrawal syndrome for alcohol; or use
problems in relationships of the alcohol with the intention of
Giving up important social, occupational
l relieving or avoiding withdrawal
or recreational activities because of symptoms
substance use D. Evidence of tolerance, such that increased
Using substances again and again, even
l doses of alcohol are required to achieve
when it puts the you in danger the effects originally produced by lower
Continuing to use, even when you know
l
doses (clear examples of this are found in
you have a physical or psychological alcohol-dependent individuals who may
problem that could have been caused or take daily doses sufficient to incapacitate
made worse by the substance or kill non-tolerant users)
Needing more of the substance to get the E. Progressive neglect of alternative
l
effect you want (tolerance) pleasures or interests because of alcohol
use, increased amount of time necessary
Development of withdrawal symptoms,
l
to obtain or take alcohol or to recover from
which can be relieved by taking more of
its effects
the substance.
F. Persisting with alcohol use despite clear
evidence of overtly harmful consequences
As per DSM-5cocaine use disorders are classified as mild, moderate and severe. As far
this document is concerned most of the studies are based on cocaine dependence/
abuse/use – hence cocaine use disorder is used to include problem use, abuse and
harmful use15.
3. SCOPE AND METHODOLOGY OF THE GUIDELINE
3.1 Scope of the Guidelines
These guidelines are neither comprehensive nor definitive. Cocaine use in India is rare
but gradually in a transitional society like India it is being increasingly recognised as a
problem. Currently it is used by only high socio-economic status of the society. Hence
the treatment seeking is only restricted to private hospitals; hence large government
hospitals, where most of the Drug Abuse Monitoring System is carried out, often miss
them. This has led to very less research in this population. However, the growing
importance of cocaine cannot be denied in the aftermath of globalization and increased
availability. So we need guidelines and there is need to treat people suffering from
cocaine dependence. Hence we have to depend mainly on research carried out in
western setting. Indian psychiatrists and mental health professionals caring for patients
should consider the evidence base but not be limited by the recommendations made, as
patients are cared in a number of different settings in our country. In the present form the
guidelines are particularly applicable to De-addiction centres, and General hospital
psychiatric centres. In this article we are not going to discuss about evidence base for
management of dual diagnosis which requires a separate guidelines. Also this should
not be considered as comprehensive enough to accommodate all know
conditions, as needed.
Increase motivation for recovery.
Initiate treatment for chronic medical and psychiatric conditions, as needed.
Enhance coping and relapse prevention skills.
Improve occupational functioning, social support and assist in integrating to society on
as needed basis.
Promote maintenance of recovery through ongoing participation in structured
treatment or self-help groups.
The goals of treatment vary according to time frame, across individual patients and can
be revised from time to time. It has been broadly divided into short term and long term
goals. The short goals are management of intoxication, management of withdrawal
symptoms, motivation enhancement, treatment of acute medical sequel and crisis
intervention. Long term treatment goals are relapse prevention, to maintain abstinence,
occupational rehabilitation, social reintegration, abstinent life style and improving the
quality of life of a person. This guideline will focus on the evidence available for the
management of intoxication, management of withdrawal symptoms, and management
of dependence. Goals of treatment should be set and agreed between the patient and
the clinician.
5. ASSESSMENT OF COCAINE USE DISORDERS
The assessment is very important as it forms the first point of contact and a thorough and
good assessment will help in diagnosing, establishing rapport, motivating the person
and in formulating the plan of the management.
5.1 Brief Overview
The assessment is very important as it forms the first point of contact and a thorough and
good assessment will help in diagnosing, establishing rapport, motivating the person
and in formulating the plan of the management. The goal of assessment also varies in
different phases of the treatment. During the first contact it is to establish rapport,
diagnosis and plan of management, and during intervention it is monitoring the
progress and assessing abstinence. The goal also depends on the context, motivation of
the client and cooperativeness of the client. If the client is uncooperative the aim of
assessment is to retain the client in the treatment. During this time the information can
be collected in pieces and information can be added when patient is co-operative.
5.2 Clinical History
A detailed assessment should include substance related factors such as age of initiation,
frequency, amount, tolerance, craving, withdrawal symptoms, salience, loss of control,
persistent despite harm, last dose, motivation, consequences of substance use (physical,
psychological, financial, family problems, vocational and legal), history of other
substance use, physical and psychiatric comorbidity if any, abstinence related factors
62 © Indian Psychiatric Society 2016
Cocaine
such as past abstinence, duration of abstinence, reasons for relapse, past treatments
(pharmacological or non-pharmacological or both), methods used for controlling
craving. It also includes history of high risk behaviours, presence of any externalizing
disorders, physical and psychiatric comorbidity, family history of substance abuse and
psychiatric illness, assessing social support, current living arrangements and reasons for
current visit.
5.3 Physical Examination
A thorough physical examination to assess for intoxication, withdrawal symptoms and
evidence of physical damage due to alcohol use or other substance use should be done.
Also a thorough mental status examination and psychopathology in case of co-morbid
psychiatric conditions should be done. Psychological or neuropsychological testing
can be done for some individuals with history of cognitive impairment.
5.4 Instruments
Scales provide ways to structurally assess the individuals with cocaine use disorders.
Some of the scales like ASSIST, Cocaine Selective Severity Assessment can be used to
make diagnosis and identify the intensity of withdrawal symptoms.
5.5 Investigations
Investigations are used to confirm the presence of the cocaine, assess the degree of the
physical damage and to confirm the presence of sexually transmitted disorders.
Investigations such as liver function test, hemogram, GGT, VDRL, HIV in high risk cases
can be used. Though not used routinely, in some cases, neuropsychological tests can be
used to assess the cognitive function particularly in cases with medical, psychiatric
complications or with co-morbid other substance use.
6. SHORT TERM MANAGEMENT
6.1 Management of Cocaine intoxication
Cocaine intoxication is commonly encountered in clinical settings particularly medical
emergency settings. Diagnosis of intoxication can be made according to the criteria set
up in ICD-10 or DSM-5. The clinical assessment should include general assessment as
described in 'assessment' with particular emphasis placed on physical status, mental
status, substance use history and associated consequences. If urine screens are available
they can be screened and noted in the clinical history. The acute effects of cocaine
intoxication generally subside with time and medications are needed for symptomatic
management. Specific pharmacological treatment is necessary when there is a history of
recent use of other substance use and with physical consequences (e.g., respiratory
depression, stroke, arrhythmias, etc.,). If mildly intoxicated general measures like
reassurance and maintenance in a safe and monitored environment do decrease
external stimulation and provide orientation if necessary. Adequate hydration and
nutrition should be provided. If patient is very anxious short acting low dose
benzodiazepines and if severely agitated low dose antipsychotics can be used to control
symptoms. While using benzodiazepines a close watch should be kept on respiratory
difficulty and while using antipsychotics a close watch should be kept for occurrence of
seizures and extrapyramidal symptoms. After the patient stabilizes then we need to
assess the patient comprehensively and also assess for withdrawal and further
management. The medical management of cocaine intoxication depending on the
organ involved has been given in several medical guidelines18,19.
6.2 Management of cocaine withdrawal:
Though cocaine withdrawal does not produce the severe symptoms as seen in alcohol
or heroin withdrawal and at one point of time its entity was debated, recent editions of
Diagnostic and Statistical Manual and International Classification of Diseases have
recognized it as a constellation of symptoms that occur after sudden cessation of
cocaine intake. Since cocaine has a relatively short half-life of 90 minutes hence
withdrawal symptoms may occur quite dramatically following the last dose particularly
in the intravenous route. Initial pioneering study on cocaine withdrawal was done by
Gawin and Klebel in 1980s. Using data from 30 out-patients they showed that there are
three distinct phases of cocaine withdrawal namely 'crash', 'withdrawal' and
'extinction'20. The phase one or 'the crash', developed rapidly following abrupt
cessation of heavy cocaine use and is characterised by acute dysphoria, irritability and
anxiety, increased desire for sleep, exhaustion, increased appetite, decreased craving to
use. Phase two, 'withdrawal' is characterised by increasing craving to use, poor
concentration, some irritability and some lethargy, which persisted for up to 10 weeks.
Phase three, 'extinction', comprises intermittent craving to use in the context of external
cues. Despite the relative persistence of this model to the clinical application of cocaine
withdrawal results from several other studies have not supported this model and they
rather predict a gradual return to the basal levels21. The withdrawal state is diagnosed as
per DSM-V or ICD-10. The severity of cocaine withdrawal has been related to increased
craving and early drop-out.
Management of cocaine withdrawal requires constant monitoring of signs and
symptoms of withdrawal. The goals of the withdrawal are a) To relieve patient's
discomfort, prevent the occurrence of more serious symptoms, and forestall cumulative
effects that might worsen future withdrawal; b) To utilise the withdrawal treatment
opportunity to engage patients in long-term management.
There are no well-studied pharmacological agents to relieve symptoms of cocaine
withdrawal. The evidence base is for dopamine agonists like amantadine and
bromocriptine. Amantadine appears to primarily exert its therapeutic influence by
releasing dopamine and norepinephrine from neuronal storage sites that are depleted
by chronic cocaine dependence.22 Amantadine has been found to be effective in double
blind placebo controlled studies to relieve the withdrawal symptoms in few studies23.
One study has also showed that patients with more severe baseline withdrawal had
more improvement compared to lower baseline24. The dose range used in these studies
is from 100-400 mg/day. There is one negative placebo controlled study too23. Although
amantadine is found useful in cocaine withdrawal but more studies are needed to settle
its exact role. Thus the role for amantadine in cocaine withdrawal still remains unclear
except in cases of severe withdrawal.
Bromocriptine acts as a dopamine agonist that stimulates dopamine receptors.
Bromocriptine was found to be reducing cocaine withdrawal in few studies though
recent studies have not proved its efficacy. When compared with amantadine,
bromocriptine was associated with reduced tolerability and increased drop-out the dose
range used in these studies is 2.5mg to 10mg.26
Propronolol is another drug which has been used with mixed efficacy. 27 A recent trial
which evaluated the efficacy of amantadine (300mg/day), propranolol (100mg/day) and
their combination in cocaine dependent patients with severe cocaine withdrawal
symptoms showed that none of the treatments were significantly more effective than
placebo. Propranolol treatment was associated with better treatment retention and
higher rates of cocaine abstinence compared to placebo.28
Though some drugs have been used the strength of evidence is at best 'D' and needs
further research using well planned randomised controlled design.
7. LONG TERM MANAGEMENT OF COCAINE USE DISORDERS
Cocaine dependence syndrome like any other addictive disorders is a chronic illness
with lapses and relapses. Medications and psychosocial strategies are used for
promoting abstinence and preventing relapse in patients with cocaine dependence. All
the pharmacological agents used in cocaine use disorders have been studied along with
psychosocial interventions. Hence clinicians should use whichever psychosocial
approach they think beneficial or is available along with pharmacological agents.
7.1 Pharmacological Agents
The pharmacological agents used broadly belong to psychostimulants, antiepileptics,
disulfiram, antipsychotics and antidepressants class. The current guideline is based on
evidence obtained from developed country (particularly USA) as there is none from
India. There is little recent evidence for use of topiramate and modafinil for cocaine
dependence.
7.1.1 Topiramate
7.1.1.1 Mechanism of action:
It is a fructose-related monosaccharide that is approved for the treatment of narcolepsy
and epilepsy. Chronic cocaine use leads to malfunction of the GABAergic inhibitory
pathways relative to the glutaminergic excitatory pathways in the dopaminergic
excitatory pathway.29,30 Hence it may be helpful in cocaine dependence as it works
through a multitude of mechanisms namely augmentation of the GABAergic pathways
and inhibition of the glutaminergic kainite and AMPA receptors and also by blockade of
voltage gated sodium and calcium channels-hence it is suitable for treating chronically
low GABA signalling in cocaine users.
7.1.1.2 Dosage:
Dosage ranged from 200mg/day to 300mg/day in the clinical trials. The rate of dosage
increase is 50 mg per week.
7.1.1.3 Evidence base
Efficacy of topiramate as an anti-craving agent has been seen in human volunteers under
controlled conditions in the laboratory. A pilot study (n=40) showed that topiramate up
to 200mg reduced cocaine usage in a 8 week trial.31 In another open-label RCT which
was a feasibility study in Netherlands on crack cocaine users it has been shown that the
efficacy of topiramate as an add-on to cognitive behavioural therapy (CBT) in crack-
cocaine dependent patient was generally low.32 Although 82% of the patients in the
experimental group agreed to start topiramate treatment), only 14% took topiramate for
at least 11 of the 12-weeks. There are two double blind placebo controlled RCT. In one
study which involved 170 cocaine and alcohol dependent subjects for 13 weeks
duration after achieving a period of abstinence, subjects were randomized to
topiramate, 300 mg daily, or identical placebo capsules in addition to weekly individual
psychotherapy. It has been found that cocaine was not better than placebo in the
primary outcome measures namely self-reported alcohol and cocaine use, and thrice
weekly urine drug screens.33 In another study (n=142) it was seen that topiramate was
more efficacious than placebo at increasing the primary outcome namely weekly
proportion of cocaine non-use days as well as increasing the likelihood of urinary
cocaine-free weeks as well as decreasing craving and improving observer-rated global
functioning days34. So, overall, the evidence for topiramate in the treatment of cocaine
dependence is mixed.
7.1.1.4 Conclusion:
Hence it can be said that though topiramate is now an emerging treatment; however,
because of the contradictory findings it cannot be recommended as yet a first line
therapy.
7.1.2 Modafinil
7.1.2.1 Mechanism:
Modafinil is a stimulant which is approved for the treatment of narcolepsy and shift work
sleep disorder. Its proposed mechanism of action is by blocking the dopamine
transporter and thereby increasing dopamine concentration in the extracellular space of
11
nucleus accumbens. Hence, working as a mild stimulant it can reduce stimulant
withdrawal and also suppress cocaine craving. Its action is, however, distinct from other
stimulants and there are other mechanisms - modafinil's effects in the brain involve
7.1.3 Disulfiram
7.1.3.1 Mechanism of action:
Disulfiram is being used in alcohol dependence for long time and its use in cocaine
dependence is of more recent onset. In cocaine dependence the proposed mechanism
of actions are at the level of monoamine neurotransmitters. Disulfiram has been shown
to chelate copper thereby inhibit dopamine beta hydroxylase resulting in excess of
dopamine and reduced norepinephrine. Disulfiram also inhibits carboxylesterase and
cholinesterase by unknown mechanisms43. This interferes with the metabolism of
cocaine, increasing plasma levels which may potentiate its cardiovascular effects
leading to adverse effects44.
7.1.3.2 Dosage:
62.5mg to 250mg.
7.1.3.3 Evidence base:
Randomized clinical trials of disulfiram as a treatment for cocaine dependence have
been inconsistent. Most studies have found that treatment with disulfiram (250 mg/d)
decreases cocaine use though one well-controlled study found that treatment with
lower doses of disulfiram (62.5 and 125 mg/d) increased cocaine use significantly. A
Cochrane review included seven controlled studies that randomised a total of 492
participants to receive disulfiram, a placebo, no pharmacological treatment or
naltrexone in addition to psychosocial treatment. Disulfiram showed a trend toward
fewer dropouts from psychosocial treatment when compared to placebo (three trials) or
Naltrexone (three trials) but this was not statistically significant45.
7.1.3.4 Conclusion:
Disulfiram may be used in cocaine dependence though definite evidence is lacking
regarding its efficacy.
7.1.4 Stimulants
7.1.4.1 Mechanism of Action:
In cocaine dependence agonist substitution or replacement therapy has also been tried.
Here a similar but less harmful chemical with the intention of harm reduction as done in
opioid has been tried for cocaine dependence. The ideal drug which should be used for
replacement or substitution should have a similar mechanism of action and also there
should be suppression of craving, act for a longer time and should not be as strongly
reinforcing as the substance substituted for. Ideally a substituting agent should have a
similar mechanism of action, onset of action should be slower but it should be longer
acting. In fact preclinical animal studies and laboratory based studies show that the
behavioural and reinforcing effects of cocaine, amphetamine, methylphenidate are
similar46. Hence they can act as replacements.
However, there are some neurobiological explanations also for example it has been
proposed that methylphenidate improves the neurocognitive functioning in cocaine
users who can therefore use it as a pre-requisite for psychosocial interventions.
The main drugs used are methylphenidate, amphetamine, modafinil, bupropion,
mazindol, methamphetamine and selegeline47. Modafinil has been described already
above.
7.1.4.2 Amphetamine
7.1.4.2.1 Mechanism of action:
Amphetamine acts as direct releasers of monoamines at the nerve terminals.
7.1.4.2.2 Dosage:
Dextro-amphetamine 15-30 mg
7.1.4.2.3 Evidence base:
Double blind RCT study have shown to decrease cocaine use though there were
contradictory result48,49. One trial has also been conducted with methamphetamine
sustained release and another pilot trial with lisdexamphetamine. The former showed
significant improvement whereas the latter showed non-significant decrease in use50,51.
These studies have only small number of cases and research is difficult with these drugs
as they are all controlled drugs46.
7.1.4.2.4 Conclusion: No evidence currently for using methamphetamine or
dextroamphetamine.
7.1.4.3.1 Methylphenidate (MPH):
MPH is currently used commonly for attention deficit hyperactive disorder (ADHD).
MPH as per literature was first used by Khantzian to decrease cocaine use52.
7.1.4.3.2 Dosage:
60 – 90 mg/day
7.1.4.3.3 Evidence Base:
There are several open label studies which have showed that MPH is useful and there
are equally good number of studies which have showed negative result53,54. Recently
few double blind placebo controlled studies which have showed that MPH is useful in
the fixed doses of up to 60mg/day. For heavy cocaine users more than 90mg have been
advised. However, only a very few studies have tested high dosage of MPH46. These
studies have several methodological problems- hence they are to be interpreted with
caution.
7.1.4.3.4 Conclusion:
At present due to inadequate evidence methylphenidate cannot be recommended for
long term treatment of cocaine dependence.
7.1.5 Anticonvulsants:
7.1.5.1 Mechanism of Action:
The 'seizure kindling' mechanism has also been hypothesized to be an explanation
for addictive disorder. Hence, almost all anticonvulsants ranging from carbamazepine,
tiagabine, gabapentin, lamotrigine, topiramate, valproate, phenobarbital, phenytoin
and vigabatrin have been used56, 57,58,59, 60,61. These anticonvulsants potentiate the GABA-
ergic mechanisms which may lead to decrease of dopaminergic tone of the nucleus
accumbens thereby decreasing cocaine re-instatement and cocaine self-
administration62. Topiramate as an anticonvulsant has shown some encouraging results
so it has been discussed separately.
7.1.5.2 Evidence base:
A recent Cochrane review compared anticonvulsants with placebo and found no
significant differences for any of the primary outcomes measures namely drop-out, use
of cocaine by urinalysis or self-report, adverse effects and secondary outcomes namely
compliance, craving, severity of dependence, depression and anxiety when
anticonvulsants were compared with placebo63.
7.1.6 Antipsychotics:
7.1.6.1 Mechanism of action:
Acute cocaine use leads to an increase in dopamine secretion in certain brain areas
whereas chronic cocaine use leads to reduced dopamine tone. So anti-psychotics have
not been favoured much because of the proposition that they would decrease the
dopamine tone further and lead to more hedonic deficiency and subsequently further
increase in cocaine intake64. However, with the advent of the atypical anti-psychotics
there has been renewed interest in this topic as they are acting not only on the
dopaminergic pathways but also on the serotonergic pathways. Most of the older
studies have been conducted with haloperidol whereas the newer studies have been
conducted with olanzapine, risperidone, quetiapine and aripriprazole and have been
used in cocaine dependence in association with schizophrenia or bipolar
illness65,66,67,68,69,70.
7.1.6.2 Dosage:
Olanzapine 5 - 10mg/day; Risperidone: 1mg to 4mg/day; Haloperidol: 4 and 10mg/day;
Quetiapine: 400mg/day
7.1.6.3 Evidence base:
In few studies risperidone was effective in reducing the number of drop-outs and
effective in treatment retention. Haloperidol and olanzapine were each found to reduce
craving with respect to placebo though there were contradictory findings in other
studies and the sample size was too small to be conclusive65,69. A cochrane review
regarding the usefulness of anti-psychotics in the treatment of cocaine use disorder
70 © Indian Psychiatric Society 2016
Cocaine
which included seven studies (N=293) found no significant differences for any of the
efficacy measures comparing antipsychotics like haloperidol, risperidone and
olanzapine with placebo. In a recent meta-analysis which included ten studies
(risperidone=5, olanzapine=3, reserpine=2; N=562) with primary cocaine
dependence concluded that antipsychotics did not differ from placebo with regard to
cocaine use days and lack of cocaine abstinence, severity of addiction, cocaine craving,
Clinical Global Impressions-Severity of Illness (CGI-S) scores, depression, anxiety,
compliance, all-cause discontinuation, and several side effects. However,
antipsychotics caused more intolerability-related discontinuation than placebo. For
quetiapine initial open-label studies showed efficacy when used at a dosage of
400mg/day in suppressing cocaine use and craving in non-psychotic patients. There is
a double-blind, randomized, placebo-controlled study for 12-week, involving cocaine
dependence syndrome with quetiapine (N=31) which showed that there is no
significant benefit of quetiapine compared to placebo (N=31) on self-report of cocaine
use and money spent on cocaine as well as urine drug screens73.
Methodology-wise most of studies had small sample sizes and measured treatment
retention or drop-out as the main outcome measures though some studies measured
craving as a secondary outcome measure. Also some of the studies had co-morbid
heroin dependence and were maintained on methadone .
7.1.6.4 Conclusion:
Currently there is inadequate evidence to suggest the use of anti-psychotics in non-
psychotic patients with cocaine use disorder.
7.1.5 Antidepressants:
7.1.5.1 Mechanism of action:
Acute cocaine use leads to increase of monoamines namely dopamine, serotonin and
nor-epinephrine. However, with chronic use there is deficiency of the mono-amines –
so use of anti-depressants may lead to stabilization of the brain mono-amine levels and
hence amelioration of the short and long-term symptoms related to cocaine abstinence.
Also neuroimaging studies have shown that the areas of the brain activated are often
common between cocaine use disorder and mood disorder – this is probably best
illustrated by the mood symptoms during cocaine withdrawal. The most common anti-
depressants which have been studied are desipramine, fluoxetine and bupropion74,75.
Other antidepressants which have been studied are nefazodone, ritanserin, buspirone,
gepirone, paroxetine, citalopram, venlafaxine, selegiline, tryptophan, sertraline, and
imipramine76.
7.1.5.2 Dosage:
Desipramine: 75 -300mg/day; Fluoxetine: 20-60mg/day; Bupropion: 300mg/day
adverse effects which did not lead to serious consequences or death. They concluded
that the vaccine was safe. At 16 weeks there was no difference in abstinence rate as
measured by cocaine positive urine rates with placebo81. Addressing the anti-cocaine
antibodies level dropping further will have a role in anti-cocaine vaccine efficacy.
Conclusion:
Currently there is not much strong evidence to recommend the use of cocaine vaccine.
7.1.8 Other medications:
Other medications that have been used are ondansetron, baclofen, have found to be
useful but need further RCTs to prove their efficacy82,83.
7.1.9.1 Combinations of medications:
Studies have been done using combination of pharmacotherapy. The combinations
have been used as per the tentative underlying neurobiological basis of the
medications.
7.1.9.2 Dosage:
Medications used have been a combination of naltrexone (50 mg) and isradipine(10
mg), bromocriptine and desipramine (200 mg/day), I-tryptophan (1 g/day) and I-tyrosine
(1 g/day), amantadine (300mg/d) and propranolol (100mg/d), disulfiram (250
mg/day)and Naltrexone (100 mg/day) , metyrapone (500 mg/day) and oxazepam (20
mg/day) mixed amphetamine salts (60mg/day) and topiramate (300 mg/day) combined
d-amphetamine(60mg/d) and modafinil, (400mg/day)84,85,28,86,87,88,89.
7.1.9.3 Evidence base:
Among the double blind randomized controlled trials done with the above
combination of medications most are negative studies except the study with
amphetamine salts and topiramate (3 months abstinence).90
7.1.9.4 Conclusion:
There is need for well conducted studies to recommend the use of combinations in
cocaine dependence.
7.2 Psychosocial Treatment
As we have seen none of the pharmacotherapies have very good efficacy – hence
psychosocial interventions take an important role in the treatment of cocaine
dependence/ problem. A variety of psychosocial strategies have been used in cocaine
dependence. The different approaches that have been taken for the treatment are
behavioural approaches like contingency management, comprehensive strategies like
community reinforcement approach, cognitive behaviour treatment, twelve step
oriented treatment, self-help group and newer generation psychotherapies like
mindfulness based therapy.
of multiple sessions focussing on social skills and involvement of the patient in the form
of home-work assignments. Studies have shown that CBT is effective95.Others studies
with larger sample sizes, have not found it to be uniquely effective. Studying the
methodology of the individual studies it may be concluded that CBT was more effective
when there have been a longer duration of use and that for shorter duration it may not be
more effective96.
Among the important therapies namely contingency management, CRA and CBT it is
worthwhile to compare amongst them. The Cochrane review observed that although
the CBT seemed to be a promising however in the short term contingency based
approaches appear to be more important. However, in the longer run CBT has more
efficacy, though such studies are difficult, as was concluded by the Cochrane review
where they highlighted the significant heterogeneity of the studies as well as the
therapist specific issues97. This has led to the development of computer based CBT
which can be used in longer term and which also holds promise in terms of efficacy98.
7.2.3 Twelve step facilitation program (TSF): It is based on the principles of twelve step
program whereby spiritual elements are included in the self-help group intervention.
Here the patients undergo a fellowship where under the guidance of a 'sponsor' they
take a pledge whereby he surrenders to the Almighty and tends to discuss all causes of
relapse and other hindrances faced in day to day dealing with substances. Similar
programmes which deals with substances namely the alcohol anonymous, narcotics
anonymous. Now evidence is also accruing favouring TSF. A randomized, placebo-
controlled, double blind medication, with 4 treatment conditions: disulfiram plus TSF,
disulfiram plus standard counseling only, placebo plus TSF, and placebo plus standard
counseling in the context of a community-based methadone maintenance program on
112 participants showed that assignment to TSF was associated with less cocaine use
throughout treatment and a higher number of cocaine-negative urines. Hence 12 steps
therapy appears to be of benefit to methadone maintaining patients using cocaine99.
7.2.4 Motivational enhancement therapy (MET): This intervention is based upon
Rogerian principles. MET is a client oriented, flexible, empathetic, non-judgemental
approach which helps in motivational enhancement. Though has been an underlying
principle in most of interviewing in substance use disorder yet structured intervention
has also been done. Two sessions of motivational interventions showed that patients
with poor coping skills decrease cocaine use irrespective of their poor motivation100.
Another study using same design did not find any benefit – hence MET may not be
efficacious in all scenarios though it needs to be an essential component of client
interactions100.
7.2.5 Other psychotherapeutic approaches: Other newer psychotherapeutic
approaches have been tried like “third wave” behavioural therapies, including
Acceptance and Commitment Therapy (ACT), Dialectical Behaviour Therapy (DBT),
Mindfulness-Based Stress Reduction (MBSR) and Transcendental Meditation (TM).
These have not been empirically validated though holds promise in future102.
7.2.6 Conclusion: There are no data supporting a single treatment approach that is able
to account for the multidimensional facets of addiction patterns and to significantly
yield better outcomes to resolve the chronic, relapsing nature of addiction, with all its
correlates and consequences. However, contingency management, community based
reinforcement approaches and CBT have the highest efficacy in RCTs as per current
evidence available.
7.3 Combined psychosocial and pharmacological management:
All the pharmacological agents used in cocaine use disorders have been studied along
with psychosocial interventions. Many of the RCTs have given positive results 92,31,103,104
and a few studies have given negative results75,54. Hence clinicians should use
whichever psychosocial approach they think beneficial or is available along with
pharmacological agents (A).
8.0 SPECIAL POPULATIONS
8.1 Pregnancy
A fallout of the 'cocaine epidemic' in western countries has been use of cocaine in
pregnant mothers. Though initially it was reported from United States later it came to be
reported from other countries including Europe. The epidemiological burden is
illustrated by the fact that in a recent study of over 3,000 neonates – although 11% of the
women reported using illicit drugs during pregnancy, 31% of the infants meconium
tested positive for cocaine alone2. Apart from the direct effects of cocaine on the in utero
fetus, other factors may also be responsible for the adverse outcome namely poor
nutrition and poor antenatal care. A recent meta-analysis found that prenatal cocaine
exposure is significantly associated with preterm birth, low birth weight, and small for
gestational age infants105. The long-term effects of prenatal cocaine exposure on
cognitive, motor, and language development have been inconsistent106. This
inconsistency is likely related to the confounding effects of the postnatal environment,
including dysfunctional parenting and unstable, chaotic home environments, and
frequent poly-substance use in the mother107. Till date there are no published reports of
cocaine related effects in the offsprings of cocaine using mothers from India.
8.1.1 Evidence base: Pregnancy itself is a great motivating force for women to quit and it
was found that among pregnant women using cocaine before pregnancy, 73% were
abstinent during pregnancy108. Most evidence in the treatment of cocaine using pregnant
mothers is in the use of CBT, 12 step process and contingency management (CM). In a
recent randomized trial comparing CM to community reinforcement approach and 12-
step facilitation, CM was associated with significantly greater duration of cocaine
abstinence, higher proportion of cocaine-negative urine tests and higher proportion of
documented abstinence across the study period 109. Pharmacological treatments have
not proved to be effective except the fact that a recent preliminary RCT with micronized
progesterone have found some efficacy in achieving abstinence in the post-partum
period110.
8.1.2 Conclusion:
Cocaine use in the pregnant women is through psychosocial interventions particularly
contingency management.
8.2 Attention Deficit Hyperactivity Disorder
In the general population, the prevalence of adult ADHD is 4.4%, while in individuals
with a substance use disorder, ADHD co-occurs at a rate of 10.8% with some studies
showing a prevalence of up to 30%111. The reason of increased cocaine use in the
ADHD population due to relief of depressive symptoms and anxiety arising out of the
illness. Hence self-medication hypothesis by EJ Khantzian has been propounded to be
the most important in establishing this co-morbidity. So use of stimulants as treatment is
a usual choice in this population apart from other medications like bupropion46.
8.2.1 Evidence base:
Methylphenidate (MPH) is one of the most commonly used stimulant in ADHD with co-
morbid cocaine use disorder. Among the three RCTs which have used, MPH in one
study showed some efficacy with decreased intake of cocaine – however, that study was
characterised by increased drop-out rate112. Also bupropion was not found to be more
efficacious when compared to placebo in an RCT. Stimulant therapy of ADHD in
childhood is associated with a reduction in the risk for subsequent drug and alcohol use
disorders. However, caution needs to be maintained about the abusive potential of
stimulants in this sub-group.
8.2.2 Conclusion:
At present there is no efficacy of any particular medication particularly stimulants
(methylphenidate) in cocaine dependence with ADHD.
9. RECOMMENDATIONS
9.1 Some issues to be considered before arriving at recommendations
l The proposed guideline is based on evidence obtained from developed country
(particularly USA) and none from India.
l Manifestations of cocaine intoxication and withdrawal are non specific and are
mostly self- limiting.
l Psychosocial interventions have reasonable evidence base and are recommended for
cocaine use disorders.
9.2 Recommendations
9.2.1 Management of Intoxication and withdrawal
There is no convincing evidence supporting the use of pharmacological treatment for
cocaine use disorder.
9.2.2 Management of cocaine dependence
Psychosocial treatments are the mainstay of treatment - contingency management,
community based reinforcement approaches and CBT have the highest efficacy. Other
therapies like MET, mindfulness based therapies needs further research.
Evidence for drug treatment is still preliminary – pharmacological treatment should be
used in combination with psychosocial therapies (A). Modafinil and topiramate are
emerging as prospective medications though currently evidence is not unequivocal and
contradictory evidences exist (C). Currently disulfiram, dopamine agonists,
antidepressants, anticonvulsants (except topiramate), psychostimulants, neither any
combination of these medications are recommended. Cocaine vaccine has been found
to be safe and shown promising results in Phase 1 & 2 research but not so promising
response in Phase 3.
REFERENCES
1. Karch SB. A Brief History of Cocaine, Second Edition. CRC Press; 2005. 232 p.
2. Ruiz P, Strain EC. Lowinson and Ruiz's Substance Abuse: A Comprehensive
Textbook. Lippincott Williams & Wilkins; 2011. 1104 p.
3. WDR 2015 - Use of drugs [Internet]. Tableau Software. [cited 2015 Nov 30]. Available
from: http://public.tableau.com/views/WDR2015
4. EMCDDA | European Drug Report 2014: Trends and developments [Internet]. [cited
2015 Sep 27]. Available from: http://www.emcdda.europa.eu/publications/
edr/trends-developments/2014
5. Basu D, Gupta S, Nebhinani N, Mattoo SK. Cocaine dependence: a case series from
India. Natl Med J India. 2014 Feb;27(1):12-4.
6. Mehta SH, Srikrishnan AK, Noble E, Vasudevan CK, Solomon S, Kumar MS, et al.
Emergence of cocaine and methamphetamine injection among HIV-positive injection
drug users in northern and western India. Drug Alcohol Depend. 2014 Feb
1;135:160-5.
7. Zimmerman JL. Cocaine intoxication. Crit Care Clin. 2012 Oct;28(4):517-26.
8. McCreary AC, Müller CP, Filip M. Psychostimulants: Basic and Clinical
Pharmacology. Int Rev Neurobiol. 2015;120:41-83.
9. Goldstein RA, DesLauriers C, Burda AM. Cocaine: history, social implications, and
toxicity--a review. Dis--Mon DM. 2009 Jan;55(1):6-38.
10. Brookoff D, Rotondo MF, Shaw LM, Campbell EA, Fields L. Coacaethylene levels in
patients who test positive for cocaine. Ann Emerg Med. 1996 Mar;27(3):316-20.
11. Volkow ND, Fowler JS, Logan J, Alexoff D, Zhu W, Telang F, et al. Effects of modafinil
on dopamine and dopamine transporters in the male human brain: clinical
implications. JAMA. 2009 Mar 18;301(11):1148-54.
12. Dela Peña I, Gevorkiana R, Shi W-X. Psychostimulants affect dopamine transmission
through both dopamine transporter-dependent and independent mechanisms. Eur J
Pharmacol. 2015 Jul 21;764:562-70.
13. Gray JD. Medical consequences of cocaine. Can Fam Physician Médecin Fam Can.
1993 Sep;39:1975-6, 1979-81.
14. Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Mental Disorders (DSM-5®) [Internet]. [cited
2015 Sep 23]. Available from: http://www.appi.org/Course/Book/Subscription/
JournalSubscription/id-3322/Diagnostic_and_Statistical_Manual_of_
Mental_Disorders.
15. Association AP. Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Mental Disorders: DSM-IV-TR.
American Psychiatric Association; 2000. 1002 p.
16. Drug use disorders | Guidance and guidelines | NICE [Internet]. [cited 2015 Oct 1].
Available from: https://www.nice.org.uk/guidance/qs23
17. American Psychiatric Association. The American Psychiatric Association Practice
Guidelines for the Psychiatric Evaluation of Adults [Internet]. American Psychiatric
Association; 2015 [cited 2015 Oct 1]. -1 p. Available from:
http://psychiatryonline.org/doi/book/10.1176/appi.books.9780890426760
18. Broderick J, Connolly S, Feldmann E, Hanley D, Kase C, Krieger D, et al. Guidelines
for the management of spontaneous intracerebral hemorrhage in adults: 2007 update:
a guideline from the American Heart Association/American Stroke Association Stroke
Council, High Blood Pressure Research Council, and the Quality of Care and
Outcomes in Research Interdisciplinary Working Group. Stroke J Cereb Circ. 2007
Jun;38(6):2001-23.
19. McCord J, Jneid H, Hollander JE, de Lemos JA, Cercek B, Hsue P, et al. Management of
cocaine-associated chest pain and myocardial infarction: a scientific statement from
the American Heart Association Acute Cardiac Care Committee of the Council on
Clinical Cardiology. Circulation. 2008 Apr 8;117(14):1897-907.
20. Gawin FH, Kleber HD. Abstinence symptomatology and psychiatric diagnosis in
cocaine abusers. Clinical observations. Arch Gen Psychiatry. 1986 Feb;43(2):107-13.
21. Coffey SF, Dansky BS, Carrigan MH, Brady KT. Acute and protracted cocaine
abstinence in an outpatient population: a prospective study of mood, sleep and
withdrawal symptoms. Drug Alcohol Depend. 2000 Jun 1;59(3):277-86.
22. Thompson DF. Amantadine in the treatment of cocaine withdrawal. Ann
Pharmacother. 1992 Aug;26(7-8):933-4.
23. Kampman K, Volpicelli JR, Alterman A, Cornish J, Weinrieb R, Epperson L, et al.
Amantadine in the early treatment of cocaine dependence: a double-blind, placebo-
50. Mooney ME, Herin DV, Schmitz JM, Moukaddam N, Green CE, Grabowski J. Effects
of oral methamphetamine on cocaine use: a randomized, double-blind, placebo-
controlled trial. Drug Alcohol Depend. 2009 Apr 1;101(1-2):34-41.
51. Mooney ME, Herin DV, Specker S, Babb D, Levin FR, Grabowski J. Pilot study of the
effects of lisdexamfetamine on cocaine use: A randomized, double-blind, placebo-
controlled trial. Drug Alcohol Depend. 2015 Aug 1;153:94-103.
52. Khantzian EJ. An extreme case of cocaine dependence and marked improvement with
methylphenidate treatment. Am J Psychiatry. 1983 Jun;140(6):784-5.
53. Dürsteler KM, Berger E-M, Strasser J, Caflisch C, Mutschler J, Herdener M, et al.
Clinical potential of methylphenidate in the treatment of cocaine addiction: a review
of the current evidence. Subst Abuse Rehabil. 2015;6:61-74.
54. Dürsteler-MacFarland KM, Farronato NS, Strasser J, Boss J, Kuntze MF, Petitjean SA, et
al. A randomized, controlled, pilot trial of methylphenidate and cognitive-
behavioural group therapy for cocaine dependence in heroin prescription. J Clin
Psychopharmacol. 2013 Feb;33(1):104-8.
55. Kranzler HR, Bauer LO, Hersh D, Klinghoffer V. Carbamazepine treatment of cocaine
dependence: a placebo-controlled trial. Drug Alcohol Depend. 1995 Jun;38(3):203-11.
56. Hart CL, Haney M, Vosburg SK, Rubin E, Foltin RW. Gabapentin does not reduce
smoked cocaine self-administration: employment of a novel self-administration
procedure. Behav Pharmacol. 2007 Feb;18(1):71-5.
57. Winhusen T, Somoza E, Ciraulo DA, Harrer JM, Goldsmith RJ, Grabowski J, et al. A
double-blind, placebo-controlled trial of tiagabine for the treatment of cocaine
dependence. Drug Alcohol Depend. 2007 Dec 1;91(2-3):141-8.
58. Sofuoglu M, Pentel PR, Bliss RL, Goldman AI, Hatsukami DK. Effects of phenytoin on
cocaine self-administration in humans. Drug Alcohol Depend. 1999 Feb 1;53(3):273-5.
59. Reid MS, Thakkar V. Valproate treatment and cocaine cue reactivity in cocaine
dependent individuals. Drug Alcohol Depend. 2009 Jun 1;102(1-3):144-50.
60. Lima AR, Lima MS, Soares BG, Farrell M. Carbamazepine for cocaine dependence.
Cochrane Database Syst Rev. 2002;(2):CD002023.
61. Somoza EC, Winship D, Gorodetzky CW, Lewis D, Ciraulo DA, Galloway GP, et al. A
multisite, double-blind, placebo-controlled clinical trial to evaluate the safety and
efficacy of vigabatrin for treating cocaine dependence. JAMA Psychiatry. 2013
Jun;70(6):630-7.
62. Koob GF, Nestler EJ. The neurobiology of drug addiction. J Neuropsychiatry Clin
Neurosci. 1997;9(3):482-97.
63. Minozzi S, Cinquini M, Amato L, Davoli M, Farrell MF, Pani PP, et al. Anticonvulsants
for cocaine dependence. Cochrane Database Syst Rev. 2015;4:CD006754.
64. Kuhar MJ, Pilotte NS. Neurochemical changes in cocaine withdrawal. Trends
Pharmacol Sci. 1996 Jul;17(7):260-4.
65. Berger SP, Hall S, Mickalian JD, Reid MS, Crawford CA, Delucchi K, et al. Haloperidol
agonists for the treatment of cocaine dependence. Cochrane Database Syst Rev.
2015;5:CD003352.
79. Haney M, Gunderson EW, Jiang H, Collins ED, Foltin RW. Cocaine-specific
antibodies blunt the subjective effects of smoked cocaine in humans. Biol Psychiatry.
2010 Jan 1;67(1):59-65.
80. Orson FM, Wang R, Brimijoin S, Kinsey BM, Singh RA, Ramakrishnan M, et al. The
future potential for cocaine vaccines. Expert Opin Biol Ther. 2014 Sep;14(9):1271-83.
81. Kosten TR, Domingo CB, Shorter D, Orson F, Green C, Somoza E, et al. Vaccine for
cocaine dependence: a randomized double-blind placebo-controlled efficacy trial.
Drug Alcohol Depend. 2014 Jul 1;140:42-7.
82. Kahn R, Biswas K, Childress A-R, Shoptaw S, Fudala PJ, Gorgon L, et al. Multi-center
trial of baclofen for abstinence initiation in severe cocaine-dependent individuals.
Drug Alcohol Depend. 2009 Jul 1;103(1-2):59-64.
83. Johnson BA, Roache JD, Ait-Daoud N, Javors MA, Harrison JM, Elkashef A, et al. A
preliminary randomized, double-blind, placebo-controlled study of the safety and
efficacy of ondansetron in the treatment of cocaine dependence. Drug Alcohol
Depend. 2006 Oct 1;84(3):256-63.
84. Sofuoglu M, Singha A, Kosten TR, McCance-Katz FE, Petrakis I, Oliveto A. Effects of
naltrexone and isradipine, alone or in combination, on cocaine responses in humans.
Pharmacol Biochem Behav. 2003 Jul;75(4):801-8.
85. Giannini AJ, Billett W. Bromocriptine-desipramine protocol in treatment of cocaine
addiction. J Clin Pharmacol. 1987 Aug;27(8):549-54.
86. Pettinati HM, Kampman KM, Lynch KG, Xie H, Dackis C, Rabinowitz AR, et al. A
double blind, placebo-controlled trial that combines disulfiram and naltrexone for
treating co-occurring cocaine and alcohol dependence. Addict Behav. 2008
May;33(5):651-67.
87. Kablinger AS, Lindner MA, Casso S, Hefti F, DeMuth G, Fox BS, et al. Effects of the
combination of metyrapone and oxazepam on cocaine craving and cocaine taking: a
double-blind, randomized, placebo-controlled pilot study. J Psychopharmacol Oxf
Engl. 2012 Jul;26(7):973-81.
88. Mariani JJ, Pavlicova M, Bisaga A, Nunes EV, Brooks DJ, Levin FR. Extended-release
mixed amphetamine salts and topiramate for cocaine dependence: a randomized
controlled trial. Biol Psychiatry. 2012 Dec 1;72(11):950-6.
89. Schmitz JM, Rathnayaka N, Green CE, Moeller FG, Dougherty AE, Grabowski J.
Combination of Modafinil and d-amphetamine for the Treatment of Cocaine
Dependence: A Preliminary Investigation. Front Psychiatry. 2012;3:77.
90. Mariani JJ, Pavlicova M, Bisaga A, Nunes EV, Brooks DJ, Levin FR. Extended-release
mixed amphetamine salts and topiramate for cocaine dependence: a randomized
controlled trial. Biol Psychiatry. 2012 Dec 1;72(11):950-6.
91. Higgins ST, Alessi SM, Dantona RL. Voucher-based incentives. A substance abuse
treatment innovation. Addict Behav. 2002 Dec;27(6):887-910.
92. Dutra L, Stathopoulou G, Basden SL, Leyro TM, Powers MB, Otto MW. A meta-
analytic review of psychosocial interventions for substance use disorders. Am J
Psychiatry. 2008 Feb;165(2):179-87.
93. Higgins ST, Budney AJ, Bickel WK, Foerg FE, Donham R, Badger GJ. Incentives
improve outcome in outpatient behavioural treatment of cocaine dependence. Arch
Gen Psychiatry. 1994 Jul;51(7):568-76.
94. García-Fernández G, Secades-Villa R, García-Rodríguez O, Sánchez-Hervás E,
Fernández-Hermida JR, Higgins ST. Adding voucher-based incentives to community
reinforcement approach improves outcomes during treatment for cocaine
dependence. Am J Addict Am Acad Psychiatr Alcohol Addict. 2011 Oct;20(5):456-61.
95. Carroll KM, Nich C, Ball SA. Practice makes progress? Homework assignments and
outcome in treatment of cocaine dependence. J Consult Clin Psychol. 2005
Aug;73(4):749-55.
96. Crits-Christoph P, Siqueland L, Blaine J, Frank A, Luborsky L, Onken LS, et al.
Psychosocial treatments for cocaine dependence: National Institute on Drug Abuse
Collaborative Cocaine Treatment Study. Arch Gen Psychiatry. 1999 Jun;56(6):493-502.
97. Knapp WP, Soares BGO, Farrel M, Lima MS. Psychosocial interventions for cocaine
and psychostimulant amphetamines related disorders. Cochrane Database Syst Rev.
2007;(3):CD003023.
98. Carroll KM, Ball SA, Martino S, Nich C, Babuscio TA, Rounsaville BJ. Enduring effects
of a computer-assisted training program for cognitive behavioural therapy: a 6-month
follow-up of CBT4CBT. Drug Alcohol Depend. 2009 Feb 1;100(1-2):178-81.
99. Carroll KM, Nich C, Shi JM, Eagan D, Ball SA. Efficacy of disulfiram and Twelve Step
Facilitation in cocaine-dependent individuals maintained on methadone: a
randomized placebo-controlled trial. Drug Alcohol Depend. 2012 Nov 1;126(1-
2):224-31.
100. Stotts AL, Schmitz JM, Rhoades HM, Grabowski J. Motivational interviewing with
cocaine-dependent patients: a pilot study. J Consult Clin Psychol. 2001
Oct;69(5):858-62.
101. Rohsenow DJ, Monti PM, Martin RA, Colby SM, Myers MG, Gulliver SB, et al.
Motivational enhancement and coping skills training for cocaine abusers: effects on
substance use outcomes. Addict Abingdon Engl. 2004 Jul;99(7):862-74.
102. Penberthy JK, Ait-Daoud N, Vaughan M, Fanning T. Review of treatment for cocaine
dependence. Curr Drug Abuse Rev. 2010 Mar;3(1):49-62.
103. Carroll KM, Fenton LR, Ball SA, Nich C, Frankforter TL, Shi J, et al. Efficacy of
disulfiram and cognitive behaviour therapy in cocaine-dependent outpatients: a
randomized placebo-controlled trial. Arch Gen Psychiatry. 2004 Mar;61(3):264-72.
104. Schmitz JM, Mooney ME, Moeller FG, Stotts AL, Green C, Grabowski J. Levodopa
pharmacotherapy for cocaine dependence: choosing the optimal behavioural therapy
platform. Drug Alcohol Depend. 2008 Apr 1;94(1-3):142-50.
105. Gouin K, Murphy K, Shah PS, Knowledge Synthesis group on Determinants of Low
Birth Weight and Preterm Births. Effects of cocaine use during pregnancy on low
birthweight and preterm birth: systematic review and metaanalyses. Am J Obstet
Gynecol. 2011 Apr;204(4):340.e1-12.
106. Forray A, Foster D. Substance Use in the Perinatal Period. Curr Psychiatry Rep. 2015
Nov;17(11):91.
107. Mansoor E, Morrow CE, Accornero VH, Xue L, Johnson AL, Anthony JC, et al.
Longitudinal effects of prenatal cocaine use on mother-child interactions at ages 3 and
5 years. J Dev Behav Pediatr JDBP. 2012 Jan;33(1):32-41.
108. Forray A, Merry B, Lin H, Ruger JP, Yonkers KA. Perinatal substance use: a prospective
evaluation of abstinence and relapse. Drug Alcohol Depend. 2015 May 1;150:147-
55.
109. Schottenfeld RS, Moore B, Pantalon MV. Contingency management with community
reinforcement approach or twelve-step facilitation drug counseling for cocaine
dependent pregnant women or women with young children. Drug Alcohol Depend.
2011 Oct 1;118(1):48-55.
110. Yonkers KA, Forray A, Nich C, Carroll KM, Hine C, Merry BC, et al. Progesterone
Reduces Cocaine Use in Postpartum Women with a Cocaine Use Disorder: A
Randomized,Double-Blind Study. Lancet Psychiatry. 2014 Oct 1;1(5):360-7.
111. Kessler RC, Adler L, Barkley R, Biederman J, Conners CK, Demler O, et al. The
prevalence and correlates of adult ADHD in the United States: results from the
National Comorbidity Survey Replication. Am J Psychiatry. 2006 Apr;163(4):716-23.
112. Dürsteler KM, Berger E-M, Strasser J, Caflisch C, Mutschler J, Herdener M, et al.
Clinical potential of methylphenidate in the treatment of cocaine addiction: a review
of the current evidence. Subst Abuse Rehabil. 2015;6:61-74.
Atul Ambekar
Shrigopal Goyal
On behalf of
Indian Psychiatric Society
Specialty Section on Substance Use Disorders
2016
Amphetamine-type Stimulants (ATS)
CONTENTS
Executive Summary
1. Introduction
1.1 History
1.2 Epidemiology
1.2.1 Global
1.2.2 Asia
1.2.3 India
1.3 Neuropharmacology
2. Who uses Amphetamine/Methamphetamine
2.1 Who are more prone? Population group at-risk of ATS use
3. Amphetamine use Disorders
3.1 Dependence
3.2 Routes of amphetamine administration and pattern of amphetamine use
3.3 Effects of ATS
3.3.1 Acute Effects
3.3.2 Consequences of amphetamine use
3.3.3 Health consequences of amphetamine use
3.4 Hazards-Psychological
3.4.1 Paranoid psychosis
3.4.2 Depression
3.5 Amphetamine withdrawal
3.6 Use during pregnancy and perinatal period
3.7 Death among ATS users
3.8 Consequences of amphetamine use in the context of polydrug use
4. Management
4.1 Amphetamine Psychosis
4.2 Treatment of ATS withdrawal
4.3 Treatment of amphetamine use disorders
4.3.1 Pharmacological treatment
EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
Amphetamine-type stimulants “(ATS)” or 'psychostimulants' are synthetic drugs that
excite or speed up the nervous system and produce effects similar to adrenaline. They
are highly euphoriogenic and consequently have a moderate degree of addictive
potential. Use of these substances is associated with a wide variety of physical,
psychological and social harms. Their use is growing in many parts of the world. In
India, though the use remains low as of now, there is recent evidence that ATS use may
be spreading in various parts of the country and hence clinicians need to be aware of
management of ATS use disorders.
For management of acute amphetamine psychosis, dopamine antagonists or 'anti-
psychotics' like chlorpromazine or haloperidol are indicated. The use of ascorbic acid
can accelerate the renal elimination of amphetamines.
ATS withdrawal is generally not medically hazardous though it can be associated with
depression. No medication has been demonstrated to be effective in alleviating
amphetamine withdrawal, but some medications may be useful. Antidepressants have
been used for withdrawal-induced depression with some benefit. Short-term use of
benzodiazepines (diazepam 5 to 10mg QID SOS) and antipsychotics (olanzapine 2.5-
5mg BD SOS) for control of irritability and agitation can be helpful.
The evidence-base for the treatment of ATS dependence is rather limited. The evidence
shows that various treatment agent like naltrexone, risperidone, modafinil, serotonin
reuptake inhibitor, bupropion have been tried but demonstrate very limited benefits for
amphetamine dependence. There are as yet no approved pharmacological treatments
for ATS users which are based upon the philosophy and principles of substitution
treatment (such as methadone or buprenorphine for opioid dependence). Maintenance
on prescribed amphetamines has been demonstrated to reduce the use of street
amphetamines.
Among psycho-social interventions, an eclectic “stepped-care approach” has been
developed which aims to provide individualized, evidence-based and voluntary
treatment.The services provided under the heading of “stepped care” include
community-based prevention and health promotion, creating awareness that there are
help/treatment options for ATS users, self-help groups, brief interventions of
motivational interviewing and cognitive–behavioural therapy (e.g. one to four
sessions), intensive individual counselling, detoxification and withdrawal services,
crisis interventions and emergency care, as well as long term rehabilitation and
reintegration services. Cognitive–behavioural therapy applied in a stepped-care
approach is the treatment of best practice for ATS use.
Clearly, more research is needed in this area to expand the evidence-base globally, as
well as in our country.
1. INTRODUCTION
Amphetamine-type stimulants“(ATS)”refer to a family of synthetic drugs that are
chemically related to the parent compound amphetamine (phenylisopropylamine).1
Also referred to as 'psychostimulants', they excite or speed up the nervous system and
produce effects similar to adrenaline. They are distinguishable from 'botanical'
psychoactive drugs (e.g., heroin, cocaine, cannabis), which are derived from plants.2
Amphetamines act as central nervous system stimulants, which increase synaptic
concentrations of monoamine neurotransmitters in the brain, namely, dopamine,
serotonin and noradrenaline. 3 The ATS group includes amphetamine,
methamphetamine and methcathinone, fenetylline, ephedrine, pseudoephedrine,
methylphenidate and MDMA or 'Ecstasy' – an amphetamine-type derivative with
hallucinogenic properties.4
The type and form of ATS manufactured vary across regions. For example, in East and
South-East Asia, manufacture of methamphetamine is primarily in tablet form ('yaba')
and high purity crystalline form ('ice'). Chemical precursors are necessary for the
synthesis of amphetamine-type stimulants (ATS), and these chemicals commonly fall
under international control. Their seizures are typically reported to the International
Narcotics Control Board (INCB) and it provides some indications about trends in
clandestine manufacturing. Ephedrine and pseudo ephedrine are precursor chemical
for methamphetamine. phenyl-2-propoanone (P-2-P), Phenyl acetic acid and
norephedrine are precursor chemical for both amphetamine and methamphetamine.5
The use of ATS is a global and growing phenomenon and in recent years, there has been
a pronounced increase in the production and use of ATS worldwide. Over the past
decade, use of amphetamine-type stimulants (ATS) has infiltrated its way into the
mainstream culture in certain countries. Younger people in particular seem to possess a
skewed sense of safety about ATS believing rather erroneously that these substances are
safe and benign. Meanwhile, ATS are posing a serious threat to the health, social and
economic fabric of families, communities and nations.
In many countries, the problem of ATS is relatively new, but quickly growing and is
unlikely to be controlled soon. Though the geographical spread is widening, the
awareness is limited and unfortunately there is a lack of integrated and consistent
responses.
The market for amphetamine-type stimulants (ATS) in the Asia and the Pacific region has
continued to grow in recent years, which is evident through recent seizures of
methamphetamine in pill and crystalline forms in most countries in East and Southeast
Asia. Illicit methamphetamine manufacture continued to spread throughout the region
and new markets emerged for a variety of other synthetic substances.6,7
1.1 History
The earlier documentation of use of amphetamine was found in China, where the ma
huang plant (Ephedra vulgaris) has been used to treat people with asthma.8This plant
contains ephedrine which was first produced by chemical synthesis in 1887 in
Germany.8 Subsequently, amphetamine came into medical and recreational use in the
1920s primarily for the treatment of colds and asthma. Methamphetamine, more potent
and easier to make than amphetamine, was discovered in Japan in 1919.9 The
crystalline powder was soluble in water, making it easy to inject. During the World War-
II and the Vietnam War methamphetamine was widely used by the armed forces to
increase alertness, confidence, feelings of increased strength and to suppress appetite.
In the United States in the 1950s, legally manufactured tablets of
bothdextroamphetamine (Dexedrine) and methamphetamine (Methedrine) were used
by college students, truck drivers, and athletes. By the 1960s the market in
methamphetamine had changed from being predominantly licit to illicit. This was
followed by the synthesis, manufacture and distribution of methamphetamine by
'motor cycle' and other criminal gangs in United States.9 Subsequently, they were
widely prescribed for weight control and treatment of attention deficit disorders.
However, since the 1970s, amphetamines have been manufactured in clandestine
laboratories and increasingly used as recreational drugs. Because of their high potential
for abuse, amphetamines became a Schedule II controlled drug following the 1971
Convention on Psychotropic Substances.4
1.2 Epidemiology
1.2.1 Global
In 2009–10, it was estimated that between 13.7 and 52.9 million people used
substances belonging to the amphetamines group at least once in the preceding year.
Data for East and South-East Asia suggest that between 4.4 and 37.9 million people have
used amphetamines in the past year, no estimates were available for South
Asia.10According to the world drug report, 2012 between 2008–2010, about 1.3% of
adults worldwide reported use of amphetamine type stimulants (ATS) involving
compounds that range from amphetamine to an array of amphetamine analogues, but
exclude 3,4-methylenedioxy-N-methylamphetamine or 'ecstasy.11A retrospective audit
of patients admitted between 2008 to 2013 at Albany Health Campus, western Australia
was found One hundred and fifty two ATS-related hospital episodes were identified
during the study period, 55% male and 45% female, with an age range from 16 to 50.12
The ATS market continues to evolve and grow. Globally, it remains the second most
widely used illicit drug after cannabis. In 2012, the World Customs Organization
reported an increase in border detections of ATS in North America, Western Europe and
the Middle East, with large quantities also detected in the Asia-Pacific region. During
2012, customs agencies reported a global increase in the number and weight of
methylamphetamine and MDMA detections. The largest methylamphetamine border
detections by weight were reported by customs agencies in Asia-Pacific, Western
Europe and North America.13
Iran is a growing source of methylamphetamine destined for both domestic and
international markets. Iran-based methylamphetamine trafficking networks have
become leading domestic market suppliers, in addition to supplying user markets across
the Middle East and Asia-Pacific region. The Bureau for International Narcotics and Law
Enforcement Affairs (BINLEA) reported that while Iranian seizures of opium and heroin
have remained stable, seizures of methylamphetamine are increasing, with 2012
figures reportedly increasing eleven-fold from 2008 to 2011.14 North America remains
both a transit and a source region for methylamphetamine. Canada is source for
methamphetamine and having many laboratories for production (Criger 2013).15
Mexico remains the primary source for methylamphetamine in the United States of
America (US), with media reporting indicating that more than 80 per cent of
themethylamphetamine seized in the US is manufactured in Mexico.16
Since 2010, however, surging ATS seizures point to a rapid expansion of the global
market, with total ATS seizures rising by more than 80 per cent to more than 135 tons in
2012. The increase of ATS seizures is primarily attributable to the growing amount of
global methamphetamine seizures, which have more than doubled over the same
period, reaching 107 tons in 2012. The growing importance of methamphetamine is a
new feature of the global ATS market. The high level of global methamphetamine
seizures in recent years has been primarily due to the rise of seizures in East and South-
East Asia and North America.17
1.2.2 ASIA
UNODC (2010) estimated that up to 20.7 million individuals in Asia and pacific region
used ATS in the past one year.18
Methamphetamine continues to dominate the ATS market in East and South-East Asia,
Oceania and the Pacific. ATS seizures in the region have annually increased from about
13 tons in 2008 to just under 40 tons in 2012. The rapid rise of ATS seizures over the
years is primarily attributable to the increase of methamphetamine seizures which
about tripled from less than 12 tons in 2008 to 36 tons in 2012.17,18
Review conducted in china based on the literature identified from searches of the China
national knowledge infrastructure (1979-2013), PubMed databases, hand-picked
references, and online references with emphasis on epidemiology, treatment and
traditional Chinese medicine. The epidemiological trends of ATS in China have led to its
being 2.2 times the rate of morphine abuse and second only to marijuana abuse.19
1.2.3 India
In general, ATS use has remained very low in India, compared to other illicit drugs. In
India, the extent, pattern and consequences of ATS use has not been studied. Over the
last few years, laboratories producing amphetamine-group substances have been
unearthed by law enforcement agencies from several parts of the country. India along
with China is the most frequently mentioned source country of seized illicit shipments
of ephedrine and pseudoephedrine which can be used to manufacture ATS. Anecdotal
reports and clinical data indicate the emergence of use of these substances in several
parts of the country.
However, National household survey (NHS) reported the prevalence of ever use of ATS
to be 0.03% Current use according to DAMS (National Survey) was 0.2%. Though,
Current use according to RAS (National Survey) was nil but in the thematic “Border
study” (as a part of National Survey),some ATS userswere detected.20 More recently
UNODC has commissioned a study on ATS use in India. This study was conducted in
the five states of Manipur, Mizoram, Punjab, Tamil Nadu and West Bengal, in India. The
study also assessed the adverse health consequences related to the use of ATS. The
findings of the study revealed that methamphetamine pills and powder were the most
commonly used forms of ATS. Most users were in their early twenties. The
usersreported a general feeling of euphoria and happiness, making it very attractive and
deeply desirable to consume. Nearly half of the participants of the study were found to
be dependent users and a quarter of them reported to have experienced mental
problems after ATS use including paranoia, hallucinations, depression and panic
attacks. The study also established a link between ATS use and crime, with 18 percent of
the participants confirming that they had been apprehended by the police after ATS use.
Study found 55 percent were ecstasy ever user, methamphetamine pills were ever used
by 42 percent of the respondents followed by methamphetamine powder (36 percent)
and amphetamines (35 percent) (UNODC,2015)21 Ecstasy was reported to be last used
in the past one month by 13.1 percent amphetamine by 8.2 percent. Among reasons for
initiation of ATS, more than half (57%) reported curiosity followed by peer influence
(17%). While citing reasons for their current use 30.8 percent reported, “to be more
energetic”.21
Thus, it is clear that ATS use though is low in India at present, in the coming years, the
clinicians are likely to encounter more cases affected by ATS use disorders and hence, it
is imperative for the clinicians to remain prepared to deal with this newer clinical and
public health problem. 22
1.3 Neuropharmacology
Amphetamines are sympathomimetic central stimulants. Their pharmacological action
is exerted indirectly by sustaining high levels of catecholamine in the synaptic cleft and
directly by binding to the postsynaptic adrenergic receptors. It acts as indirect
catecholamine agonist and releases serotonin and also blocks reuptake of dopamine.
Amphetamine undergoes extensive renal excretion and significant amounts are present
in urine as the unchanged parent drug. The concentration of amphetamine in urine is
about 200 times greater than the concentration in blood. Other factors could impact on
the urine-blood amphetamine relationship, such as urinary pH, creatinine, route of
administration, pattern of voiding and time elapsed after use of the drug.
2. WHO USES AMPHETAMINE/METHAMPHETAMINE?
Recent UNODC study conducted in India found that most of the respondents were
youths with the median age of 25 years. A quarter of the respondents (25%) were
females. About two third (63%) of the respondents had received college level education
and more than half were engaged in full time employment with about one fifth (19%)
reporting being in business. A similar proportion (19%) reported earning more than
Rs. 30,001/- per month. Majority (62%) were single.21
There is no definitive profile of a “typical” user. ATS are used for many reasons. For
example, sportspersons may use ATS to enhance their performance, long-distance truck
drivers may use it to keep awake on long journeys, labourers and porters engaged in
heavy physical activities may take ATS to make them feel stronger, and students may use
it to help them stay awake and study. Another group of ATS users comprises those who
take ATS for social reasons such as at parties, nightclubs or gatherings of friends and
acquaintances. Some are heavy and regular users who smoke or inject potent forms of
methamphetamine and also use a variety of other drugs. They are thus likely to
experience poor mental and physical health and may become dependent on
amphetamines. However, the majority of non-medical use is by young people who use
low-potency ATS, swallow or snort the drug, do not inject and are not dependent.
2.1 Who are more prone? Population groups at-risk of ATS use
l Children with ADHD
l Those suffering from PTSD
l Those suffering from mood disorders (self medication hypothesis)
l Those adolescent and adults already using inhalants, cigarettes, cannabis , alcohol
(gate way hypothesis)
l Men for sexual pleasure, indiscriminate sexual Behaviour
l Those with social phobia
l Those with conduct disorder or antisocial personality disorder
l Those who are impulsive and engage in high risk taking behaviour
l With personality traits of physical fearlessness and reward sensitivity
l Adolescent females with abnormal weight control behaviour
l Working/homeless children;
l Incarcerated and institutionalized youth;
l Sexually abused children
l Unemployed youth
l Sex workers and other workers in the entertainment/hospitality industry (e.g. clubs
and casinos)
l Young people frequenting places of entertainment such as clubs and discothèques
l Men who have sex with men (MSM), lesbian, bisexual and transgender youth, who
have higher rates of drug use including ATS than the rest of the community.22,23,24
3. AMPHETAMINE USE DISORDERS
Amphetamines produce feelings of euphoria and relief from fatigue, may improve
performance on some simple tasks, increase activity levels, and produce anorexia. The
dependence liability of the amphetamines is thought to be primarily related to their
euphorigenic effects.25 However, their dependence and misuse are viewed as resulting
from a process in which multiple interacting factors (social, psychological, cultural, and
biological) influence drug-using behaviour.26
Amphetamines have been used almost since their introduction. Taken intravenously,
the dependence potential of amphetamines is comparable to that of heroin or cocaine.27
The ease of synthesis frominexpensive and readily available chemicals makes possible
the wide spread of amphetamine dependence and abuse.
3.1 Dependence
Dependence on ATS is characterized by increasing tolerance to the drug, occurrence of
withdrawal symptoms, a preoccupation with the drug and an inability to reduce ATS use
despite signi? cant negative social, health or psychological consequences and
impairment.
l Tolerance can sometimes be observed when ATS users transit from non-injecting to
injecting as they begin to use higher doses of ATS per episode.
l Withdrawal from ATS is marked by fatigue, lethargy, sleep disturbances, appetite
disturbances, depression, irritability, psychomotor retardation or agitation and
strong craving.
The degree of methamphetamine dependence is strongly related to the route of
administration: injecting route of intake is associated with a high likelihood of
dependence.
3.2 Routes of amphetamine administration and patterns of amphetamine use
The patterns of amphetamine use may be classified as follows.28
l Instrumental use: amphetamines are exploited by the users to achieve desired goals,
such as improve concentration and ward off fatigue.
l Subcultural/recreational use: amphetamine stimulant properties are exploited to
allow the user to remain active for longer periods in social/recreational settings, such
as at music and dance events.
l Chronic use: for several reasons, such as craving, tolerance and withdrawal, some
amphetamine users turn to be chronic users to relieve unwanted effects of
abstinence.
amphetamine withdrawal are the same as those for cocaine withdrawal.32 The findings
of a factor analysis of amphetamine withdrawal symptoms suggest that this clinical
condition may be comprised of three factors.45 The hyperarousal factor comprises drug
craving, agitation, and vivid or unpleasant dreams. The reversed vegetative factor
comprises decreased energy, increased appetite, and craving for sleep. The anxiety
factor comprises loss of interest or pleasure, anxiety and slowing of movement.
Depressive mood is a prevalent symptom and should be considered as a symptom
incorporated in more than one factor or more. Although the symptoms occurring during
amphetamine withdrawal may be over in four or five days, some of the symptoms may
continue for weeks or months.41, 46
Withdrawal Between 2-4 days to 2-4 Strong craving ,Fluctuating between irritability,
weeks, peak in severity anxiety, restlessness and agitation, low energy
over 7-10 days
although onset of action is delayed and relapse to use while taking antidepressants can
result in hypertension or serotonin syndrome. Mirtazapine is used at Drug and Alcohol
Services South Australia and has resulted in some improvement in symptoms. It may be
continued for depressive symptoms if response to treatment is evident. Short-term use of
benzodiazepines (diazepam 5 to 10mg QID SOS) and antipsychotics (olanzapine 2.5-
5mg BD SOS) for control of irritability and agitation can be helpful, particularly in the
inpatient setting. Care should be taken to limit access to large quantities of medications
and to avoid development of benzodiazepine dependence. These medications should
be prescribed for a maximum of seven to 10 days. Modafinil is also used at Drug and
Alcohol Services South Australia and has been demonstrated to result in some
improvement in symptoms, but this is not an approved medication for amphetamine
withdrawal treatment. The mainstay of treatment is supportive care and counselling.54
4.3 Treatment of amphetamine use disorders
4.3.1 Pharmacological treatment
Pharmacotherapies for amphetamine or methamphetamine dependence are based on
different underlying mechanisms that may:
a. alter the neurobiology of reinforcement or reward from the drug,
b. attenuate the negative reinforcing effects of withdrawal from and craving for the
drug, or
c. ameliorate comorbid psychiatric vulnerabilities that co-occur and that can interfere
with recovery
The medications evaluated in trials for pharmacotherapies for amphetamine or
methamphetamine dependence have mechanisms of action that can be categorized as
antagonists or agonists. Antagonist therapy approaches use medications that block the
action of the agonist to attenuate or eliminate the positive reinforcing effects of acute
methamphetamine intoxication. Antagonists compete with endogenous monoamines
but have no intrinsic activity at the receptor site. In contrast, agonist therapies are
medications that bind to and trigger responses from receptors involved in the addiction
process, often mimicking the action of monoamines involved in the reinforcement,
withdrawal symptoms and motivational aspects of methamphetamine or amphetamine
use.55
4.3.1.1 Antagonist strategies
4.3.1.1.1 Naltrexone: It is an opioid receptor antagonist. Since, the primary positive
reinforcing effects of ATS are mediated by dopamine, and opioid receptors partially
modulate dopaminergic effects these receptors may act as a relevant pharmacological
target. The results of an open-label trial of naltrexone for amphetamine dependence
were encouraging.56 A Swedish randomized trial included 80 treatment-seeking
(Batki et al, 2000) and iv) days of adherence to treatment (Batki et al, 2000; Batki et al,
2001; Tennant 1986).
4.3.1.3.2 5-HT3 antagonist (Ondansetron): Johnson and colleagues assessed three
doses of ondansetron in a double-blind placebo-controlled trial with 150
methamphetamine-dependent participants. Significant differences were not observed
for the medication at any of the doses in reducing methamphetamine use or any reports
of withdrawal, craving or severity of dependence.75
4.3.1.3.3 Mirtazapine: Colfax reported outcomes of a trial of mirtazapine (15 mg twice
daily) in 60 men who have sex with men showing men assigned to receive mirtazapine
showed fewer methamphetamine-positive urine samples compared to those assigned to
placebo.76
4.3.1.3.4 GABAergic agents: The GABA system activation exerts an inhibitory effect on
the reward system of dopaminergic tract. This feature suggests that GABA agents may
have some efficacy in attenuating the reinforcing effects of stimulants. Some preclinical
evidence suggested modest efficacy for cocaine dependence of the selective GABAB
agonist baclofen, and a clinical trial found some support as a treatment for cocaine
dependence.77
In a randomised, placebo controlled trial of a proprietary concoction of flumazenil
injections (a benzodiazepine antagonist), gabapentin and hydroxyzine in 120
methamphetamine-dependent adults78, no effects were seen on methamphetamine use,
treatment retention or drug craving. Elkashef et al. (2012)79 assessed topiramate with a
target dose of 200 mg/day in 140 methamphetamine dependent adults. There was no
clear evidence of efficacy for the medication; however, among individuals who were
abstinent at the beginning of treatment, topiramate appeared to facilitate abstinence
during the second half of the trial.
4.3.1.3.5 N-acetyl cysteine: Recently, a double blind randomized cross over study
conducted to evaluate efficacy of N-acetyl cysteine in treatment of methamphetamine
dependence found that this drug is effective in suppressing methamphetamine
craving.80
4.4 Psychosocial treatment approaches
Only few controlled trials of a psychosocial intervention for amphetamine dependence
and abuse have been found.81 However, recently web based intervention has been used
for treatment of users of amphetamine type stimulant.82 To meet the challenge of ATS
treatment, an eclectic “stepped-care approach” has been developed which aims to
provide individualized, evidence-based and voluntary treatment. The “stepped-care”
approach uses psychosocial interventions at various stages of drug use. It aims to
increase access to treatment, provide support to help users reduce or cease use, and
mitigate the social, health and legal problems associated with continued use.
The services provided under the heading of “stepped care” include community-based
prevention and health promotion, creating awareness that there are help/treatment
options for ATS users, self-help groups, brief interventions of motivational interviewing
and cognitive–behavioural therapy (e.g. one to four sessions), intensive individual
counselling, detoxification and withdrawal services, crisis interventions and emergency
care, as well as long term rehabilitation and reintegration services. Research suggests
that cognitive–behavioural therapy applied in a stepped-care approach is the treatment
of best practice for ATS use.
There are many activities, which need to be undertaken at every step. Thus, case
management and counselling are important at every stage – though different techniques
and different intensities are indicated for ATS users, depending on their profiles. Also
important is the provision of opportunities for ATS users to undergo vocational training
and assistance to gain employment, as well as in improving family relations, dealing
with legal problems and assisting in the development of new recreational activities and
social networks in the community.
4.4.1 Interventions in the community and in primary health-care settings (Steps one
and two)54
Providing services for ATS users in the community is the first step. Many ATS users are
occasional users who require information and education about the risks of ATS use, as
all ATS users may at some time require emergency care and management of acute
withdrawal. All ATS users should be provided with condoms since ATS use tends to
increase libido and hence the risk of unsafe sex. Needles and syringes should be
provided to all ATS injectors.
Providing services for ATS users in the community and in primary health-care settings
has many benefits including help in dispelling the stigma and discrimination as ATS
users are not singled out.
ATS users are exposed to a range of evidence- and community-based psychosocial
interventions as appropriate, without necessarily providing a specific therapeutic
approach. It is a setting where knowledge of community resources is available so that
referral can easily be made to specialized drug treatment facilities or other ancillary
services. It is the setting to which drug users are likely to return if referred to specialist
care. It is in the community that resources for rehabilitation and reintegration are
mobilized. It is the most cost-effective option for ATS users due to the lower costs of
transportation to such health facilities as well as for the health sector in the delivery of
services to ATS users and associated costs of referral to other standard health services
such as HIV/ AIDS and tuberculosis.
Motivational Assumptions
l are that people change their thinking and
interviewing (MI) behaviour according to a series of identifiable stages
It is possible to influence the natural change process with
l
“motivational” interviewing techniques.
Key concepts include establishing a “therapeutic alliance”
l
showing empathy, providing feedback, helping the client to
reframe his/her behaviour and thus reinforcing change.10
Contingency Contingency
l management is the systematic application of
management (CM) reinforcement/conditioning principles.
Basic assumptions include the belief that drug use behaviour
l
can be controlled using reinforcement procedures.
Positive reinforcement takes the form of verbal praise,
l
earning programme privileges or rewards.
Typically, the individual can earn larger-value rewards for
l
longer periods of continuous abstinence from drugs.
5. CONCLUSION
ATS is a rather new category of substance for most Indian professionals. At present the
clinical experience is limited. Even globally, there is scanty evidence-base about
effectiveness of various treatment approaches. Clearly, more research is needed in this
area to expand the evidence-base globally, as well as in our country.
REFERENCES
1. Dyer KR, & Cruickshank CC. Depression and other psychological health problems
among methamphetamine dependent patients in treatment: Implications for assessment
and treatment outcome. Australian Psychologist.2005 July; 40(2):96-108.
2. Chawla S. 'They're synthetic. They're clandestine. They can heal. They can kill.' UN
Chronicle. 1998; 25 (2):34-36.
3. Rothman RB & Baumann MH. Monoamine transporters and psychostimulant drugs.
European J Pharmacol. 2003; 479: 23-40.
4. United Nations. Convention on Psychotropic Substances. 1971.
(http://www.incb.org/pdf/e/conv/convention_1971_en.pdf, accessed on 28 September
2015).
5. Australian Crime Commission, 2014. Illicit drug data report 2013-14.
19. Sun HQ, Chen HM, Yang FD, Lu L, Kosten TR.Epidemiological trends and the advances
of treatments of amphetamine-type stimulants (ATS) in China. Am J Addict. 2014 May-
Jun;23(3):313-7.
20. Ray R. The Extent, Pattern and Trends of drug abuse in India (Ray, R)” UNODC,
Regional Office for South Asia and Ministry of Social Justice and Empowerment,
Government of India.2014
21. UNODC. Amphetamine type stimulants (ATS) use in India: An exploratory study.
UNODC. 2015
22. Kushwaha V, Verma R, Jhanjee S, Ambekar A. Amphetamine type stimulants:
"Forewarned is forearmed". Indian J Psychiatry. 2007; 49(5 Suppl):27.
23. McKetin R, Ross J, Kelly E, Baker A, Lee N, Lubman DI, Mattick R. Characteristics and
harms associated with injecting versus smoking methamphetamine among
methamphetamine treatment entrants. Drug Alcohol Rev. 2008; 27:277–285.
24. Pennay A, Lee N. Prevention and early intervention of methamphetamine-related harm.
Prevention Research Quarterly: Current evidence evaluated, Drug Info Clearing House,
Issues Paper, No. 6:2008. http//www.druginfo.adf.org.au. (accessed on 16 August
2015)
25. King GR, Ellinwood Jr EH. Amphetamines and other stimulants. In: Lowinson JH, Ruiz
P, Millman RB, Langrod JG, editors. Substance abuse: a comprehensive textbook. 3rd
edition. Baltimore; Williams & Wilkins,1997:207-23.
26. Jaffe JH. Amphetamine (or amphetamine-like)-related disorders. In: Kaplan HI, Sadock
BJ, editors. Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, 7th edition. Baltimore: Williams
&Wilkins, 2000: 971-82.
27. Kramer JC, Fischman VS, Littlefield DC. Amphetamine abuse: pattern and effects of high
doses taken intravenously. JAMA.1967;201:305-9.
28. World Health Organization. Amphetamine-type stimulants. Geneva: World Health
Organization, 1997.
29. Australian Drug Foundation (ADF), Drug information: drug facts: ice, ADF, Melbourne,
2013.
http://www.druginfo.adf.org.au/drug-facts/ice accessed on 20 August 2015
30. Centre for Addiction and Mental Health (CAMH). Amphetamines, CAMH,
Toronto,2012
http://www.camh.ca/en/hospital/health_information/a_z_mental_health_and_addicti
on_information/Amphetamines/Pages/default.aspx. accessed on 20 August, 2015
31. Jenner, L. 'Ups and downs: physical and mental health consequences of amphetamine-
type stimulant use', ed. S Allsop and N Lee, Perspectives on amphetamine type
stimulants, IP Communications, Melbourne. 2012
32. American Psychiatric Association. Diagnostic and statistical manual for mental
disorders, 4-text revision. Washington DC: American Psychiatric Association, 2000.
33. Australian ATS strategy, 2011. National amphetamine type stimulant strategy 2008-
2011 http://www.nationaldrugstrategy.gov.au accessed on 20 November 2015.
34. Vecellio M, Schopper C, Modestin J. Neuropsychiatric consequences (atypical
psychosis and complex-partial seizures) of ecstasy use: possible evidence for toxicity-
vulnerability predictors and implications for preventative and clinical care. J
Psychopharmacol. 2003 Sep;17(3):342-5.
35. Hall W, Hando J, Darke S, Ross J. Psychological morbidity and route of administration
among amphetamine users in Sydney, Australia. Addiction.1996;91:81-7.
36. Griffith JD, Cavanaugh J, Held J, Oates J. Dextroamphetamine: evaluation of
psychomimetic properties in man. Arch. Gen. Psychiatry. 1972;26:97-100.
37. Bell DS. The experimental reproduction of amphetamine psychosis. Arch. Gen.
Psychiatry.1973; 29:35-40.
38. Ellinwood Jr EH. Amphetamine psychosis: I. description of the individuals and process. J
Nerv Ment Dis, 1967;144:273-83.
39. King GR, Ellinwood Jr EH. Amphetamines and other stimulants. In: Lowinson JH, Ruiz
P, Millman RB, Langrod JG, editors. Substance abuse: a comprehensive textbook.
3rdedition. Baltimore; Williams & Wilkins. 1997:207-23.
40. Jonsson LE, Sjostrom K. A rating scale for evaluation for the clinical course and
symptomatology in amphetamine psychosis. Br J Psychiatry. 1970; 117:661-5.
41. Hofmann FG. A handbook on drug and alcohol abuse: the biomedical aspects. 2nd
edition. New York: Oxford University Press, 1983.
42. Vincent N, Shoobridge J, Ask A, Allsop S, Ali R. Physical and mental health problems in
amphetamine users from metropolitan Adelaide, Australia. Drug Alcohol
Rev.1998;17:187-95.
43. Cantwell B, McBride AJ. Self detoxification by amphetamine dependent patients: a
pilotstudy. Drug Alcohol Depend. 1998;49:157-63.
44. Schuckit MA, Daeppen J-B, Danko GP, Tripp ML, Smith TL, Li TK et al. Clinical
implications for four drugs of the DSM-IV distinction between substance dependence
with and without a physiological component. Am J Psychiatry. 1999;156:41-9.
45. Srisurapanont M, Jarusuraisin N, Jittiwutikan J. Amphetamine withdrawal: I. reliability,
validity and factor structure of a measure. Aust N Z J Psychiatry , 1999;33:89-93.
46. Watson R, Hartmann E, Schildkraut JJ. Amphetamine withdrawal: affective state, sleep
patterns, and MHPG excretion. Am J Psychiatry. 1972; 129:263-9.
47. Smith L, Yonekura ML, Wallace T, Berman N, Kuo J, Berkowitz C. Effect of prenatal
methamphetamine exposure on fetal growth and drug withdrawal symptoms in infant
born at term. Development Behav Paediatr.2003; 24 (1):17-23.
48. Thaithumyanon P, Limpongsanurak S, Praisuwanna P, Punnahitanon S. Perinatal effects
of amphetamine and heroin use during pregnancy on the mother and infant. J Med
Assoc Thai. 2005 Nov;88(11):1506-13.
63. Shearer J, Sherman J, Wodak A and van BeekI. Substitution therapy for amphetamine
users -Drug and Alcohol Review (2002) 21, 179.185
64. Shearer J, Wodak A, Mattick RP, et al. Pilot randomized controlled study of
dexamphetamine for amphetamine dependence. Addiction 2001;96: 1289 - 96.
65. Herin DV, Rush CR, Grabowski J. Agonist-like pharmacotherapy for stimulant
dependence: preclinical, human laboratory, and clinical studies. Ann N Y Acad Sci.
2010; 1187:76–100.
66. Galloway GP, Buscemi R, Coyle JR, et al. A randomized, placebo-controlled trial of
sustained-release dextroamphetamine for treatment of methamphetamine addiction.
Clin Pharmacol Ther. 2011; 89:276–82.
67. McGaugh J, Mancino MJ, Feldman Z, et al. Open-label pilot study of modafinil for
methamphetamine dependence. J Clin Psychopharmacol. 2009; 29:488–91.
68. Anderson AL, Li S-H, Biswas K, et al. Modafinil for the treatment of methamphetamine
dependence. Drug Alcohol Depend. 2012; 120:135–41.
69. Elkashef AM, Rawson RA, Anderson AL, et al. Bupropion for the treatment of
methamphetamine dependence. Neuropsychopharmacology. 2008; 33:1162–70.
70. Shoptaw S, Heinzerling KG, Rotheram-Fuller E, et al. Randomized, placebo-controlled
trial of bupropion for the treatment of methamphetamine dependence. Drug Alcohol
Depend. 2008; 96:222–32.
71. Das M, Santos D, Matheson T, et al. Feasibility and acceptability of a phase II
randomized pharmacologic intervention for methamphetamine dependence in high-
risk men who have sex with men. AIDS. 2010; 24:991–1000.
72. Dwoskin LP, Rauhut AS, King-Pospisil KA, Bardo MT. Review of the pharmacology and
clinical profile of bupropion, an antidepressant and tobacco use cessation agent. CNS
Drug Rev. 2006; 12:178–207.
73. Rau KS, Birdsall E, Hanson JE, et al. Bupropion increases striatal vesicular monoamine
transport. Neuropharmacology. 2005; 49:820–30.
74. World Health Organization, 2001.Systematic review of treatment for amphetamine-
related disorders. Department of Mental Health and Substance Dependence. World
Health Organization. Geneva.
75. Johnson BA, Ait-Daoud N, Elkashef AM, et al. A preliminary randomized, double-blind,
placebo-controlled study of the safety and efficacy of ondansetron in the treatment of
methamphetamine dependence. Int J Neuropsychopharmacol. 2008; 11:1–14.
76. Colfax GN, Santos G-M, Das M, et al. Mirtazapine to reduce methamphetamine use: A
randomized controlled trial. Arch Gen Psychiatry. 2011; 68:1168–75.
77. Shoptaw S, Yang X, Rotheram-Fuller EJ, et al. Randomized placebo-controlled trial of
baclofen for cocaine dependence: preliminary effects for individuals with chronic
patterns of cocaine use. J Clin Psychiatry. 2003; 64(12):1440–8.
78. Ling W, Shoptaw S, Hillhouse M, Bholat MA, Charuvastra C, Heinzerling K, et al.
Double-blind placebo-controlled evaluation of the PROMETA™ protocol for
Kaustav Chakraborty
Rajarshi Neogi
On behalf of
Indian Psychiatric Society
Specialty Section on Substance Use Disorders
2016
Club Drugs
CONTENTS
Executive Summary
1. Introductory section
1.1 Introduction
1.2 Scope and methodology of developing the guideline
1.3 Data Search Methodology
2. Club drugs
2.1 Epidemiology of club drugs
2.2 MDMA
2.2.1. Clinical pharmacology
2.2.2. Neurobiology
2.2.3. Clinical and adverse effects
2.2.4. Management
2.2.4.1. Management of acuteMDMA toxicity
2.2.4.2. Management of harmful use and dependence of MDMA
2.3 Ketamine
2.3.1. Clinical pharmacology
2.3.2. Neurobiology
2.3.3. Clinical and adverse effects
2.3.4. Management
2.3.4.1. Management of acute toxicity of Ketamine
2.3.4.2. Management of Ketamine dependence and withdrawal
2.4 Gamma-hydroxybutyrate (GHB)
2.4.1. Clinical pharmacology
2.4.2. Neurobiology
2.4.3. Clinical and adverse effects
2.4.4. Management
2.4.4.1. Management of acute GHB toxicity
2.4.4.2. Management of GHB withdrawal
2.4.4.3. Management of GHB dependence
2.5. Flunitrazepam
2.5.1. Clinical pharmacology
2.5.2. Neurobiology
2.5.3. Clinical and adverse effects
2.5.4 Management
2.5.4.1. Toxicology and detection
2.5.4.2. Management of Flunitrazepamintoxication/dependence
2.6. Lysergic acid diethylamide (LSD) and related hallucinogens
2.6.1. Clinical pharmacology
2.6.2. Neurobiology
2.6.3. Clinical and adverse effects
2.6.4. Management
2.6.4.1. Management of hallucinogen toxicity
2.6.4.2. Management of hallucinogen dependence
2.6.4.3. Management of HPPD
3. General principles in the management of club drugs intoxication / harmful use/
dependence
4. Club drugs: Indian scenario
5. Conclusion
EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
Club drugs are a group of newer synthetic addictive substances which are increasingly
used in 'clubs' or 'raves' along with loud, electronic 'techno rock' music and all night
dancing by the sensation seeking youths and/ or adults. There is very little data regarding
the prevalence of club drugs harmful use/ dependence particularly from India. The data
is only in the form of case reports or case series, news paper reports, crime bureau or
narcotics department data. But it can definitely be said that their use is on the rise and
clinicians will be challenged by the various health problems that are known to arise
from the use of these substances. In our discussion we will use the term 'club drugs' in
reference to MDMA, Ketamine, GHB, Flunitrazepam, and LSD/related substances. We
have developed a clinical practice guideline based on existing evidence, with emphasis
on available Indian data, to assist practitioner and patient decisions about appropriate
health care for specific clinical circumstances, e.g., acute intoxication, harmful use,
dependence and withdrawal state due to use of club drugs.
MDMA (3,4-METHYLENEDIOXYMETHAMPHETAMINE or ECSTASY)
Management of acute MDMA toxicity
Laboratory identification of MDMA is difficult. As many as one-third of immunoassay
urine screens have failed to detect it in standardized specimens. In acute MDMA
toxicity short period of hospital stay is recommended (C). Severely dehydrated patients
may require intravenous fluid (C). Patients with severe hyponatremia may require fluid
restriction (C). Gastric decontamination with active charcoal is indicated if presentation
is within 1 hour of ingestion (D). Hyperthermia can be treated with Dantrolene (C) or
benzodiazepine sedation (D).
Management of harmful use and dependence of MDMA
Psychosocial treatment is the mainstay for chronic harmful use of MDMA (D, S). No
speci? c guidelines for psychosocial intervention have been described and validated for
chronic ecstasy users. For those that do seek help, typical treatment approaches include
individual and group counselling, cognitive behavioural therapy, and relapse
prevention technique.
KETAMINE
Management of acute toxicity of Ketamine
The diagnosis of ketamine should be considered when people (especially young
people) present with agitation, tachycardia and either visual hallucinations or
nystagmus. No antidote exists for ketamine overdose. Supportive care with special
attention to cardiac and respiratory function is the mainstay of treatment as the effects of
the drug are usually short lived (S). Patient should be kept in a quiet environment with
minimum external stimulus (S). Activated charcoal can be used in the presence of co-
ingestant or if the patient presents very early (D). Benzodiazepines cane be used for
agitated or hyperthermic patients (D).
Management of Ketamine dependence and withdrawal
Psychosocial treatments are mainstay of ketamine dependence (D). Ketamine
withdrawal is characterized by anxiety, shaking, sweating, palpitations and carving for
the drug. This can be treated with tapering dose of diazepam modified from alcohol
detoxification regimen (D).
GAMMA-HYDROXYBUTYRATE (GHB)
Management of acute GHB toxicity
It may be difficult to differentiate GHB poisoning from other sedative hypnotic
intoxications. GHB is detected by routine urine screens in the western countries which
are not available in India now. A sensitive and specific GC-MS method using selective
ion monitoring has been developed for the quantification of GHB in blood. Supportive
care is the mainstay of treatment. Endotracheal intubation may be required if vomiting is
present (D,S). Decontamination with activated charcoal should be considered in
patients who are alert, stable and have a protected airways (D). Atropine can be used for
hemodynamically unstable patients (D). Myoclonic movements and seizures may be
treated with lorazepam or diazepam (D). There are no specific antidotes for GHB
poisoning
Management of GHB withdrawal
The GHB-related withdrawal syndrome seems consistent with other hypnotic/sedative
withdrawal syndromes. Benzodiazepines are the first line of treatment for GHB
withdrawal (D). Baclofen and barbiturates can be used as second-line adjuncts (D).
Valproic acid, carbamazepine, gabapentin, chloral hydrate, baclofen, clonidine,
paroxetine, beta blockers, bromocriptine, trazadone, fentanyl, propofol, and
antipyschotics have been tried sporadically (D).
Management of GHB dependence
Psychosocial interventions are the mainstay of treatment of GHB dependence (D).
Motivatonal counselling, contingency management, CBT based relase prevention
techniques, group therapy, occupational therapies can be tried.
FLUNIRAZEPAM
Management of flunitrazepamintoxication / dependence
Management of Flunitrazepamoverdose/dependence is similar to other
benzodiazepine overdose/dependence which has been elaborately dealt in the
previous volume of IPS-CPG which provided the guidelines for the management of
sedative-hypnotic use disorders. Decontamination with activated charcoal is done for
patients with secured airways and who present early (D,S). Flumazenil can be used to
reverse the effects of Flunitrazepamtoxicity (D). Flunitrazepamdependence is managed
by titrating doses of long acting benzodiazepines similar to other benzodiazepine
dependence (D).
LSD AND OTHER RELATED HALLUCINOGENS
Management of hallucinogen toxicity
The management of acute toxicity resulting from the use of hallucinogens will in part
depend on the hallucinogenic substance consumed.Attempts to 'talk the patient down'
first must be instituted. Sympathetic, non-judgemental reassurance, support and
observation are often sufficient.Patient should be placed in a quiet, well lit room with
minimal external stimuli (S). Benzodiazepines, diazepam or lorazepam are the
mainstay of treatment, particularly in presence of agitation (D). Antipsychotics can be
considered as second line treatment (D).
Management of hallucinogen dependence
The use of LSD or other classic hallucinogens does not appear to lead to dependence.
Typically there is no persistent and compulsive pattern of use and the use of
hallucinogens is not associated with any recognized withdrawal syndrome.
Management of HPPD (Hallucinogen persisting perception disorder)
Hallucinogen persisting perception disorder (HPPD) and 'flashbacks' have been
associated with use of classic hallucinogens in particular, although these concepts
remain uncertain. HPPD can persist for months or years after the use of
hallucinogens.Several classes of antidepressants, anxiolytics, antipsychotics, COMT
inhibitor, naltrexone, levodopa, clonidine, lamotrigine and citalopram can be used to
treat HPPD (B). Lamotrigine may be a promising agent in the treatment of HPPD (D).
GENERAL PRINCIPLES IN THE MANAGEMENT OF CLUB DRUGS INTOXICATION /
HARMFUL USE / DEPENDENCE
No standard treatment protocol has been identified for club drug overdose. Basic
management should include cardiac monitoring, pulse oximetry, urinalysis, and
performance of a comprehensive chemistry panel to check for electrolyte imbalance,
renal toxicity, and possible underlying disorders. Harm reduction strategies have been
proposed which emphasizes that buildings meet safety and health standards, adequate
security is provided to accommodate the large number of attendees and “ravers” are
educated about health effects by trained volunteers.Suspicion of a club drug overdose
or toxicity is essential. Except for GHB, club drugs cannot be detected through routine
toxicological screens. Airway, breathing and circulation should be maintained (S).
1. INTRODUCTORY SECTION
1.1 INTRODUCTION
'Raves' are parties with loud, electronic “techno-rock” music, laser light shows, and all-
night dancing held in clandestine locations, including warehouses, nightclubs, and
farm fields.1 They first became popular in Great Britain in the late 1980s.The
underground or noncommercial music featured at raves which is produced by
computers and include little or no vocals is distinct from the music played at
conventional nightclubs. Following bans in some countries the rave parties moved in to
legitimate nightclubs. A “raver” is a person who has an exciting and uninhibited social
life and regularly goes to raves. Not all ravers use drugs; however, many illicit drugs are
available at raves and are used liberally to enhance the “vibe”.2 Here, it would be
worthwhile to clarify that words like 'rave drugs', 'club drugs' and 'party drugs' have
been used interchangeably in the literature. The U.S. National Institute on Drug Abuse
(NIDA) in its “Community Alert on Club Drugs,” defined “club drugs” as MDMA (3,4-
methylenedioxymethamphetamine, or Ecstasy), Ketamine, Gamma-hydroxybutyrate
(GHB), Flunitrazepam, Methamphetamine, and Lysergic Acid Diethylamide (LSD).3 On
the other hand, the U.S. Office of National Drug Control Policy identifies four specific
club drugs: MDMA, Ketamine, GHB, and Flunitrazepam.4 Methamphetamine and LSD
have been inconsistently included in the category of the club drugs. In addition, these
two drugs have a longer history of misuse in comparison to the other four which came to
the scene much later (MDMA being first reported in 1985).
In our discussion we will use the term 'club drugs' in reference to MDMA, Ketamine,
GHB, Flunirazepam, and LSD/related substances to avoid further confusion.
Methamphetamine has been deliberately left out because it will dealt in a separate
chapter on amphetamine like stimulants. These drugs are being used in an expanding
variety of venues by groups who differ in terms of age, gender, sexual orientation, and
race/ethnicity5. Each of these drugs has very different pharmacologic properties,
physiological and psychological effects, and potential consequences (Table 1).
Toxic effects Irritability, fatigue, Increased heart rate, Sleep induction, Decreased body 'Bad trip', characterised
nausea, loss of hypertension, cognitive tremors, agitation, temperature and blood by anxiety, fear/panic,
appetite, weight loss, and psychomotor seizures, GI symptoms, pressure, sedation, dysphoria and/or
tachycardia, impairment, nausea, CNS & respiratory cognitive & paranoia. Distressing
hypertension, tremors, respiratory depression, depression, dizziness, psychomotor effects can be sensory
tics, jaw clenching, immobility, anxiety, confusion, impairment, visual (e.g. frightening
serotonin-syndrome, dissociation, hallucinations, apnea, disturbances, dizziness, perceptions), somatic
anxiety, bruxism, depression, recurrent bradycardia, confusion, GI (e.g. distressing
thought flashbacks, delirium, unconsciousness, disturbances, urinary awareness of
Adapted from Chakraborty K, Neogi R, Basu D. Club drugs: Review of the 'rave' with a note of concern for the Indian scenario.
Indian J Med Res 2011;133:594-604.25
131
Newer and Emerging Addictions in India
Scientific studies about the uses of these club drugs and their short-term and long-term
effects on animals have shown these drugs can be damaging in multiple ways, and some
drugs (particularly MDMA) can damage specific neurons in the brain5. Moreover,
routine drug screens do not pick up various club drugs, and gas chromatography-mass
spectrometry (GC-MS) testing must be requested to confirm the presence of the specific
drug, otherwise many cases of sexual assault and driving under the influence go
undetected. In this guideline we attempt to discuss the epidemiology, clinical
pharmacology, neurobiology, clinical and adverse effect profile, and treatment
strategies of club drugs with a section contributing to the Indian scenario.
1.2. SCOPE AND METHODOLOGY OF DEVELOPING THE GUIDELINE
The index guideline covers the epidemiology, clinical pharmacology, neurobiology,
clinical and adverse effects, and management of acute intoxication, harmful use,
withdrawal and dependence state due to use of club drugs wherever applicable. In
general the ICD-10 classification for mental and behavioural disorders was followed as
the point of reference. Mental and behavioural disorders due to use of hallucinogens
can be coded under F16 of ICD-10, whereas mental and behavioural disorders
associated with other club drugs can be coded under F19 (Mental and behavioural
disorders due to multiple drug use and use of other psychoactive substances).The
discussion on management mainly focuses on five types of club drugs which has already
been referred to in the previous section. The general principles in the management of
club drugs intoxication, harmful use, withdrawal and dependence are presented later in
this chapter. This guideline assumes importance because consistent treatment protocols
are lacking which the clinicians can follow when confronted with users of club drugs as
newer generation of youths are increasingly opting for these drugs to get the desired
'kick' particularly in club/ rave settings. In index guideline 'acute intoxication' means, a
transient condition following the administration psychoactive substance, resulting in
disturbances in level of consciousness, cognition, perception, affect or behaviour, or
other psychophysiological functions and responses; 'harmful use' means, a pattern of
psychoactive substance use that is causing damage to health, the damage may be
physical or mental; 'dependence syndrome' means, a cluster of physiological,
behavioural, and cognitive phenomena in which the use of a substance or a class of
substances takes on a much higher priority for a given individual than other behaviours
that once had greater value; and 'withdrawal state' means A group of symptoms of
variable clustering and severity occurring on absolute or relative withdrawal of a
substance after repeated, and usually prolonged and/or high-dose, use of that substance.
1.3. DATA SEARCH METHODOLOGY
The data search strategies for this review included electronic databases as well as hand-
search of relevant publications or cross-references. The electronic search included
PUBMED and other search engines (e.g. Google Scholar, PsychINFO). The data search
experiencing harm from club drugs and to report negative consequences.40-41 Other
studies have not found gender differences in club drug use.33,42,43
Further, polysubstance abuse is common among users of club drugs, often used in
combination, particularly with marijuana or alcohol.31,44,45 In a survey of 23,780 middle
school students in New York City, it was found that Black students were less likely than
White students to useclub drugs. The use of alcohol and/or marijuana predicted club
drug use regardless of the timeframe of use, and lifetime cigarette use predicted lifetime
club drug use.46 It has been found that, club drug use is common among youths in
treatment for substance abuse and has spread beyond the rave culture.47 In a
retrospective review of 38,350 case records from 1998 through 2003 of persons
admitted with problems with club drugs were compared against users of alcohol or
other drugs. Club drug users were more impaired on ? ve of six Addiction Severity Index
(ASI) indices at admission and they were more likely to use multiple substances more
often. They were more likely than users of alcohol or other drugs to complete treatment,
but this varied by drug. At follow-up 90 days after discharge, club drug users continued
to report more ASI problems. Pro? les of these clients show that ecstasy use has spread
beyond the club culture, as indicated by the changes in client demographics over time.
GHB clients presented a mixed picture of severe problems at admission and good
response to treatment. Hallucinogen clients were young and less likely to complete
treatment.48
Much of the available literature on the epidemiology of “club drugs” among men who
have sex with men (MSM) derives from studies conducted on the west coast of the
United States (Reback and Grella, 1999; Lewis and Ross, 1995; Frosch et al., 1996),
with additional studies in Australia (Kippax et al., 1998) and Western Europe (Henry,
1992). 49-53 In a study of 569 MSM youths, recruited during 2000 and 2001, high rates of
lifetime exposure to a variety of club drugs(including methamphetamine, ketamine, and
MDMA) was observed. Among those who used club drugs on a chronic basis (N = 145),
there was high rates of a prior suicide attempt (including high rates of multiple suicide
attempts), high rates of lifetime exposure to multiple types of drugs, high rates of current
poly drug use (including multiple types of club drugs), and high rates of current
depressive symptoms.54 MSM who had ever used MDMA were more likely to report
unprotected anal sex and were more likely to be diagnosed with an STD than MSM who
had never used MDMA.55A study assessing the pattern of club drug initiation among
gay and bisexual men suggests that the sequencing of club drug use may be better
explained by socialization processes in the gay community than by Gateway Theory,
which has been traditionally used to explain patterns of drug use in the population.56
The epidemiological studies on club drugs are shown in Table 2.
production.82 It induces the release of serotonin and also blocks serotonin re-
uptake.These effects are thought to be related to the observed depression, anorexia,
agitation, and marked feelings of empathy reported in association with use of the drug.
Because MDMA depletes serotonin stores in neurons, subsequent doses produce
diminished euphoria and increase adverse effects such as depression and agitation.83 In
addition to its effects on serotonin neurotransmission, MDMA has also been shown to
affect the noradrenergic, dopaminergic, and cholinergic neurotransmitter systems.6,84,85
2.2.3. Clinical and adverse effects
Clinical effects of MDMA have been varied ranging from increased energy to
depression (Table 1).7-11 Partygoers are motivated primarily by the energetic and
euphoric effects they expect from MDMA.86 MDMA has been shown to increase energy
and psychomotor drive, self-con? dence, and well-being, and to produce a positive
mood, heightened sensory awareness (such as intensi? ed perceptions), derealization,
depersonalization, and to increase responsiveness toemotions and sense of closeness to
others.83 MDMA increases sexual arousal and there are reports where MDMA was
specifically used to increase the sexual vigour.87,88 No withdrawal syndrome from
MDMA has been reported.82 Regular ecstasy users often report diminished
responsiveness to the drug and a consequent need for dose escalation, both of which
imply the development of tolerance.32
Ecstasy use can also bring about a range of negative physical side effects while under the
influence of the drug and during the comedown period (Table 1)12-15. Adverse effects
include anxiety and thought disorder, jaw clenching (bruxism), lack of appetite,
difficulty concentrating, disturbance of balance, and an increase in blood pressure. In a
study of MDMA administration, some of these effects were still reported by some
subjects after 24 hours.9 Women reported more undesirable acute subjective effects
(e.g. physical illness, depressed mood, anxiety, thought disorder and perceptual
changes) with greater intensity relative to males.89 In addition, studies have found a
relationship between MDMA use (but not use of other drugs) and high risk sexual
behaviour (unprotected anal intercourse) among homosexual and bisexual men
attending dance clubs.55, 90
There are numerous reports of Ecstasy producing severe acute toxicity resulting in death
usually related to severe dehydration, strokes, hyperthermia, and hyponatremia.91
These cases involved seizures, tachyarrhythmias, hypertension, diaphoresis, and
pupillary dilation. In addition, body temperatures rangedfrom 104–110?F, which was
associated with a variety of complications including kidney failure and death. Evidence
of possible liver toxicity is also suggested as another severe outcome related to MDMA
use. MDMA ingestion directly causes a rise in antidiuretic hormone. Heat from the
exertion of dancing in a crowded room coupled with the MDMA-induced hyperthermia
can lead easily to excessive water intake and severe hyponatremia, to which young
women appear to be particularly susceptible.92,93 Cases have also been reported of
damage to the neurological system including cerebral infarctions and hemorrhage,
accompanied by neurological impairment. MDMA ingestionhas also been implicated
in the experience of psychiatric disturbances such as depression, panic attacks, and
? ash backs of hallucinations. It is likely that these disturbances emergein individuals
who are already “at-risk” for mental illness; however, it has been suggested that because
MDMA has demonstrated neurotoxicity it might actually be able to induce chronic
psychosis in the absence of such individual risk.83Long-term use of MDMA has been
related to brain neurotoxicity (lower density of serotonin transporter sites) even after
periods ofabstinence.94,95
There is also a substantial risk for fetal exposure from women who are, or become
pregnant, while using MDMA. Pregnant women who use MDMA tend to be young,
single, and report psychological morbidity and have a clustering of risk factors that may
compromise the pregnancy and fetus. Pregnant rats exposed to MDMA during a period
that was developmentally equivalent to the human ? rst trimester days had pups with
signi? cant neurochemical and behavioural alterations, which is the ? rst report of its
kind following a prenatal MDMA exposure.5,96
2.2.4. Management
Laboratory identification of MDMA is difficult. MDMA is excreted as unchanged drug,
3,4-methylenedioxyamphetamine (MDA), and free and glucuronidated/sulfated 4-
hydroxy-3-methoxymethamphetamine (HMMA), and 4-hydroxy-3-
methoxyamphetamine (HMA) metabolites.Identification of HMMA as well as MDMA
through gas chromatography-mass spectroscopy (GC-MS) increases the ability to
identify positive specimens but requires hydrolysis.97,98.
2.2.4.1. Management of acute MDM Atoxicity
The most common interventions requiredare clinical monitoring, observation and
reassurance, and symptomatic treatment, including ? uids (D).99 The average duration of
hospital stay reported by the Australian study was three hours (III).100 Dehydration
should be addressed. Following ecstasy-related presentation to a hospital emergency
department, intravenous ? uids were administered to 31% of patients in a UK study,130
and to 71% of cases in a Swiss study, but it is important to note that symptoms following
ecstasy use range from severe dehydration to severe hyponatraemia; the latter patients
require ? uid restriction, so it is dangerous to give hypotonic ? uids or normal saline to
patients prior to proper assessment (III).101,102 There is no evidence to support gastric
decontamination with activated charcoal, but it may be appropriate for cases of
presentation within 1 hour of ingestion (IV).24
Recommendations:
l Psychosocial treatments are mainstay of ketamine dependence (D)
l Ketamine withdrawal can be treated with tapering dose of diazepam modified from
alcohol detoxification regimen (D)
2.4. GAMMA-HYDROXYBUTYRATE (GHB)
GHB is available as a clear liquid, white powder (dissolved in water), tablet, or capsule
and can be made in private residences with ingredients and recipes obtained on the
Internet (DEA 04). Street names include “G”, “Liquid Ecstasy,” “Scoop,” “Easy Lay,”
“Georgia Home Boy,” “Grievous Bodily Harm,” “Liquid X,” “Goop,” “Gib,” “Soap,”
“Blue Nitro”, “Blue Verve”, “Caps”, “Chemical X”,“Cherry Meth”, “Date Rape Drug”,
“Drogue du Cambriolage Sexuel Parfait”, “Ellie”, “Ever Clear”, “EZ Lay”, “Fantasy”, “G”,
“Gamma-OH”, “Get-her-to-Bed”, “Great Hormones at Bedtime”, “Grievous Bodily
Harm”, “G-Riffic”, “Jib”, “Liquid Dream”, “Liquid E”, “Liquid Ectasy”, “Liquid G”,
“Liquid X”, “Liquid-XTC”, “Natural Sleep 500”, “Organic Quaalude”, “Salty Water”,
“Scoop”, “Scoop Her”, “Sleep”, “Soap”, “Somatomax”, “Somatomax PM”, “Vita-G”,
“Water” and “Nitro”.23.
GHB was suggested for medical use in anaesthesia, obstetrics, and psychiatry138
(including possible use for alcohol and narcotic withdrawal symptoms) in the 1960s and
also in the treatment of alcohol and opiate withdrawal, fibromyalgia, and
narcolepsy.23,139-142 By the 1990s, GHB was being marketed for illicit use in weight
control management and its purported anabolic properties and associated muscle
growth that made it a popular drug with body builders.6,14 In addition, GHB has been
implicated for its use in association with sexual assault because victims have difficulty
resisting the assault due to the level of intoxication produced. The associated memory
problems and the fact that it clears from the body quickly (within 12 h) make detection
difficult and increase the complexity of attempts to prosecute for which GHB derived its
infamous label of 'date rape' drug.16 Much interest has been generated regarding driving
difficulties caused by GHB. In has been found that, two symptoms that most commonly
caused driving difficulties were rapid loss of consciousness or onset of stupor, known
among users as “G-napping” and periods of anterograde amnesia.24 GHB is now a
Schedule I drug in the U.S. and Schedule IV of the 1971 UN Convention. In 2002,
sodium oxybate, a formulation of GHB, was approved for the treatment of narcolepsy
and classified as schedule III.23
2.4.1. Clinical Pharmacology
Gamma-hydroxybutyric acid (GHB) is a short-chain fatty acid occurring naturally in
mammals. GHB can form salts (e.g. sodium and potassium salts), which are soluble in
water and alcohol. It is colourless and easily mixes in aqueous solutions; however, a
salty taste may be noticeable.143 Illegal GHB and its precursors, GBL (gamma
butyrolactone) and 1,4-BD (1,4-butanediol), can be obtained over the Internet and
sometimes are marketed as solvents such as ink jet printer fluid or as GHB alternatives in
health food stores, gyms, raves, and nightclubs. GHB and GBL are subject to
interconversion in aqueous media.
GHB pharmacokinetics have been studied in healthy volunteers, narcoleptics,
alcoholics, and patients with liver impairment. A further study monitored GHB kinetics
following 1,4-butanediol administration to healthy volunteers. When healthy adult
volunteers and patients with biopsy-proven liver cirrhosis were compared, there was a
marked reduction in clearance following oral administration and significant
prolongation of elimination half-life.144 GHB is metabolized via succinic acid and the
citric acid cycle (TCA cycle/Krebs cycle), ultimately producing carbon dioxide and
water. GHB conversion to succinic semi-aldehyde can be catalysed by cytosolic GHB-
dehydrogenase or mitochondrial GHB-etoacid transhydrogenase. At low doses, GHB is
eliminated through the respiratory system, with higher doses via renal clearance. While
the half-life of GHB is short after low doses, high doses (such as those associated with
overdose) result in slow and prolonged absorption and a much longer half-life in animal
studies.23 The related chemicals, 1,4-BD and GBL, are metabolized endogenously to
GHB. 1,4-BD is metabolized by alcohol dehydrogenases to gamma-
hydroxybutyraldehyde and then by aldehyde dehydrogenase to form GHB; ethanol can
inhibit this metabolism as it acts as a competitive substrate to alcohol dehydrogenase.
Less than 2% of GHB is eliminated unchanged through urine. GBL is converted to GHB
by serum lactonase; this enzyme is not present in brain tissue.145, 146 Following the oral
administration of 1,4-BD 25 mg/kg, the mean elimination half- life was reported to be
about 39.3 minutes in healthy adult volunteers.147
2.4.2. Neurobiology
GHB acts as a neurotransmitter or neuromodulator and bind to GABA-B receptors; GHB
is both a metabolite and a precursor of the inhibitory neurotransmitter
gammahydroxybutyrate (GABA), and acts as a neuromodulator in the GABA system.23
GHB does not readily pass the blood brain barrier. The highest density of these
receptors is in the hippocampus, cortex, and dopaminergic areas (striatum, olfactory
tracts, and substantia nigra). GHB inhibits dopamine release and activates tyrosine
hydroxylase, that together act to increase central dopamine levels, which could be
associated with the reinforcing effects of GHB.148
2.4.3. Clinical and adverse effects
Clinical and toxic effects of GHB can be found in Table 1.2,16,22 The symptoms typically
occur within 15-45 minutes, and resolve within a relatively short interval of time; CNS
depression usually persists for 1-3 hours with patients making a complete recovery
typically within 4-8 hours. Other common neurological effects include ataxia,
disorientation, dizziness, confusion, hallucinations, somnolence, slurred speech,
dysarthria, confusion, headache, incoordination, euphoria, amnesia, hypotonia,
hyporeflexia, tremor, and myoclonus. Seizures or seizure-like activity have also been
reported agitation, bizarre behaviour, and combativeness has been noted in some
patients, either at presentation to the treatment facility or upon wakening. Patients can
also alternate between agitation and somnolence.
Table 3: Clinical effects of GHB at different doses
Dose range Clinical effects
10 mg/kg Short-term anterograde amnesia, hypotonia, and euphoria
20 – 30 mg/kg Drowsiness, sleep, and myoclonus
50mg/kg Coma
>50mg/kg Coma, bradycardia, and/or respiratory depression
Other less common neurological effects may include bruxism, vertigo, disinhibition,
increased sexual arousal, delusions, extrapyramidal side effects, dystonias, and athetoid
posturing. Miosis is common while mydriasis and horizontal and vertical gaze
nystagmus may also occur. Pupils may also be sluggish or nonreactive. Common
cardiovascular effects include bradycardia, and hypotension. Chest tightness or
palpitations may also occur. The major respiratory effects of GHB include dose-related
respiratory depression, bradypnoea, periodic (Cheyne-Stokes) respirations, and apnoea
and respiratory failure. Metabolic features include hyperglycaemia, hypokalaemia, and
potentially hypernatremia if large doses of the sodium salt are ingested. Elevated
creatine kinase activity/rhabdomyolysis may also occur. Nausea and vomiting are
common gastrointestinal symptoms following oral or intravenous administration of
GHB. Death is normally due to respiratory failure. GHB use alongside other CNS
depressant drugs may increase toxicity by producing synergistic CNS depression. and
co-ingestants may also contribute to fatalities involving GHB.21,147
The Drug Enforcement Administration (DEA) has documented deaths related to GHB.15
Several issues to note were the presence of other substances (particularly alcohol and
opiates e.g. heroin, codeine, dihydrocodeine and morphine); the presence of GHB in
postmortem blood specimens, in cases where there has been no evidence of GHB use
and the GHB concentration found is sometimes low despite the user dying due to GHB
use.
Dependence on GHB has been described as developing after regular use, i.e., every 2h
round-the-clock for 2 months to 4 year.23 Withdrawal symptoms include insomnia,
Recommendations
l Psychosocial interventions are the mainstay of treatment of GHB dependence (D)
2.5. FLUNITRAZEPAM
Street names of Flunitrazepam include Roofies, Rophies, Roche, Forget-me Pill, Circles,
Mexican Valium, Rib, Roach-2, Roopies, Rope, Ropies, Ruffies, Roaches, Circles,
Forget Pill, LA Rochas, Lunch Money, Mexican Valium, Mind Erasers, Poor Man's
Quaalude, Pingus, R-2, Roches, Roofies, Roopies, Rope, Rophies, Ruffies, Trip-and-
Fall, Whiteys, Forget me drug, Reynolds, Rolpes, Reffies, Ruffles, Sedexes, wolfies.23,159
Flunitrazepamis a benzodiazepine manufactured by Roche Laboratories, is available in
more than 60 countries in Europe and Latin America for preoperative anaesthesia,
sedation, and treatment of insomnia. In the United States where it is not legally
available, imported Flunitrazepamcame to prominence in the 1990s as an inexpensive
recreational sedative and a “date rape” drug.160It is odourless and tasteless and is easily
dissolved in beverages, allowing a perpetrator to add it to the beverage of a potential
victim. Flunitrazepam has had a long history of abuse by heroin and cocaine addicts.
The manufacturers, Hoffman-La Roche, are now adding a blue dye to the pill that will be
visible if added to a beverage though the generic flunitrazepam available in the grey
market do not have the dye.159
Flunitrazepamcomes in pill form and is typically taken orally, although reports of it
being ground and snorted are also available. Users swallow or chew the tablets or allow
them to dissolve under the tongue. The act of adding such substances to drinks is known
as "drink spiking". They also crush pills and snort the powder to feel the effects more
quickly, the powder can also sprinkled on marijuana and smoked or dissolved and
injected. Users feel the effects 15-20 minutes after ingestion, and they may last for 12 or
more hours.159
In 1996, the U.S. government prohibited the import of the drug, but it remains available
in other countries and continues to be illegally brought into the U.S. Since 2001, only
the 1mg Roche tablet has been available, although generic products continue to be
available in the 2mg strength, which has been the strength preferred for misuse, since
word around the street and in the sub-culture maintains that the 2mg pill produces a
quicker and a better “high” than two 1mg pills.161 Although the generic/grey market pills
may be white and round, the original manufacturer has reformulated the 1mg pill to be a
greyish-green oval tablet.
2.5.1. Clinical Pharmacology
Chemical formula and structure of Flunitrazepam is C16H12FN3O3-5-(2-
Fluorophenyl) 1,3-dihydro-1-methyl-7-nitro-2H-1,4-benzodiazepine. It is a white solid,
with a melting point of between 166-167°C, a molecular weight of 313.3, and is soluble
in ethanol.159
2.5.2. Neurobiology
Similar to other benzodiazepines, Flunitrazepam is a GABA agonist. As such, it
mediates inhibitory neurotransmission in the brain and spinal cord.162 Benzodiazepines
bind to the GABA receptor, opening the chloride channels of neurons and resulting in
an influx of chloride and hyperpolarization of the cell. This decreases the excitability of
the cell producing sedation, anticonvulsant activity, and anxiety reduction.162
2.5.3. Clinical and adverse effects
Clinical effects of Flunitrazepam are similar to benzodiazepines.23 The effects are much
greater with the concurrent ingestion of alcohol or other sedating drugs.23
Flunitrazepam has been suggested to have a higher abuse liability than other
benzodiazepines.163 Clinical effects of Flunitrazepam include disinhibition, amnesia,
and muscle relaxation, but individual effects vary.164 The amnesia is commonly of
anterograde type, that is, it involves memory loss for events that occur after the
medication is taken.23
Adverse effects of Flunitrazepam include decreased body temperature and blood
pressure, sedation, cognitive & psychomotor impairment, visual disturbances,
dizziness, confusion, GI disturbances, urinary retention.23 The effects of Flunitrazepam
can be felt within 30 minutes of being drugged and can last for several hours. If an
individual is drugged, he/she might look and acts like someone who is drunk.
Flunitrazepam overdose may result in excessive sedation, impairment of balance and
speech, and may progress in severe overdoses to respiratory depression, coma, and
possibly death.162
Cessation of Flunitrazepamuse can result in benzodiazepine withdrawal syndrome.
The withdrawal syndrome includes headache, tension, anxiety, restlessness, muscle
pain, photosensitivity, numbness and tingling of the extremities, and increased seizure
potential.165 Gradual discontinuation may result in withdrawal symptoms including
seizures, psychosis, severe insomnia, amnesia, loss of concentration, rebound
insomnia, mood swings, depression and severe anxiety. Abrupt and rapid
discontinuation may result in suicidal or homicidal ideations, mania, delirium,
convulsions, violence, catatonia and coma. As withdrawal weans off over days to weeks
patients often find that their physical and mental health improves with improved mood
and improved cognition.162
2.5.4. Management
2.5.4.1. Toxicology and detection
While a standard component of most urine drug screens is testing for benzodiazepines,
Recommendations
l Decontamination with activated charcoal is done for patients with secured airways
and who present early (D,S)
l Flumazenil can be used to reverse the effects of Flunitrazepamtoxicity (D)
l Flunitrazepamdependence is managed by titrating doses of long acting
benzodiazepines similar to other benzodiazepine dependence (D)
l Psychosocial interventions are also useful for Flunitrazepam dependence (D)
2.6. LSD AND RELATED HALLUCINOGENS
LSD is the best-known synthetic hallucinogenic drug among the class of the
hallucinogens. Although LSD does not occur in nature, a similar analogue, lysergic acid
amine (LSA), is found in seeds of Argyreia nervosa and Ipomoea violacea used in Central
America for ceremonial purposes.168 Synthesized by Hofmann in 1938, LSD's
consciousness-altering properties were discovered accidentally a few years later. 169 Its
molecular structure and mechanism of action present similarities with serotonin, which
prompted the evaluation of its potential therapeutic use in alcoholics and patients with
mental disorders.170 In 1966, LSD was banned and in 1970 was reclassified as a
Schedule I controlled substance in an attempt to avoid its growing recreational use.171
The most common hallucinogenic fungi containing tryptamine derivatives are the
Psilocybe spp. mushrooms, which are widely distributed around the world, being
extremely used by indigenous people for centuries in sacred rituals, especially in South
American countries (particularly in Colombia), Mexico, India, Japan, New Guinea and
Australia.172,173,174 Psychoactive mushrooms soon became known worldwide as 'magic
mushrooms' and have turned famous among recreational users in the USA, Europe and
Japan. Psilocybe mushrooms, psilocybin and psilocin are classified as Schedule I drugs
in the USA, although the spores of mushrooms remain legal except California.168
Another very commonly known and used natural tryptamine is bufotenine or 5-
hydroxy-N,N-dimethyltryptamine (5-OH-DMT), an N-alkylated derivative of serotonin
and also a structural isomer of psilocin.175-178
LSD and other related hallucinogens are summarised in Table 4.
(8β)-9,10-didehydro-6- LSA (ergine) 'Morning Glory seeds' and 'Hawaiian Baby Wood
methylergoline- rose seeds' (seeds containing LSA and other
8-carboxamide alkaloids)
Other LSD related compounds ALD-52, ETH- 'Morning Glory seeds' and 'Hawaiian Baby Wood
LAD, PRO- rose seeds' (seeds containing LSA and other
LAD, AL-LAD, alkaloids)
LSZ
4-hydroxy-N,N- Psilocin 'Liberty caps' or 'Libs' are the most common wild
dimethyltryptamine UK species of magic mushroom,
Psilocybesemilanceata. Also occurring in the UK
are Panaeoluscinctulusand 'Wavy caps',
Psilocybecyanescens'Cubes' or 'Boomers' are the
most commonly home-cultivated species,
Psilocybecubensis'Truffles' or 'Philosopher's
stones' are cultivated nodular growths (technically
'sclerotia') from other Psilocybespecies.
N,N-dimethyltryptamine DMT 'Dimitri' and 'Spice' are terms sometimes used for
the white, yellow or brown DMT crystals or
powder, often used for smoking (technically
vapourising). This should not be confused with
'spice' also commonly used for synthetic
cannabinoids. 'Ayahuasca' and 'Yagé' are
decoctions that include a DMT-containing
plant and another plant containing a monoamine
oxidase inhibitor, which allows DMT to be orally
bioavailable
alpha-methyltryptamine α
MT ‘AMT'
Hallucinogenic DOM, DOI, 'STP' (for 'serenity, tranquillity and peace') was
amphetamines,DOx series and DOB, TMA-2 the original name for pills of DOM
their derivatives
Tetrahydrodifranyl compounds 2C-B-FLY, They are called 'FLY' because their molecular
bromodragonfly structure resembles the insect
Symptoms of hallucinogen overdose involve almost all the organ systems of the body
which is shown in Table 5.
A study using data from the large representative sample of the US National Survey on
Drug Use and Health found that the use of hallucinogenic drugs appears not to be
causally linked to the de novo development of chronic disorders of mental health such
as schizophrenia or depression.190 Hallucinogens are rarely a cause of substance-
induced psychosis, where the drug triggers a psychotic episode that may persist hours,
days or even weeks after the acute intoxication should have run its course.191
Nonetheless, psychotic symptoms in the context of LSD use have been reported. Salvia
can trigger psychosis in people with existing psychotic illnesses or predispositions.
Psilocybin mushrooms can cause an exacerbation of psychosis. A greater psychotic
response to LSD in persons with a genetic predisposition to schizophrenia has been
observed.192
Attempts to 'talk the patient down' first must be instituted. Sympathetic, non-
judgemental reassurance, support and observation are often sufficient. Where possible,
the patient should be placed in a well lit room with minimal disturbance. Patients may
be prone to mistrust and paranoid ideation and early efforts in empathising, expressing
understanding of their fears and establishing confidence have been shown to be
beneficial.189
Benzodiazepines, particularly diazepam or lorazepam195,196 have been reported by some
studies to be first-line choice if pharmacological interventions are needed and in cases
of agitation (IV).189 In most of the case 10 mg oral doses of diazepam (0.1–0.3 mg/kg
body weight) is sufficient (IV).24 Doses of 15–30 mg per hour or as needed have been
suggested for cases of 'bad trips' that do not respond to reassurance in an emergency
department setting.189 Larger doses may be required. Antipsychotics should be
considered as a second line if benzodiazepines do not produce adequate sedation (IV).24
In cases of severe agitation or 'excited delirium', physical restrain should be avoided, as
this is associated with sudden cardiovascular collapse.197
Recommendations
l Patient should be placed in a quiet, well lit room with minimal external stimuli (S)
l Benzodiazepines, diazepam or lorazepam are the mainstay of treatment,
particularly in presence of agitation (D)
l Antipsychotics can be considered as second line treatment (D)
2.6.4.2. Management of hallucinogen dependence
The use of LSD or other classic hallucinogens does not appear to lead to dependence.
Typically there is no persistent and compulsive pattern of use and the use of
hallucinogens is not associated with any recognised withdrawal syndrome.198
Hallucinogens do not appear to show classic patterns of tolerance, but, on the contrary,
are associated with tachyphylaxis.179 This means that sensitivity to the effects of LSD and
other hallucinogens appears to be strongly attenuated for a period after use. It may
therefore prove difficult for a user to achieve desired effects from LSD if taken two days
in a row, or indeed to get a desired effect from other hallucinogens.168,179
2.6.4.3. Management of HPPD
Pharmacological interventions for HPPD have been used but many of the studies
(especially older ones) had methodological limitations. These interventions have
included several classes of antidepressants, anxiolytics and antipsychotics, a COMT
inhibitor, naltrexone, levodopa, clonidine, lamotrigine and citalopram (IIb).24 Over the
years, there have been reports of treatment using haloperidol, diphenylhydantoin,
trifluoperazine, barbiturates, benzodiazepines, carbamazepine, sertraline, naltrexone,
clonidine, and a combination of olanzapine and fluoxetine(IIb).24 Hermle et al. have
suggested that the anti-epileptic lamotrigine may be a promising new medication for
HPPD (IV).24,199
Recommendations
Several classes of antidepressants, anxiolytics,
l antipsychotics, COMT inhibitor,
naltrexone, levodopa, clonidine, lamotrigine and citalopram can be used to treat
HPPD (B)
Lamotrigine may be a promising agent in the treatment of HPPD (D)
l
Table 6 : Treatment strategies for Club Drugs (adapted from Gahlinger, 2004)23
Cardiac monitoring
Pulse oximetry
Urinalysis
Chemistry panel
Toxicology screen if available
Seizure precautions
Consider escape and self-injury
Stimulants: Depressants:
MDMA Flunitrazepam
Ketamine (Ketalar) GHB
No standard treatment protocol has been identified for club drug overdose. Basic
management should include cardiac monitoring, pulse oximetry, urinalysis, and
performance of a comprehensive chemistry panel to check for electrolyte imbalance,
renal toxicity, and possible underlying disorders (Table 6).23 Every effort should be made
to control seizures. Gastrointestinal decontamination with activated charcoal and a
cathartic may be useful in acute exposures if the drug was taken orally within the
previous 60 minutes. Severe hypertension can be treated with labetalol, phentolamine,
nitroprusside, or similar agents. Hyperthermia should be treated immediately with tepid
water bathing and fanning. The serotonin antagonists chlorpromazine and
cyproheptadine appear to be effective in mild to moderate cases of serotonin
syndrome.200 There are no specific antidotes for ingestion of club drugs, except for
Flunitrazepam, which has already been mentioned.165 In view of the above, an
alternative is to encourage harm reduction strategies (Table 7)2 by ensuring that
buildings meet safety and health standards, adequate security is provided to
accommodate the large number of attendees and ravers are educated about health
effects by trained volunteers. NIDA website (www.clubdrugs.org) also provides useful
information regarding club drugs.
Table 7: Harm reduction strategies for raves (adapted from Weir, 2000)2
l Replenish fluids and sodium (500 mL/h if dancing, 250 mL/h if inactive)
l Take breaks from dancing
l Know the risks of adulterated drugs and the inaccuracies of logos
l Know the signs and symptoms of toxicity
l Avoid alcohol
l Ensure medical centre and team is on-site
l Don't attend a rave alone; contract with a friend to look out for each other
As with other psychoactive substances, various psychosocial interventions can be
planned for the management of club drugs dependence. These include motivational
interviewing, contingency management, CBT based relapse prevention, community
reinforcement approach, behavioural therapies, social behaviour network therapy,
supportive expressive psychotherapy so on and so forth (IV).201,202 However, in the
absence of any controlled clinical trial of psychosocial interventions for the
management of club drugs dependence, specific recommendation cannot be made.
UNODC's Global Synthetics Monitoring: Analyses, Reporting and Trends (SMART)
Programme aims to provide quality information on ATS, such as patterns of trafficking
and use, and will provide the international community with the evidence needed to
take more targeted action in areas of weakness.203 An illicit club drug community
intervention programme, 'Clubs against Drugs', was initiated in 2002 in Stockholm,
Sweden. The illicit club drug intervention was based on a systems approach top
revention.204,205 The programme included community mobilization, drug training,
increased enforcement,policy work, environmental changes and media advocacy and
public relation (PR) work [18,21] In a pre- (2003) and post-intervention study (2004 & 2008)
design The 'Clubs against Drugs' community-based intervention programme, appeared
to increase the frequency and effectiveness of club doormen's interventions regarding
obviously drug-intoxicated guests (III).206
4.1. RECOMMENDATIONS
l Suspicion of a club drug overdose /toxicity is essential
l Except for GHB, club drugs cannot be detected through routine toxicological
screens, so one should not waste valuable time
l Maintainairway, breathing and circulation (S)
1. These are often associated with status symbol amongst the neo-rich youth
2. These are often perceived to be safe or benign compared to the “hard drugs” such
as heroin, cocaine etc.
3. Some of these drugs (e.g., GHB, Rohypnol) are notorious as “rape drugs” and their
use is associated with crimes like date-rape, party rape, robbery, etc.
4. Unlike cannabis, opium or heroin, these are usually imported or smuggled from
neighboring countries
5. Some of these (e.g., MDMA) are directly neurotoxic in short and long term use
6. Contrary to their popular perception, all these drugs can have substantial toxic
effects on several systems of the body and can be potentially lethal (see Table 1,
'Toxic effects', for details)
7. These are difficult to detect through routine toxicological screening (GHB is an
exception);
8. These are notorious for spreading sexually transmitted diseases (STDs) and HIV
infection because of their intravenous route of administration
9. These are devoid of any antidote (flunitrazepam is an exception)
10. Management needs to be started early and can be difficult (see Table 6 for details)
Adapted from Chakraborty K, Neogi R, Basu D. Club drugs: Review of the 'rave' with a
note of concern for the Indian scenario. Indian J Med Res 2011;133:594-604.25
The rave parties of Goa are said to be started by the Hippies.208 Earlier Rave parties meant
loud music, alcohol and cannabis abuse. Since the late eighties, psychedelic culture in
the northern village of Anjuna became increasingly concentrated on free out-door
parties with a particular subgenre of electronic dance music, which by 1994 was known
as Goa trance and later became much darker, more minimal and aggressive, called psy-
trance.208 Rave parties in Goa happen every tourist season (November to May) which are
attended mainly by foreigners from the UK, Israel, Germany, France and Japan.209 The
bars organizing such parties sell Ecstasy or LSD.210 In last few years upper-class Indians
have massively taken to Ecstasy and clubbing and there are more women amongst
them.208 The CK1 pill is one of the trendy party drugs manufactured locally in Goa. The
pill is a combination of cocaine and the anaesthetic ketamine. CK1, also known by its
street names Blizzard and Calvin Klein, is easily available in the north Goa beach belt.
Customs officials admit that the clandestine production and smuggling of ketamine is
turning Goa into a transit point for an international drug mafia.211
Thanks to its booming software industry, Bangalore is baptized the Silicon Valley of
India and has turned into a rave hotspot.212 The spot lights in the clubs create an
atmosphere between cosy and disco, everybody drinks, most smoke and a few take
psychedelic drugs.212,213
In Pune, 280 people were arrested during a pre-dawn raid on a rave party in March
2007. The ravers were allegedly using California drops.214 A California drop is acid that
is put on a stamp, which is then chewed; the cost of each drop is put between INR 350
and 500.
Also known as white magic, drone, and mephedrone, “meow meow” is the latest and
cheapest street drug hitting Mumbai which was not even in the list of government-
banned drugs until February 2015.215 A very recent newspaper article reported that African
connection to drug peddling in the city of Hyderabad seems to be on the wane. Records
from the Narcotics Control Bureau revealed that drug rackets have moved closer home,
with suppliers now mostly hailing from Nepal and Myanmar.216
Sometimes police directly raid rave parties in plain clothes and catch ravers red-handed.
People who are found in the Rave Party are often booked under Section 27 of the
Narcotic Drugs and Psychotropics Substances Act of 1985 and Section 294 of the Indian
Penal Code.
5. CONCLUSION
Club drugs are a menace to the society. Their use, other than for strictly medical or
approved research purposes, should be prohibited through legislation and awareness
generation. Even though the “club drug” phenomenon was identified early, scientific
information about these drugs, their identification, and short- and long-term effects are
still evolving. The lack of research-based information on the adverse effects of these
drugs has led to the emergence of a range of web sites that may or may not provide
accurate information. India has a huge teenage population which is being targeted by
foreign drug peddlers to flourish their business. Club drugs continue to be modified and
evolve, making them very difficult to monitor. As health professionals we should remain
well informed regarding club drugs and their management protocol. To the best of our
knowledge this is the only guideline which solely focuses on the management of club
drugs toxicity, dependence and withdrawal and makes specific recommendations to
manage those conditions. There is another guideline24 which deals with the
management of acute and chronic harms of club drugs along with other psychoactive
substances. Therefore, this guideline provides us with a unique opportunity to make
ourselves familiar with various club drugs available in the market and enable us to deal
more effectively with the medical problems arising out of using these substances.
REFERENCES
1. Rome ES. It's a rave new world: Rave culture and illicit drug use in the young. Cleve
Clin J Med 2001; 68: 541-550.
2. Weir E. Raves: a review of the culture, thedrugs and the prevention of harm. CMAJ
2000; 162: 1843-1848.
3. National Institute on Drug Abuse. Community drug alert bulletin—“club drugs”
[Online]. 1999 [cited 2015 Sept 15]; Available from: URL:http: //165.112.78.61/
DrugPages/Clubdrugs.html
4. Office of National Drug Control Policy [Online]. 2004. [cited 2015 Sept 15]; Available
from: URL:http://www.whitehousedrugpolicy.gov/drugfactlclub/club_b. html#g03
5. Maxwell JC. Party Drugs: Properties, Prevalence, Patterns, and Problems. Subst Use
Misuse 2005; 40: 1203-1240.
6. Drug Enforcement Administration [Online]. 2004a [cited 2015 Sept 15]; Available
from: URL:http://www.dea.gov/concern/ghb-1actsheet.html
7. Liechti ME, Bauman C, Gamma A, Vollenweider FX. Acute psychological effectsof 3,4-
methylenedioxy-methamphetamine (MDMA, "Ecstasy") are attenuated by the
serotoninuptake inhibitor citalopram. Neuropsychopharmacology 2000; 22: 513-521.
8. TerBogt TFM, Engels RCME. “Partying” Hard: Party Style, Motives for and Effects of
MDMA Use at RaveParties. Subst Use Misuse 2005; 40: 1479-1502.
9. Vollenweider FX, Gamma A, Liecthi M, Huber T. Psychological and cardiovascular
effects and short-term sequelae of MDMA ("Ecstasy") in MDMA-naive healthy
volunteers. Neuropsychopharmacology 1998; 19: 241-251.
10. Buffum J, Moser C. MDMA and human sexual function. J Psychoactive Drugs 1986; 18:
355-359.
11. Zemishlany Z, Aizenberg D, Weizman A. Subjective effects of MDMA ('Ecstasy') on
human sexual function. Eur Psychiatry 2001; 16: 127-130.
12. Topp L, Kaye S, Bruno R, Longo M, Williams P, O'Reilly B, et al. Australian Drug
Trends 2001: Findings of the Illicit Drug Reporting System (IDRS). NDARC Monograph
No. 48. UNSW, Sydney: National Drug and Alcohol Research Centre; 2002.
13. Parrott AC, Buchanan T, Scholey AB, Heffernan T, Ling J, Rodgers J. Ecstasy/MDMA
attributed problems reported by novice, moderate and heavy recreational users. Hum
PsychopharmacolClinExp 2002; 17: 309-312.
14. Smith KM, Larive LL, Romanelli F. Club drugs: Methylene dioxymethamphetaine,
flunitrazepam, ketamine hydrochloride, and ë-hydroxybutyrate. Am J Health Syst
Pharm 2002; 59: 1067-1076.
15. Goss J. Designer drugs: Assess and manage patients intoxicated with Ecstasy, GHB, or
Rohypnol—the three most commonly abused designer drugs. JEMS 2001; 26: 84-87,
90-93.
16. National Institute on Drug Abuse (NIDA). NIDA Community Drug Alert Bulletin-Club
Drugs [Online]. 2003 [cited 2015 Sept 15]; Available from:
URL:http://www.drugabuse.gov/clubalert/clubdrugalert.html
17. Drug Enforcement Administration (DEA) [Online]. 2004b [cited 2015 Sept 15];
Available from: URL:http://www.dea.gov/pubs/inteI/01026/index.html
18. Gupta RK, Jain BK, Singh S, Garg M, Kashyap J. Behavioural and
neuropharmacological profiles of ketamine. Indian J Pharmacol 1988; 20: 211-212.
19. Cotman CW, Monaghan DT. Chemistry and anatomy of excitatory amino acid systems.
In: Meltzer HY, editor. Psychopharmacology: The Third Generation of Progress. New
York: Raven; 1987 .p. 194-210.
20. Prabhakar Rao P, Subbu VSV. Cardiovascular and other pharmacological actions of
Ketamine. Indian J Pharmacol 1977; 9: 273-277.
21. Bialer PA. Designer drugs in the general hospital. PsychiatrClin North Am 2002; 25:
231-243.
22. Sporer KA, Chin RL, Dyer JE, Lamb R. Gamma-hydroxybutyrate serum levels and
clinical syndrome after severe overdose. Ann Emerg Med 2003; 42: 3-8.
23. Gahlinger PM. Club Drugs: MDMA, Gamma-Hydroxybutyrate(GHB), Rohypnol, and
Ketamine. Am Fam Physician 2004; 69: 2619-2626.
24. Abdulrahim D, Bowden-Jones O, editors. Guidance on the Managementof Acute and
Chronic Harms of Club Drugs and Novel Psychoactive Substances. London: Novel
PsychoactiveTreatment UK Network (NEPTUNE); 2015.
25. Chakraborty K, Neogi R, Basu D. Club drugs: Review of the 'rave' with a note of
concern for the Indian scenario. Indian J Med Res 2011;133:594-604.
26. Beck F, Iegleye S, Peretti-Watel P. Survey EROPP 2002. Paris: OFDT; 2003.
27. Australian Institute of Health and Welfare. 2001 National Drug Strategy Household
Survey:First results. Canberra, Australia: Australian Institute of Health (Drug Statistics
Series); 2002.
28. Wilkins C, Casswell S, Bhatta K, Pledger M. Drug use in New Zealand: National
surveyscomparison 1998 and 2001. Auckland, New Zealand: Alcohol and Public
Health Research Unit; 2002.
29. SAMSHA 2001. National Survey on Drug Use and Mental Health. USA: Substance
Abuse and MentalHealth Services Administration; 2002.
30. Drug use among Ontario students 2003. Ontario, Canada: Centre for Addiction and
Mental Health; 2003.
31. Wu LT, Schlenger WE, Galvin DM. Concurrent use of methamphetamine, MDMA,
LSD, ketamine,GHB, and flunitrazepam among American youths. Drug Alcohol
Depend 2006; 84: 102–113.
32. Meyer JS. 3,4-Methylenedioxymethamphetamine (MDMA): current perspectives.
Subst Abuse Rehabil 2013;4: 83-99.
33. Parsons JT, Grove C, Kelly BC. Club drugs use and dependence among young adults
recruited through time-space sampling. Public Health Rep 2009; 124: 246-254.
34. Cottler LB, Leung KS, Abdallah AB. Test–re-test reliability of DSM-IV adopted criteria
for 3,4-methylenedioxymethamphetamine (MDMA) abuse and dependence: a cross-
national study. Addiction 2009; 104:1679-1690
35. Vitale, S., van de Mheen, D. Illicit drug use and injuries: A review of emergency room
studies.Drug Alcohol Depend 2006; 82:1–9.
36. Wood DM, Button J, Ashraf T, Walker S, Greene SL, Ramsey J, et al. What evidenceis
there that the UK should tackle the potential emerging threat of methamphetamine
toxicityrather than established recreational drugs such as MDMA ('Ecstasy')? QJM
2008; 101:207–21.
37. Wood DM, Warren-Gash C, Ashraf T, Greene SL, Shather Z, Trivedy C, et al.
Medicaland legal confusion surrounding gamma-hydroxybutyrate (GHB) and its
precursors gamma-butyrolactone (GBL) and 1,4-butanediol (1,4BD). QJM 2008;
101:23–29.
38. Wood DM, Nicolaou M, Dargan PI. Epidemiology of Recreational Drug Toxicityin a
Nightclub Environment. Subst Use Misuse 2009; 44:1495–1502.
39. Van Etten ML, Neumark YD, Anthony JC. Male-female differences in the earliest stages
of drug involvement. Addiction 1999; 94:1413-1419.
40. Measham FC, Aldridge J, Parker H. Dancing on drugs: risk, healthand hedonism in the
British club scene. London: Free AssociationBooks; 2001.
41. Topp L, Hando J, Dillon P, Roche A, Solowij N. Ecstasy use in
Australia:patternsofuseandassociatedharm.DrugAlcoholDepend1999; 55:105-115.
42. A k r a m G , G a l t M . A p r o f i l e o f h a r m - r e d u c t i o n p r a c t i c e s a n d
couseofillicitandlicitdrugsamongstusersofdancedrugs.Drugs EducPrev Pol 1999;
6:215-225.
43. Boys A, Marsden J, Griffiths P, Fountain J, Stillwell G, Strang J.Substance use among
young people: the relationship betweenperceived functions and intentions. Addiction
1999; 94:1043-1050.
44. Verudin ML, Payne RA, McRae AL, Back SE, Simpson SA, Sarang RY, et al. Assessment
of Club Drug use in a treatment-seeking sample of individualswith Marijuana
Dependence. Am J Addict 2007; 16:484–487.
45. Wu LT, Parrott AC, Ringwalt CL, Patkar AA, Mannelli P, Blazer DG. The high
prevalence of substance use disorders among recent MDMA users comparedwith
other drug users: Implications for intervention. Addict Behav 2009; 34: 654–661.
46. Goldsmat LA, O'Brien J, Clatts MC, McGuire LS. The Relationship between Club Drug
Use and Other Drug Use: A Survey of New York City Middle School Students. Subst
Use Misuse 2005; 40:1539–1555.
47. Hopfer C, Mendelson B, Van Leeuwen JM, Kelly S, Hooks S. Club Drug Use among
Youths in Treatment for Substance Abuse. Am J Addict 2006; 15: 94-99
48. Maxwell JC. Party Drugs: Properties, Prevalence, Patterns,and Problems. Subst Use
Misuse 2005; 40:1203–1240.
49. Reback CJ, Grella CE. HIV risk behaviours of gay and bisexual male
methamphetamineusers contacted through street outreach. J Drug Issues 1999;
29:155–166.
166 © Indian Psychiatric Society 2016
Club Drugs
50. Lewis LA, Ross MW. A Select Body: The Gay Dance Party Subculture and the
HIV/AIDSPandemic. London: Cassell; 1995.
51. Frosch D, Shoptaw S, Huber A, Rawson RA, Ling W. Sexual HIV risk among gay
andbisexual male methamphetamine abusers. J Subst Abuse Treat 1996; 13:483–486.
52. Kippax S, Campbell D, Van de Ven P, Crawford J, Prestage G, Knox S, et al. (1998).
Cultures of sexual adventurism as markers Of HIV seroconversion: A case control study
in a cohort of Sydney gay men. AIDS Care 1998;10:677–688
53. Henry JA. Ecstacy and the dance of death. BMJ 1992; 305:5–6.
54. Clatts MC, Goldsamt LA, Yi H. Club Drug use among young men who have sex with
men in NYC: A Preliminary Epidemiological Pro? le. Subst Use Misuse 2005;
40:1317–1330.
55. Banta-Green C, Goldbaum G, Kingston S, Golden M, Harruff R, Logan BK.
Epidemiology of MDMA and Associated Club Drugs in the Seattle Area. Subst Use
Misuse2005, 40:1295–1315.
56. Halkitis PN, Palamer JJ. Multivariate modeling of Club Drug use initiation among gay
and bisexual men. Subst Use Misuse 2008; 43: 871-879.
57. Soellner R. Club Drug use In Germany. Subst Use Misuse 2005; 40:1279–1293.
58. Kraus L, Augustin R. Population survey on the consumption of psychoactivesubstances
in the German adult population 2000. Sucht 2001;47(S1):35-43.
59. Tossmann HP, Heckmann W. The consumption of drugs among young people in
thetechno party scene: An empirical and explorative study regarding the necessity and
possibilitiesof preventing drugs related to target groups. Koln: Bundeszentrale fur
gesundheitlicheAufklarung; 1997.
60. Tossmann HP, Boldt S, Tensil MD. Ecstasy—“one-way street” to addiction? Patterns of
drug use in the technoparty scene and its changes on a long-term perspective. Koln:
Bundeszentrale fur gesundheitlicheAufkl¨arung; 2001.
61. Wilkins C, Casswell S, Bhatta K, Pledger M. Drug use in New Zealand: National
surveyscomparison 1998 and 2001. Auckland: .Alcohol and Public Health Research
Unit; 2002
62. Abraham M, Kaal H, Cohen P. Licit and Illicit Drug Use in the Netherlands
2001.Amsterdam: CEDRO/Mets enSchilt; 2002.
63. National Plan on Drugs. Spain: Household Survey on Drugs; 2001.
64. Beck F, Iegleye S, Peretti-Watel P. Paris: Survey EROPP 2002; 2003.
65. Drug use among Ontario students, 1977–2003. Ontario: Centrefor Addiction and
Mental Health; 2003
66. Aust R. Prevalence of Drug Use: Key Findings from the 2001/2002 British Crime
Survey.London: Home Of? ce; 2002.
67. Australian Institute of Health and Welfare. 2001 National Drug Strategy Household
Survey:First results. Canberra: Australian Institute of Health (Drug Statistics Series);
2002.
68. Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration. Results from the 2001
NationalHousehold Survey on Drug Abuse: Volume I. Summary of National Findings.
Rockville, MD:SAMHSA, US Department of Health and Human Services; 2002
69. Johnston LD, O'Malley PM, Bachman JG. National Survey Results on Drug Use
fromthe Monitoring the Future Study, 1975–2003. Rockville, MD: National Institute
on Drug Abuse; 2003
70. Gripenberg-Abdon J, Elgan TH, Wallin E, Shaafati M, Beck O, Andreasson S.
Measuring substance use in the club setting. Subst Abuse Treat Prev Pol 2012; 7:7-17.
71. Havere TV, Vanderplasschen W, Lammertyn J, Broekaert G, Bellis M. Drug use and
nightlife: More than just dance music. Subst Abuse Treat Prev Pol 2011, 6:18-29.
72. Greer GR, Tolbert R. A method of conducting therapeutic sessions with MDMA. J
PsychoactiveDrugs 1998; 30: 371-379.
73. Multidisciplinary Association for Psychedelic Studies (MAPS) [Online]. 2004 [cited
2015 Sept 15]; Available from: URL:http://www.maps.org/researchlmdmaplan.html
74. U.S. Department of Justice, Drug Enforcement Administration. Schedules of
ControlledSubstances; Scheduling of 3, 4 Methylenedioxymethamphetamine
(MDMA) Into Schedule I ofthe Controlled Substances Act; Remand. Federal Register
1988; 53: 5156-5158.
75. Abdallah AB, Scheier LM, Inciardi JA, Copeland J, Cottler LB. A Psycho-Economic
Model of Ecstasy Consumption and RelatedConsequences: A Multi-Site Study With
Community Samples. Subst Use Misuse 2007; 42: 1651-1684.
76. Leung KS, Abdallah AB, Copeland J, Cottler LB. Modifiable risk factors of Ecstasy use:
Risk perception, current dependence,perceived control, and depression. Addict Behav
2010; 35:201-208.
77. Wu ZH, Gardy JJ, Rosales S, Berenson AB. Ecstasy use and its correlates among young,
low-income women. Subst Use Misuse 2011; 46:404–410.
78. Winstock AR, Wolff K, Ramsey J. Ecstasy pill testing: Harm minimization gone too
far?Addiction 2001; 96:1139-1148.
79. Parrott AC. Is Ecstasy MDMA? A review of the proportion of Ecstasy tablets
containingMDMA, their dosage levels, and the changing perceptions of purity.
Psychopharmacology 2004; 173:234-241.
80. Singh AN. Ecstasy and Prozac. New Scientist 1995; 1999: 51.
81. Singh AN, Catalan J. Rave drug (ecstasy) and selective serotonin reuptake inhibitor anti-
depressants. Indian J Psychiatry 2000; 42:195-197.
82. Bialer PA. Designer drugs in the general hospital. PsychiatrClin North Am 2002; 25:
231-243.
83. Britt GC, McCance-Katz EF. A Brief Overview of the Clinical Pharmacologyof "Club
Drugs". Subst Use Misuse 2005; 40: 1189-1201.
84. Sprague J, Everman S, Nichols D. An integrated hypothesis for the serotonergic
axonalloss induced by 3, 4-methylenedioxymethamphetamine. Neurotoxicology
1998; 19:427-441.
85. Gouzoulis-Mayfrank E, Daumann J. Neurotoxicity of methylenedioxyamphetamines
(MDMA; ecstasy) in humans: how strong is the evidence for persistent brain damage?
Addiction 2006; 101:348–361.
86. M terBogt TF, Engels RC. ''Partying” Hard: Party style, motives for and effects of MDMA
use at rave parties. Subst Use Misuse 2005; 40:1479–1502.
87. McElrath K. MDMA and Sexual Behaviour: Ecstasy users' perceptions about sexuality
and sexual risk. Subst Use Misuse 2005; 40:1461–1477.
88. Chen T, Yen C. Sexual intercourse experience and engagement in unprotected sex in
adolescent MDMA users in Taiwan. Subst Use Misuse 2011;46:398–403
89. Baylen CA, Rosenberg H. A review of the acute subjective effects of MDMA/ecstasy.
Addiction 2006; 101: 933–947
90. Klitzman RL, Pope HG Jr, Hudson JI. MDMA ("Ecstasy") abuse and high-risk sexual
behaviours among 169 gay and bisexual men. Am J Psychiatry 2000; 157:1162-1164.
91. Schwartz R, Norman M. MDMA and the rave: a review. Pediatr1997; 100:705-708.
92. Holmes SB, Banerjee AK, Alexander WD. Hyponatremia and seizures after Ecstasy use.
Postgrad Med J 1999; 75: 32-33.
93. Budisavljevic MN, Stewart L, Sahn SA, Ploth DW. Hyponatremia associated with 3,4-
methylenedioxymethylamphetamine (“Ecstasy”) abuse. Am J Med Sci 2003; 326: 89-93.
94. Koesters SC, Rogers PD, Rajasingham CR. MDMA ('Ecstasy') and other 'club drugs.'
The new epidemic. PediatrClin North Am 2002; 49: 415-33.
95. Ricaurte GA, McCann UD, Szabo J, Scheffel U. Toxicodynamics and long-term toxicity
of the recreational drug, 3, 4-methylenedioxymethamphetamine (MDMA,
'Ecstasy').Toxicol Lett 2000;112-113:143-146.
96. Koprich JB, Chen EY, Kanaan NM, Campbell NG, Kordower JH, Lipton JW. Prenatal
3,4-methylenedioxymethamphetamine (ecstasy) alters exploratory behaviour, reduces
monoamine metabolism, and increases forebrain tyrosine hydroxylase ? ber density of
juvenile rats. NeurotoxicolTeratol 2003; 25:509–517.
97. Tong T, Boyer EW. Club drugs, smart drugs, raves, and circuit parties: An overview of
the club scene. Ped Emerg Care 2002; 18:216-218.
98. Moeller MF, Kraemer T. Drugs of abuse monitoring in blood for control of driving
under the influence of drugs. Ther Drug Monit 2002; 24:210-221.
99. Liechti ME, Kunz I, Kupferschmidt H. Acute medical problems due to ecstasy use.
Swiss Med Wkly2005;135: 652–657.
100. Halpern P, Moskovich J, Avrahami B, Bentur Y, Sofer D, Peleg K. Morbidity associated
withMDMA (ecstasy) abuse – a survey of emergency department admissions. Hum
ExpToxicol2011; 30:259–266
101. Meehan TJ, Bryant SM, Aks SE. Drugs of abuse: the highs and lows of altered mental
states in the emergency department. Emerg Med Clin North Am 2010;28:663-682.
102. Campbell GA, Rosner MH. The agony of ecstasy: MDMA (3,4-
methylenedioxymethamphetamine) and the kidney. Clin J Am SocNephrol
2008;3:1852–1860.
103. Grunau BE, Wiens MO, Brubacher JR. Dantrolene in the treatment of MDMA-related
hyperpyrexia: a systematic review. CJEM 2010; 12:435–442
104. National Institute onDrug Abuse. MDMA (Ecstasy) abuse [Online]. 2006 [cited 2015
Sept 15]; Available from: URL:http://www.drugabuse.gov/publications/research-
reports/mdma-ecstasy-abuse
105. Tellier PP. Club drugs: is it all Ecstasy? Pediatric Ann 2002; 31:550-556.
106. Curran HV, Monaghan L. In and out of the k-hole: A comparison of the acute and
residual effects of ketamine in frequent and infrequent ketamine users. Addiction
2001; 96:749-760.
107. Pal HR, Berry N, Kumar R, Ray R. Ketamine dependence. Anaesth Intensive Care
2002;30:382–384
108. Goyal S, Ambekar A, Ray R. Ketamine dependence in an Anesthesiologist: An
occupational hazard? Indian J Psychol Med 2014; 36:335–337.
109. Leung KS, Li JH, Tsay WI, Callahan C, Liu SF, Hsu J, et al. Dinosaur girls, candy girls,
and Trinity: voices of Taiwanese club drug users. J EthnSubst Abuse 2008;7:237-257
110. Chen W. Huang M, Lin S. Gender differences in subjective discontinuation symptoms
associated with ketamine use. Subst Abuse Treat Prev Pol 2014, 9:39-46.
111. Tung CK, Yeung SW, Chiang TP, Xu K, Lam M. Reliability and Validity of the Severity of
Dependence Scale in a Chinese Sample of Treatment-seeking Ketamine Users. East
Asian Arch Psychiatry 2014; 24:156-164.
112. Koesters SC, Rogers PD, Rajasingham CR. MDMA ('ecstasy') and other 'club drugs'.
The new epidemic. PediatrClin North Am 2002; 49:415-433.
113. Sunder RA, Toshniwal G, Dureja GP. Ketamine as anadjuvant in sympathetic blocks
for management of centralsensitization following peripheral nerve injury. J
BrachialPlexPeripher Nerve Inj2008; 3:22–28.
114. Lynch ME, Clark AJ, Sawynok J, Sullivan MJ. Topicalamitriptyline and ketamine in
neuropathic pain syndromes:an open-label study. J Pain2005; 6:644–649.
115. Correll GE, Maleki J, Gracely EJ, Muir JJ, Harbut RE.Subanesthetic ketamine infusion
therapy: a retrospectiveanalysis of a novel therapeutic approach to complexregional
pain syndrome. Pain Med 2004; 5:263-275.
116. Morgan CJA, Curran HV. Ketamine use: A review. Addiction 2011; 107:27-38.
117. Harihar C, Dasari P, Srinivas JS. Intramuscular ketamine in acute depression: A report
on two cases. Indian J Psychiatry 2013;55:186-188.
118. Andrade C, Rao NS. How antidepressant drugs act: A primer on neuroplasticity as the
eventual mediator of antidepressant efficacy. Indian J Psychiatry 2010;52:378-386
119. GuhaThakurta R, Das R, Bhattacharya AK, Saha D, Sen S, Singh OP, et al. Rapid
Response with Ketamine on Suicidal Cognition in Resistant Depression. Indian J
Psychol Med 2012; 34:170-175.
120. Ohta N, Ohashi Y, Fujino Y. Ketamine inhibits maturation of bone marrow-derived
dendritic cells and priming of the Th1-type immune response. AnesthAnalg2009;109:
793-800.
121. Pal HR, Berry N, Kumar R, Ray R. Ketamine dependence. Anaesth Intensive Care 2002;
30: 382-384.
122. Jansen KLR. A review of the nonmedical use of ketamine: Use, users and
consequences. J Psychoactive Drugs 2000; 32:419-433.
123. Critchlow DG: A case of ketamine dependence with discontinuation symptoms.
Addiction 2006; 101:1212–1213.
124. Lim DK: Ketamine associated psychedelic effects and dependence. Singapore Med J
2003, 44:31–34.
125. Blachut M, Solowiow K, Janus A, Ruman J, Cekus A, Matysiakiewicz J, et al. A case of
ketamine dependence. Psychiatr Pol 2009; 43:593–599.
126. Cotman CW, Monaghan DT. Chemistry and anatomy of excitatory amino acid systems.
In: Meltzer HY, editor. Psychopharmacology: The Third Generation of Progress. New
York: Raven; 1987 .p. 194-210.
127. Taffe MA, Davis SA, Gutierrez T, Gold LH. Ketamine impairs multiple cognitive
domains in Rhesus monkeys. Drug Alcohol Depend 2002; 68:175-187.
128. Morgan CJ, Muetzelfeldt L, Curran HV. Ketamine use, cognition and psychological
wellbeing: a comparison of frequent, infrequent and ex-users with polydrug and
nonusing controls. Addiction2009; 104:77–87.
129. Liao Y, Tang J, Ma M, Wu Z, Yang M, Wang X, et al. Frontal white matter abnormalities
following chronic ketamine use: a diffusion tensor imaging study. Brain 2010:
133;2115–2122
130. Gill JR, Stajic M. Ketamine in non-hospital and hospital deaths in New York City. J
Forensic Sci 2000; 45:655-658.
131. Parke-Davis. Parke-Davis Product information Sheet: Ketalar. ABPI Compendium of
Data Sheets and Summaries of Product Characteristics. Datapharm Publications; 1999-
2000.
132. Weiner AL, Vieira L, McKay CA, Bayer MJ. Ketamine abusers presenting to the
emergency department: a case series. J Emerg Med 2000;18:447–451.
133. Smith KM, Larive LL, Romanelli F. Club drugs: methylene dioxymethamphetaine,
? unitrazepam, ketamine hydrochloride, and gamma-hydroxybutyrate. Am J Health
Syst Pharm 2002; 59:1067-1076.
134. Ng SH, Tse ML, Ng HW, Lau FL. Emergency department presentation of ketamine
abusers in Hong Kong: a review of 233 cases. Hong Kong Med J 2010; 16:6–11.
135. Copeland J, Dillon P. The health and psycho-social consequences of ketamine use. Int J
Drug Policy 2005; 16:122–131.
136. Critchlow DG. A case of ketamine dependence with discontinuation symptoms.
Addiction. 2006; 101:1212–1213.
137. Maxwell JC. The response to club drug use. CurrOpinPsychiatr 2003;16:279-289.
138. Laborit H. Sodium 4-hydroxybutyrate. Neuropharmaco 1964; 43:433-452.
139. Gallimberti L, Cibin M, Pagnin P, Sabbion R, Pani PP, Pirastu R, et al. Gamma-
hydroxybutyric acid for treatment of opiate withdrawal syndrome.
Neuropsychopharmacology 1993; 9:77-81.
140. Scharf MB, Hauck M, Stover R, McDannold M, Berkowitz D. Effect of
gammahydroxybutyrate on pain, fatigue, and the alpha sleep anomaly in patients with
fibromyalgia. Preliminary report. J Rheumatol 1998; 25:1986-90.
141. Caputo F, Addolorato G, Lorenzini F, Domenicali M, Greco G, del RE A, et al. Gamma-
hydroxybutyric acid versus naltrexone in maintaining alcohol abstinence: An open
randomized comparative study. Drug Alcohol Depend 2003; 70:85-91.
142. Addolorato G, Caputo F, Capristo E, Stefanini GF, Gasbarrini G.
Gammahydroxybutyric acid: Efficacy, potential abuse, and dependence in the
treatment of alcohol addiction. Alcohol 2000; 20:217-222.
143. Ward D, Morgenthaler J, Fowkes S. GHB – the natural mood enhancer. California,
USA: Smart Publications; 1998.
144. Thai D , Dyer JE, Jacob P , Haller CA. Clinical pharmacology of 1,4- butanediol and
gamma-hydroxybutyrate after oral 1,4-butanediol administration to healthy volunteers
. ClinPharmacolTher 2007; 81:178-184 .
145. Mégarbane B , Fompeydie D, Garnier R , Baud F J. Treatment of a 1,4-butanediol
poisoning with fomepizole . J ToxicolClinToxicol 2002; 40:77-80
163. Mintzer MZ, Griffiths RR. Flunitrazepam and triazolam: A comparison of behavioural
effects and abuse liability. Drug Alcohol Depend 1998; 53:49-66.
164. Rome ES. Cleve Clin J Med 2001; 68:541-550.
165. Schwartz RH, Weaver AB. Rohypnol, the date rape drug. ClinPediatr1998; 37:321-
322.
166. Alain G. Verstraete, Detection times of drugs of abuse in blood, urine, and oral fluid,
Ther Drug Monit 2004; 26:200-205.
167. Chakraborty K, Dan A. Clinical Practice Guidelines (CPG) for the Management of
Sedative-Hypnotic Use Disorders. In: Basu D, Dalal PK, editors. Clinical Practice
Guidelines for the Assessment and Management of Substance Use Disorders.
Hyderabad: Indian Psychiatric Society Specialty Section on Substance Use Disorders
(IPS-SS-SUD), Aparna Graphics; 2014 .p. 297-344
168. Halpern JH. Hallucinogens and dissociative agents naturally growing in the United
States. PharmacolTher 2004;102:131-138.
169. Hagenbach D, Werthmuller L. Mystic chemist: the life of Albert Hofmann and his
discovery of LSD. Santa Fe, New Mexico: Synergetic Press; 2011.
170. Nichols DE. Serotonin, and the past and future of LSD. MAPS Bull 2013; 23:20–23.
171. Smith DE, Raswyck GE, Davidson LD. From Hofmann to the Haight Ashbury, and into
the future: the past and potential of lysergic acid diethylamide. J Psychoact Drugs 2014;
46:3–10
172. Matsushima Y, Eguchi F, Kikukawa T, Matsuda T. Historical overview of psychoactive
mushrooms. Inflamm Regen 2009; 29:47–58
173. Wurst M, Kysilka R, Flieger M. Psychoactive tryptamines from basidiomycetes. Folia
Microbiol 2002; 47:3–27
174. Cunningham N. Hallucinogenic plants of abuse. Emerg Med Australas 2008:
20:167–174
175. Chamakura RP. Bufotenine—a hallucinogen in ancient snuff powders of South
America and a drug of abuse on the streets of New York City. Forensic Sci Rev 1994;
6:1-18
176. Weil AT, Davis W. Bufoalvarius: a potent hallucinogen of animal origin. J
Ethnopharmacol 1994; 41:1–8
177. Ujvary I. Psychoactive natural products: overview of recent developments. Ann Ist
Super Sanita 2014; 50:12–27.
178. Moretti C, Gaillard Y, Grenand P, Bevalot F, Prevosto JM. Identification of 5-hydroxy-
tryptamine (bufotenine) in takini (Brosimumacutifolium Huber subsp. acutifolium C.C.
Berg, Moraceae), a shamanic potion used in the Guiana Plateau. J Ethnopharmacol
2006; 106:198–202.
179. Fantegrossi WE, Murnane KS, Reissig CJ. The behavioural pharmacology of
hallucinogens. BiochemPharmacol 2008; 75:17–33.
180. Brandt SD, Freeman S, McGagh P, Abdul-Halim N, Alder JF. An analytical perspective
on favoured synthetic routes to the psychoactive tryptamines. J Pharm Biomed Anal
2004; 36:675–691
181. Sklerov JH, Magluilo J Jr, Shannon KK, Smith ML. Liquid chromatography-electrospray
ionization mass spectrometry for the detection of lysergide and a major metabolite, 2-
oxo-3-hydroxy- LSD, in urine and blood. J Anal Toxicol 2000; 24:543–554.
182. Hasler F, Bourquin D, Brenneisen R, Vollenweider FX. Renal excretion profiles of
psilocin following oral administration of psilocybin: a controlled study in man. J Pharm
Biomed Anal 2002; 30:331–339.
183. Sitaram BR, Lockett L, Talomsin R, Blackman GL, McLeod WR. In vivo metabolism of
5-methoxy-N,N-dimethyltryptamine and N,N-dimethyltryptamine in the rat.
BiochemPharmacol 1987; 36:1509–1512.
184. Titeler M, Lyon RA, Glennon RA. Radioligand binding evidence implicates the brain 5-
HT2 receptor as a site of action for LSD and phenylisopropylamine hallucinogens.
Psychopharmacology 1998; 94:213–216.
185. Blair JB, Kurrasch-Orbaugh D, Marona-Lewicka D Cumbay MG, Watts VJ, Barker EL, et
al. Effect of ring fluorination on the pharmacology of hallucinogenic tryptamines. J Med
Chem 2000; 43:4701–4710.
186. Halberstadt AL, Geyer MA. Multiple receptors contribute to the behavioural effects of
indoleamine hallucinogens. Neuropharmacology 2011; 61:364–381.
187. Ray TS. Psychedelics and the human receptorome. PLoS One 2010; 5:e9019.
188. Bulling S, Schicker K, Zhang YW, Steinkellner T, Stockner T, Gruber CW, et al. The
mechanistic basis for noncompetitiveibogaine inhibition of serotonin and dopamine
transporters. J BiolChem 2012; 287:18524–18534.
189. Johnson M, Richards W, Griffiths R. Human hallucinogen research: guidelines for
safety. J Psychopharmacol 2008; 22:603–620.
190. Krebs TS, Johansen PO. Psychedelics and mental health: a population study. PloS One.
2013; 8:e63972.
191. Keshavan MS, Kaneko Y. Secondary psychoses: an update. World Psychiatry 2013;
12:4-15.
192. van Amsterdam J, Opperhuizen A, van den Brink W. Harm potential of magic
mushroom use: a review. RegulToxicolPharmacol 2011; 59:423–429.
193. Baggott MJ, Coyle JR, Erowid E, Erowid F, Robertson LC. Abnormal visual experiences
in individuals with histories of hallucinogen use: A web-based questionnaire. Drug
Alcohol Depend 2011; 114:61–67.
194. Halpern JH, Pope HG Jr. Hallucinogen persisting perception disorder: what do we
know after 50 years? Drug Alcohol Depend 2003; 69:109-119.
195. Williams RH, Erickson T. Evaluating hallucinogenic or psychedelic drug intoxication
in an emergency setting. Lab Med 2000; 31:394–401.
196. Meehan TJ, Bryant SM, Aks SE. Drugs of abuse: the highs and lows of altered mental
states in the emergency department. Emerg Med Clin North Am 2010; 28:663–682.
197. Huesgen K. Towards evidence-based emergency medicine: best BETs from the
Manchester Royal Infirmary. BET 1: excited delirium syndrome and sudden death.
Emerg Med J 2013; 30:958– 960.
198. Griffiths RR, Johnson MW, Richards WA, Richards BD, McCann U, Jesse R. Psilocybin
occasioned mystical-type experiences: immediate and persisting dose-related effects.
Psychopharmacology 2011; 218:649–665.
199. Hermle L, Simon M, Ruchsow M, Batra A, Geppert M. Hallucinogen persisting
perception disorder (HPPD) and flashback - are they identical? J Alcoholism Drug
Depend 2013; 1:121.
200. Martin TG. Serotonin syndrome. Ann Emerg Med 1996; 28:520-526.
201. Smedslund G, Berg RC, Hammerstrøm KT, SteiroA, Leiknes KA, Dahl HM, et al.
Motivational interviewing for substance abuse. Cochrane Database Syst Rev 2011;
(5):CD008063.
202. Knapp WP, Soares BG, Farrel M, Lima MS. Psychosocial interventions for cocaine and
psychostimulant amphetamines related disorders. Cochrane Database Syst Rev 2007;
(3):CD003023
203. UNODC Annual Report 2009 [Online]. 2009 [cited 2015 Sept 15]; Available from:
URL:http://www.unodc.org/documents/about-unodc/AR09_LORES.pdf
204. Holder HD. Alcohol and the Community: A Systems Approach to Prevention.
Cambridge: Cambridge University Press; 1998.
205. Birckmayer J, Fisher DA, Holder HD, Yacoubian GS Jr. Prevention of
methamphetamine abuse: can existing evidence informcommunity prevention? J Drug
Educ 2008; 38:147–165.
206. Abdon JG, Wallin E, Andreasson S. Long-term effects of a community-based
intervention: 5-year follow-up of 'Clubs against Drugs'. Addiction 2011;
106:1997–2004
207. Ray R. The Extent, Pattern and Trends of Drug Abuse in India, National Survey. New
Delhi: UNDCP-ROSA; 2004.
208. Saldanha A. Trance and visibility at dawn: racial dynamics in Goa's rave scene. Soc
Cult Geogr 2005; 6:707-721
209. Raves: the foreign hand [Online]. 2007 [cited 2015 Sept 15]; Available from:
URL:http://www.telegraphindia.com/1070311/asp/7days/story_7490754.asp
210. Saldanha A. Vision and viscosity in Goa's psychedelic trance scene. ACME: An
International E-Journal for Critical Geographies 2006; 4:172-193.
211. Drug trade may increase during tourist season: Goa police [Online]. Available from:
URL:http://www.indiaenews.com/india/20091111/230963.htm
212. Saldanha A. [Online]. [cited 2015 Sept 15]; Available from: URL:
http://www.snarl.org/youth/arun-msi.pdf
213. Rave Heart. The Times of India. [Online]. 2004 [cited 2015 Sept 15]; Available from:
URL:http://timesofindia.indiatimes.com/city/bangaloretimes/RaveHeart/articleshow/
928759.cms
214. Rave party, revellers, drugs, and aftermath. The Hindu. [Online]. 2007 [cited 2015 Sept
15]; Available from:
URL:http://www.thehindu.com/2007/03/06/stories/2007030610260100.htm
215. Meow Meow and the walking dead: India's newest drug [Online]. 2015 [cited 2015
Sept 15]; Available from:
URL:http://www.ozy.com/fast-forward/meow-meow-and-the-walking-dead-indias-
newest-drug/62142
216. Drug rackets move closer home [Online]. 2015 [cited 2015 Sept 15]; Available from:
URL:http://timesofindia.indiatimes.com/city/hyderabad/Drug-rackets-move-closer
home/articleshow/47919137.cms
BEHAVIOURAL ADDICTIONS
GAMBLING DISORDER
Abhishek Ghosh
Debasish Basu
P.K. Dalal
On behalf of
Indian Psychiatric Society
Specialty Section on Substance Use Disorders
2016
Gambling Disorder
CONTENTS
Executive Summary
1. Introduction
2. Scope and methodology of the guideline
3. Assessment of gambling disorder/ pathological gambling (GD/PG)
3.1 Diagnosis of GD
3.1.1 Screening questionnaire
3.1.2 Structured interviews
3.2 Exploration for co-morbidity
3.3 Exploration for psycho-social consequences
4. Treatment setting
5. Treatment for gambling disorder (GD)/ pathological gambling (PG)
5.1 Pharmacological management for gambling disorder (GD)
5.1.1 Opioid antagonists
5.1.2. Antidepressants
5.1.3. Mood stabilizers
5.1.4. Other group of medications
5.2 Psychosocial treatment for gambling disorder (GD)
5.2.1 Gamblers Anonymous
5.2.2. Self help measures
5.2.3. Cognitive behaviour therapy
5.2.4. Brief intervention and motivational intervention
5.2.5. Family therapy
5.2.6. Combined psycho-social approach
5.3 Combined psychotherapy and drug treatment
6. Caveats in the proposed guideline
EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
Introduction- Gambling, as a ubiquitous method of entertainment is present since
antiquity. However, gambling is mostly recreational, only in a minority it causes
significant socio-occupational dysfunction, and in a further smaller fraction of
individuals it becomes an uncontrollable pre-occupation that persists despite significant
negative consequences, resulting in a disorder. Gambling disorder (GD) was
introduced in the Psychiatric nosology in 1980's in the 3rd Edition of DSM [and also in
ICD-9] as pathological gambling. In DSM-5, it is included in the section of substance use
and related addictive disorders as Gambling Disorder. It is reasonably common in
clinical setting. Gambling disorder leads to devastating psychosocial consequences and
is associated with poor quality of life. Cumulative evidence for the treatment of
gambling disorder, which ranges from psychosocial to pharmacological, has
demonstrated significant efficacy in reducing the severity and consequences of
gambling.
Assessment for GD- Assessment and diagnosis of GD is entirely clinical and hence
based upon a detailed history and mental status examination. History from the
individual must be corroborated from the family members where ever possible. A
comprehensive assessment of GD must consist of the following:
Screening and establishing confirmed diagnosis
l
Exploration for co-morbidity
l
Exploration for psychosocial consequences
l
Screening and diagnostic instruments are reviewed in the guideline. The frequency and
pattern of co-morbidity have been discussed. The adverse psycho-social consequences,
the exploration of which are deemed necessary an additional have been mentioned.
Treatment setting- Although no systematic assessment has been conducted so far, the
usual locus for the treatment of GD is the out-patient clinics. Inpatient treatment is most
likely to take place if the individual is hospitalized for another psychiatric disorder,
including substance use disorders.
Pharmacological treatment for GD - Various treatment options have been investigated
for pharmacotherapy of gambling disorder, namely the opioid antagonist,
antidepressants, mood stabilizers, and glutamatergic agents. Naltrexone could be
considered as the first line pharmacological treatment for gambling disorder (GD).
Dosage required could be more than the usual dose used for the treatment of alcohol
dependence. [A] N-acetyl-cysteine (NAC) could be another promising first line agent
following naltrexone [A]. Second line agents: fluvoxamine (~200 mg/day) [B],
paroxetine (~50 mg/day) [B], memantine (~20mg/day), tocapone, and acamprosate
[C]. Although treatment of GD in presence of co-morbidity has not been investigated
systematically, evidence suggests that escitalopram and lithium could be used for
concurrent anxiety disorder and bipolar disorder respectively.
Psychosocial treatment for GD - Research in the area of psychological treatment for GD
is probably better developed as opposed to the pharmacological treatment. Several
treatment options for gamblers have been explored, ranging from self-help and peer
support, to brief and motivational interventions, to more intensive therapy approaches.
In depth motivational intervention (MI) or short term (~4 sessions) motivation
enhancement therapy could be first line treatment options as a sole form of treatment [A]
or brief motivational intervention could be used in conjunction with other forms of
intensive interventions (especially CBT) to improve treatment retention [A].More
intensive intervention especially CBT could be considered for long term engagement
[A].CBT could be delivered in both individual and group format [A]. Components of
CBT includes: cognitive restructuring, relapse prevention [A], skill training, behavioural
interventions (like cue conditioning/extinction) [B]. Bibliotherapy (proving workbooks)
could be used along with either MI or CBT [A]. Second line therapy options could be:
twelve step facilitation (TSF) [A], Exposure based therapy [B], and family therapy [C]. The
overall empirical evidence for the efficacy of psychological intervention in terms of both
quantity and quality of studies is better than pharmacological treatment. Hence, it must
be offered to all patients seeking treatment for GD.
The document ends with important caveats that should be borne in mind while
interpreting and following the guideline. .
1. INTRODUCTION
Gambling, as a ubiquitous method of entertainment is present since antiquity. In
gambling, the individual places something of value at stake in the hope of getting
something of greater value. Perhaps, it originated in Korea, and spread across the
Europe, USA, and Asia. In the ancient and medieval India, it was present as dice games;
in the pre-independence and colonial era horse racing was a highly cherished activity
amongst the relatively affluent Indian communities.1 In the 90's lotteries was the
legalized form of 'gambling'. Presently perhaps cricket betting has become the 'state of
the art' gambling! However, most of the gambling are recreational, only minority causes
significant socio-occupational dysfunction and in further smaller fraction of individual it
becomes a pre-occupation and uncontrollable and persists despite significant negative
consequences, resulting into disorder.2 Gambling disorder (GD) was introduced in the
Psychiatric nosology in 1980's in the 3rd Edition of DSM [and also in ICD-9] as
pathological gambling (PG) along with other impulse control disorders like
kleptomania, pyromania, and trichotillomania.3-5 However, the diagnostic criteria laid
down for pathological gambling were based on criteria for substance dependence.
Because there is no substance involved in gambling, it could not be incorporated under
the section of substance use disorders, despite its clinical-phenomenological,
biological, and even treatment related similarities with the latter.6 This limitation has
been subverted in DSM-5 which has brought about a significant change in the section of
substance use disorders by incorporating addictive disorders (includes behavioural
addictions).7 Henceforth, pathological gambling which was 'out of place' for more than
three decades after its inception could be included in this section as gambling disorder.
The elimination of the pre-fix pathological is to reduce stigma associated with the word
and perhaps to establish a phonemic similarity with other substance use disorders (for
e.g. alcohol related disorders).6 This recent change in the nosology is likely to improve
recognition of the disorder, especially among substance users who are at high-risk for
GD.8 However, in ICD-10 it is still specified as Pathological Gambling (PG). Hence,
both these terms have been used interchangeably in the current document.
Prevalence of PG varies widely depending upon the locus and modus of the study. The
first three national level survey conducted in the US were telephone based and the
prevalence ranged from 0.8-2% .9-11 The first in-person national level study done as a part
of National Epidemiological Survey of Alcohol and Related Conditions (NESARC)
revealed a prevalence figure of 0.4% in general population.12 A large body or research
also exists across the continents 13and across a diverse population (college students,
adults, children, and specific ethno-cultural group. The figures of PG hover around 0-
4% and 1.7-8.5% amongst adults and child/adolescent respectively.13 Prevalence of PG
is significantly more in substance using population. A meta-analysis of 18 studies
amongst the treatment seeking substance users, the lifetime rate of PG was 14%.14 Other
large scale individual studies focusing on the substance users observed a prevalence
figure ranging from 10-13%.15 One Indian study which assessed problem gambling(not
PG/GD) in treatment seeking substance using population observed a prevalence of
7.4% in the past year.1
Gambling disorder leads to serious psycho-social consequences. It is associated with
poor quality of life, high rates of bankruptcy, divorce, and incarceration. Gambling
losses might lead to psychiatric hospitalizations because of secondary depression and
suicidality.16 The overwhelming financial consequences and guilt associated with GD
places the individual at higher risk of suicidal attempts. A study among Gamblers
Anonymous (GA) participants has revealed suicidal attempt as high as 25% .17 Despite
all these negative consequences the rate of treatment seeking is a very low in GD. The
likely cause ranges from external barriers for seeking help to personal factors.18 People
who seek treatment mostly do so for their substance use or psychiatric problems and
seldom for gambling per se.
Although a couple of decades ago treatment literature regarding GD revolved around
case reports, case series and controlled trials with serious methodological limitations,19
over the last decade there has been several methodologically validated research in this
area. Cumulative evidence for the treatment of gambling disorder, which ranges from
psycho-social to pharmacological, has demonstrated significant efficacy in reducing the
severity and consequences of gambling. To the best of our knowledge, till now there is
no published clinical practice guideline (CPG) dedicated in this important area. The
objective of the current guideline is to study the available evidence, determine its
strength and finally to recommend practical treatment options especially suited to the
Indian context.
2. SCOPE AND METHODOLOGY OF THE GUIDELINE
We searched PubMed (http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/pubmed) to identify published
meta-analysis, reviews, open-label trials, randomized double-blind trials, placebo-
controlled trials, and case reports written in English, focusing on the pharmacotherapy
of pathological gambling. In addition, we have searched Scopus, Google Scholar, and
PsychInfo to identify any other study missed. The following keywords were used:
gambling disorder, pathological gambling, problem gambling, pharmacotherapy,
psychological therapy and treatment. The search was conducted on 4th June, 2015.
Only selection of clinical trial had yielded 203 results; inclusion of reviews had
increased the number of results to 509.
We have used the term gambling disorder (GD) and pathological gambling (PG)
interchangeably throughout the document.
Panel 1
ICD-10 criteria for PG
l Individuals have frequent and repeated episodes of gambling despite adverse
consequences
l Individuals put their jobs at risk, acquire large debts, and lie or break the law
l Individuals have intense urges to gamble, which are difficult to control
l Individuals have preoccupation with ideas and images of the act of gambling
l Should be distinguished from gambling and betting (frequent gambling for
excitement or in an attempt to make money), excessive gambling by manic
patients, and gambling by sociopathic personalities
Panel-2
DSM-IV TR criteria for PG
Persistent and recurrent maladaptive gambling behaviour is indicated if the
individual has five (or more) of the following:
l Is preoccupied with gambling
l Needs to gamble with increasing amounts of money
l Has repeated unsuccessful efforts to control, cut back, or stop gambling
l Is restless or irritable when attempting to cut down or stop gambling
l Gambles as a way of escaping from problems or of relieving a dysphoric mood
l After losing money gambling, often returns another day to get even (i.e.,
“chasing one's losses”)
Panel-3
DSM-5 criteria for GD
Persistent and recurrent problematic gambling behaviour leading to clinically
significant impairment or distress, as indicated by the individual exhibiting four (or
more) of the following in a 12-month period:
l Needs to gamble with increasing amounts of money in order to achieve the
desired excitement.
l Is restless or irritable when attempting to cut down or stop gambling.
l Has made repeated unsuccessful efforts to control, cut back, or stop gambling.
l Is often preoccupied with gambling (e.g., having persistent thoughts of reliving
past gambling experiences, handicapping or planning the next venture, thinking
of ways to get money with which to gamble).
l Often gambles when feeling distressed (e.g., helpless, guilty, anxious,
depressed).
l After losing money gambling, often returns another day to get even (“chasing”
one's losses).
l Lies to conceal the extent of involvement with gambling.
l Has jeopardized or lost a significant relationship, job, or educational or career
opportunity because of gambling.
l Relies on others to provide money to relieve desperate financial situations
caused by gambling
The gambling behaviour is not better accounted for by a manic episode
Current severity:
Mild: 4–5 criteria met.
Moderate: 6–7 criteria met.
Severe: 8–9 criteria met.
NOTE: “Has committed illegal acts to finance gambling” has been removed from
the diagnostic criteria
and Chasing (PERC).27 Given high rates of comorbidity, routine and accurate
identification of gambling-related problems among individuals seeking help for
substance abuse and related disorders is important. BBGS was derived from the
NESARC study and was based on DSM-IV PG.28 It also has similar high sensitivity and
specificity like the NODS-CLiP. However, the validity of these 2 instruments has not
been established yet from different sample and for clinical population. A recent study
has compared the brief screening instruments with the DSM-5 criteria for GD. Both
NODS-CLiP and NODS-PERC had been found to have excellent accuracy at all cut-off
points. However, BBGS had the best accuracy.29 The shortest possible screening tool for
PG is the Lie/Bet scale. Its Items determine if individual lies to others about gambling
behaviours or bets more and more money. There are 2 items with “yes/no” response
options in a lifetime time frame. Answering “yes” to one or both items indicates PG.30
3.1.2 Structured interviews
For a more comprehensive assessment, the Gambling Treatment Outcome Monitoring
System (GAMTOMS) is a multidimensional self-report or interview assessment
instrument. GAMTOMS incorporates SOGS and also assesses various domains
pertaining to treatment planning and outcome monitoring, including gambling
frequency, mental health, financial problems, legal problems, and motivation.
Additionally, this system has a ten-item DSM-IV measure that is relevant for diagnostic
purposes. GAMTOMS has been used for several psychometric evaluations in clinical
samples, whereby DSM-IV categorical diagnosis of pathological gambling had good
sensitivity (0·96) and specificity (0·95) for distinguishing clinician-diagnosed cases from
non-cases, as well asgood sensitivity (0·96) and specificity (1·0) distinguishing SOGS-
positive cases from SOGS-negative cases. GAMTOMS also includes a follow-up version
that measures treatment outcome via self-report.31Another comprehensive instrument
for the diagnosis of GD is Diagnostic Interview for Gambling Schedule (DIGS). This
instrument measures demographics, gambling involvement, treatment history, onset of
gambling, gambling frequency, amounts of money bet and lost, sources of borrowed
money, financial problems, legal problems, mental health screen, other impulse
disorders, medical status, family and social functioning and diagnostic symptoms
(lifetime and past year). It has total 20 items and is based on DSM-IV TR diagnostic
criteria. If respondent endorses either of the two items per criterion, the criterion is
considered endorsed.32 The details of all instruments have been summarized in Table 1.
However, an interview by a qualified psychiatrist is always the gold standard for the
diagnosis of GD. Other diagnostic/screening instruments mentioned so far can
supplement an interview but can and should never replace it. These instruments are
proven to be highly useful for research purpose, to have an idea about the baseline
severity of gambling and to monitor the progress with treatment.
implications for individual case formulation, treatment planning and selection, the
proposed objectives and expectations of the selected treatment, and the even length of
treatment. Psychiatric co-morbidity may also affect an individual's compliance with
treatment, the success of treatment, the likelihood of relapse and the number of
treatment attempts.37-38
Therefore following presence of disorders must be explored by clinical interview and (if
needed diagnostic instruments):
l Substance use disorders
l Mood disorders
l Anxiety disorders
The process of diagnosing these disorders is outside the purview of the chapter.
3.3 Exploration for Psychosocial Consequences
GD incurs a lot of negative effect on the individual and on the family-society. It has been
estimated that for one person suffering from GD, at least 10 people get affected by its
negative consequences.39 Exploration of negative consequences is mostly historical and
following dimensions must be incorporated:
l Legal
l Marital relationship
l Interpersonal relationship with significant others in the family
l Financial
l Occupational
l Overall quality of life
Gambling Treatment Outcome Monitoring System (GAMTOMS), as mentioned earlier
is a comprehensive instrument which can assess the adverse psycho-social effects of
gambling. This instrument can supplement the clinical history. Such an assessment
could be extremely helpful in planning treatment and to monitor the progress of it.
4. TREATMENT SETTINGS
Gambling disorder might be encountered both in the psychiatric or addiction treatment
clinic. The orientation and philosophy of these clinics are different. However, as GD is
currently a part of addictive disorder and most of the research conducted so far was
based on substance use disorder treatment clinics and done by a group of researchers
with substance use disorder orientation and allegiance, this clinical practice guideline
would be predominantly guided by addiction treatment principles. Although no
systematic assessment has been conducted so far, the usual locus for the treatment of
GD is the out-patient clinics. Inpatient treatment is most likely to take place if the
individual is hospitalized for another psychiatric disorder, including substance use
disorders. Research had revealed that individual with either psychiatric or substance
use co-morbidity tends to have higher severity and poorer outcome for both gambling
and the other disorder.40-42
Following could be indications for inpatient treatment:
l Patients with depressive disorder and suicidality
l Patients with severe substance use disorders
l Poor social support
l Court mandated admissions
5. TREATMENT FOR GAMBLING DISORDER (GD) / PATHOLOGICAL GAMBLING
(PG)
Surveys in the general population indicate that only about 10% of those who are
suffering from GD seek formal treatment. Reasons for their non-treatment seeking are a
desire to handle their problem on their own, shame, and denial.43-44 Despite low
treatment seeking both direct and indirect evidence indicate that the recovery rate of
GD is around 30-40%. And most of the individual recovers without treatment from
professional sources. Hence GD is not always a chronic, persistent and severe
disorder.45 Moreover, it has been seen that individual with more legal complications,
preoccupation with gambling and with co-morbid mood disorders seeks treatment.46 In
depth interviews of those who were recovered had revealed use of behavioural
strategies like, engaging in activities incompatible with gambling and avoidance of
conditioned cues, which are quite similar with those who had undergone professional
treatment.47 These facts don't question the necessity for the treatment of GD rather point
towards some important considerations regarding those who seek treatment (the subset
of patients for whom this CPG is applicable):
l More severe form of GD (severity might be in terms of more psycho-social
consequences or presence of severe co-morbidity)
l Brief treatment model might aid in the self-recovery process of the individual
l It is important to dispel stigma and resultant myth regarding gambling
l There is always a hope for recovery
Goal of treatment for GD: Gambling as has been conceptualized as addictive disorder
the standard goal and standard outcome measure remain complete abstinence.
However, research does not support the contention that abstinence-based goals are
more advantageous than moderation goals.48 In fact, research has demonstrated the
viability of non-abstinent treatment goal and popularity of the same amongst those in
natural or treatment assisted recovery. A study conducted amongst the female with PG
in Australia has shown that those with older age and with a strong belief that complete
abstinence is not required for recovery opt for moderation as treatment goal.49
Recommendation
l Naltrexone can be considered as the first line pharmacological treatment for
gambling disorder (GD). Dosage required could be more than the usual dose used
for the treatment of alcohol dependence. [A]
l N-acetyl-cysteine (NAC) could be another promising first line agent following
naltrexone [A]. Dosage to be administered ranged from 1200-3000 mg/day. [B]
l Second line agents: fluvoxamine (~200 mg/day) [B], paroxetine (~50 mg/day) [B],
memantine (~20mg/day), tolcapone, and acamprosate [C].
l Escitalopram could be an option for those with co-morbid anxiety disorder [B].
l For individual with high impulsiveness modafinil could be an alternative treatment
option [B].
l Response to treatment could be seen between 1-8 weeks, depending upon the type
of medication (opioid antagonist ~1 week; NAC ~8 weeks). Any medications must
be continued for this duration before changing it. Duration of treatment though not
well defined, medications could be safely used for 6 months.
Nalmefene, though found out to be effective in randomized double blind trials [A], is
not available in India.
Key uncertainties
l Duration of treatment is not defined.
l Treatment effect or strategies for those with co-morbid substance use disorders needs
to be evaluated.
l Though there few narrative reviews, no meta-analysis has been conducted till date.
5.2 Psychosocial Treatment for Gambling Disorder (GD)
Research in the area of psychological treatment for GD is perhaps better developed as
opposed to the pharmacological treatment. Several treatment options for gamblers have
been explored, ranging from self-help and peer support, to brief and motivational
interventions, to more intensive therapy approaches. Involvement in peer support
programs seems to be optimal when combined with professional treatment; however,
engagement and retention in peer support is limited. In majority of the studies, primary
outcomes were measures of gambling symptom severity, financial loss from gambling
and frequency of gambling. Secondary outcomes were occurrence of pathological
gambling diagnoses and depression and anxiety symptoms. Retention in the treatment,
one of the significant determinants of the outcome for any psychological treatment, is
another parameter which has been frequently studied. Overall retention rates range
from 50% to 90%. Treatment effects were defined by comparisons between therapy and
control conditions at post-treatment assessments (conducted from 0 to 3 months
following completion of treatment) and follow-up assessments (conducted from 9 to 12
months following completion of treatment). Details of all psycho-social interventions
have been reviewed in Table 3.
5.2.1 Gamblers Anonymous (GA)75
GA which is modeled on Alcoholics Anonymous 12-step programs strongly advocates
complete abstinence from gambling. Like its sister programs, GA has adopted the
disease model and views disordered gambling as a lifelong affliction that can be
controlled via gambling abstinence, but not cured. Gamblers Anonymous were started
in 1957 in Los Angeles, CA, USA, and are now operating in at least 55 countries
worldwide (http://www.gamblersanonymous.org/mtgdirTOP.html.). The groups
promote a sense of common purpose and understanding and reinforce each
consecutive day of abstinence from gambling. As with Alcoholics Anonymous, periods
of success are marked with celebrations and rewards.75 Twelve-step-facilitation (TSF) is a
professionally led structured form of psychological intervention derived from the
treatment philosophy of 12 step programs and aims increasing referral to, involvement
in, and understanding of 12 step programs. TSF has been tried for gambling also. The
effectiveness studies are mentioned in the Table 3.
Panel-4
Distorted cognitions in GD
Magnification of gambling skill
l Overrating one's ability to win at gambling
Superstitious beliefs
l Talismanic superstitions include beliefs that the possession of certain objects
increases the probability of winning (eg, ring, hat)
l Behavioural superstitions include beliefs that certain actions or rituals can
increase the probability of winning (eg, playing only certain slot machines or
placing smaller bets if they do not throw the dice themselves)
l Cognitive superstitions include beliefs that certain mental states can affect the
probability of winning (eg, prayer, hope, positive expectancies)
Interpretative biases
l Attributional biases refer to the tendency to overestimate dispositional factors
(e.g., skills, abilities) to explain wins and to underestimate situational factors
(e.g., luck, probability)
l Gambler's fallacy refers to the belief that a win is due after a series of losses
l Chasing refers to the belief that the only way to recover financial loss is to
continue to gamble
l Anthropomorphism is the tendency to attribute human characteristics to non-
animate or non-human gambling objects (e.g., slot machine, lottery card, bingo
card, horses)
l Learning from losses refers to the belief that continuing to gamble is highly
justifiable because losses are perceived as valuable learning experiences, which
can ultimately lead to winning
l Hindsight bias refers to retrospectively evaluating gambling decisions as correct
or incorrect on the basis of whether they lead to wins or losses
Temporal telescoping
l The belief that wins are actually nearer, temporally, than further, especially if the
gambling is relying on superstitious behaviour or gambling systems to win; the
gambler makes the additional assumption that they (rather than other gamblers)
will win, even if other gamblers have also incurred serious losses and are
expecting to win
Selective memory
l Selectively recalling wins, especially large ones, and having difficulty recalling
losses
Predictive skill
l Making gambling decisions on the basis of interpretations or meanings assigned
to subjectively salient or important cues; cues can be internal (e.g., bodily
perceptions, gut sensations, intuitions, feelings) or external (eg, omens, weather
phenomena, serendipitous events) or behaviour by other gamblers
Illusions of control over luck
l Luck can be perceived as an important variable and regarded as an
uncontrollable variable (ie, luck oscillates between periods of good and bad luck
and cannot be manipulated directly), a controllable variable (ie, luck can be
manipulated through superstitious behaviours or systems), a trait variable (ie,
people are characteristically lucky with certain games and unlucky with others),
or a contagion (ie, luck is affected by other areas of their life or by other people)
Illusory associations
l Perceiving illusory associations or assigning causality to salient features of the
environment believed to be associated with gambling outcomes (eg, noticing
more frequent winning at night, noticing that certain days of the week are more
likely to lead to wins, believing that watching a sports game on television will
favor a specific team)
Toneatto T, Ladoceur R. Treatment of pathological gambling: a critical review of
the literature. Psychol Addict Behav. 2003; 17:284-92.19
Smith et al., 87 (CT= 44, 1, 3, and 6 differential efficacy of Outcome: rated by participants
201586 ET=43); month follow-up CT and Exposure using the Victorian Gambling
completers: therapy (ET) for adult Screen (VGS)
CT=30, problem gamblers Both groups experienced
ET=21) Randomized comparable reductions
controlled trial (improvement) in VGS scores
both at the end and after 12
months
Hodgins et 102 Single session of CBT workbook vs. Outcome: Clinical global
al. (2001)88 enrolled 85 motivational workbook + impression modified for PG
available at enhancement motivational No statistical difference
12 months enhancement between motivational
intervention via enhancement and workbook
telephone vs. wait list Both better than WL
(WL)
Carlbring & 66 enrolled Six-, 18- and 36- Web-based CBT with Outcome: criteria met in South
Smit, 60 with month follow up telephone support Oaks Gambling Screening
(2008)91 post- and online workbook questionnaire (SOGS)
treatment materials vs. waitlist Intervention group: moderate to
data control large improvements maintained
at 36-month follow-up
Diskin & 81 enrolled One-, three-, six- Single in-person Outcome: Gambling severity
Hodgins, 69 and 12- month motivational MI significantly better than
(2009)93 completed follow-up interviewing vs. control interview
12-month control interview Improvement persisted after 12
follow-up months
(>40%
female)
Recommendations
l In depth motivational intervention (MI) or short term (~4 sessions) motivation
enhancement therapy could be first line treatment options as a sole form of treatment
[A] or brief motivational intervention could be used in conjunction with other forms
of intensive interventions (especially CBT) to improve treatment retention [A].
l More intensive intervention especially CBT could be considered for long term
engagement [A]. Number of sessions could range from 10-30 (mean 20) [A]. CBT
could be delivered in both individual and group format [A]. Components of CBT
includes: cognitive restructuring, relapse prevention [A], skill training, and
behavioural interventions (like cue conditioning/extinction) [B].
l Bibliotherapy (proving workbooks) could be used along with either MI or CBT [B].
l Second line therapy options could be: twelve step facilitation (TSF) [A], Exposure
based therapy [B], and family therapy [C].Family therapy (CRAFT) could be useful
when the individual is not ready to seek treatment.
l Brief telephonic MI could be an option for those not willing to commit for long term
engagement or not willing to come to treatment facilities [B].
l Combination of N-acetyl-cysteine with exposure based therapy might have some
additive effect [B].
l GA referral unlikely to be effective alone, if not coupled with other professionally led
interventions [A].
interventions. Next, this guideline is based on the literature from the West. The
generalizability of such recommendations for our Indian population might be debated.
However, in absence of any treatment related research from India, we did not have any
better alternative than to extrapolate our recommendations from the Western literature.
Lastly, The Pathways Model explicated by Blaszczynski & Nower102 (although not as yet
fully validated) hypothesizes three routes into disordered gambling. Individuals in the
first group have no predisposing vulnerabilities; rather their gambling problems have
been conditioned by the psychological properties of the games themselves, and
perhaps by the experience of a 'big win' early in their gambling careers. The second
subgroup is prone to depression or anxiety, and these individuals begin gambling as a
means of escape or to otherwise alleviate these emotional difficulties. The third group
present with antisocial and impulsive tendencies, accompanied by neuropsychological
evidence of frontal cortex involvement. This model indicates that there could be an
opportunity for patient treatment matching. This area needs to be explored in the future.
References
1. Benegal V. Gambling experiences, problems and policy in India: a historical analysis.
Addiction. 2013; 108(12):2062-7.
2. Hodgins DC, Stea JN, Grant JE. Gambling disorders. Lancet. 2011;378(9806):1874-84.
3. American Psychiatric Association. Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Mental
Disorders. Washington, DC: Amercican Psychiatric Assocation, 1980.
4. American Psychiatric Association. Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Mental
Disorders text revision. Washington, DC: American Psychiatric Association, 2000.
5. WHO. International Classification of Diseases (ICD-10): clinical descriptions and
diagnostic guidelines. Geneva: World Health Organization, 1992.
6. Grant JE, Chamberlain SR. Gambling disorder and its relationship with substance use
disorders: Implications for nosological revisions and treatment. Am J Addict. 2013
doi: 10.1111/j.1521-0391.2013.12112.x.[E-pub ahead of print]
7. APA. Diagnostic and Statistical Manual. 5th edition. Arlington, VA, USA: American
Psychiatric Association; 2013.
8. Toneatto T, Brennan J. Pathological gambling in treatment-seeking substance abusers.
Addict Behav. 2002; 27:465-9.
9. Kallick M, Suits D, Dielman T, Hybels J. A Survey of AmericanGambling Attitudes and
Behaviour. Research Report Series, SurveyResearch Center, Institute for Social
Research. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press; 1979.
10. Gerstein DR, Volberg RA, Toce MT. Gambling Impact and Behaviour Study: Report to
National Gambling Impact Study Commission. Chicago, Ill.: National Opinion
Research Center; 1999.
11. Welte J, Barnes G, Wieczorek W, Tidwell MC, Parker J. Alcohol and gambling
pathology among U.S. adults. Prevalence, demographic patterns and comorbidity. J
Stud Alcohol. 2001; 62:706–12.
12. Petry NM, Stinson FS, Grant BF. Comorbidity of DSM-IV pathological gambling and
psychiatric disorders: Results from the National Epidemiologic Survey on Alcohol and
Related Conditions. J Clin Psychiatry. 2005; 66:564–74.
13. McGowan VM. How do we know what we know? Epistemic tensions in social and
cultural research on gambling 1980-2000. J Gambling Issues. 2004; 11:32-6.
14. Shaffer HJ, Hall MN, Vander Bilt J. Estimating the prevalence of disordered gambling
behaviour in the United States and Canada: a research synthesis. Am J Public Health.
1999; 89:1369-76.
15. Petry NM. Gambling and substance use disorders: current status and future directions.
Am J Addict. 2007;16:1-9.
16. Petry NM, Kiluk BD. Suicidal ideation and suicide attempts in treatment- seeking
pathological gamblers. J Nerv Ment Dis. 2002; 190:462– 9.
17. Potenza MN, Steinberg MA, McLaughlin SD, Rounsaville BJ, O' Malley SS. Illegal
behaviours in problem gambling: Analysis of data from a gambling helpline. J Am
Acad Psychiatry Law. 2000; 28:389–403.
18. Hodgins DC, el-Guebaly N. Natural and treatment-assisted recovery from gambling
problems: a comparison of resolved and active gamblers. Addiction. 2000 ;95:777-89.
19. Toneatto T, Ladoceur R. Treatment of pathological gambling: a critical review of the
literature. Psychol Addict Behav. 2003; 17:284-92.
20. Stinchfield R, Govoni R, Frisch GR. A review of screening and assessment instruments
for problem and pathological gambling.In: Smith G, Hodgins DC, Williams RJ, eds.
Research and Measurement Issues in Gambling Studies. Boston: Academic
Press/Elsevier, 2007: 180-213.\
21. Lesieur HR, Blume SB. Revising the South Oaks Gambling Screen in different settings.
J Gambl Stud 1993; 9: 213-23.
22. Stinchfield R, Winters KC, Botzet A, Jerstad S, Breyer J. Development and
psychometric evaluation of the gambling treatment outcome monitoring system
(GAMTOMS). Psychol Addict Behav. 2007;21:174-84.
23. Ferris J, Wynne H. The Canadian Problem Gambling Index: final report. Ottawa, ON:
phase II final report to the Canadian Inter-Provincial Task Force on Problem Gambling,
2001.
24. Shaffer HJ, Labrie R, Scanlan KM, Cummings TN. Pathological gambling among
adolescents: Massachusetts Gambling Screen (MAGS). J Gambl Stud. 1994;10:339-62.
25. Gerstein D, Murphy S, Toce M. Gambling impact and behaviour study: report to the
National Gambling Impact Study Commission, 1999.
40. Langenbucher J, Bavly L, Labouvie E, Sanjuan PM, Martin CS. Clinical features of
pathological gambling in an addictions treatment cohort. Psychol Addict Behav. 2001;
15: 77–9.
41. Steinberg MA, Kosten, TA, Rounsaville BJ. Cocaine abuse and pathological gamblers.
Am J Addict. 1992; 1:121–32.
42. Hall GW, Carriero NJ, Takushi RY, Montoya ID, Preston KL, Gorelick DA.
Pathological gambling among cocaine-dependent outpatients. Am J Psychiatry. 2000;
157: 1127–33.
43. Cunningham JA. Little use of treatment among problem gamblers. Psychiatr Serv.
2005; 56: 1024-25.
44. Suurvali H, Hodgins DC, Cunningham JA. Motivators for resolving or seeking help for
gambling problems: a review of the empirical literature. J Gambl Stud 2010; 26: 1-33.
45. Slutske WS. Natural recovery and treatment-seeking in pathological gambling: results
of two U.S. national surveys. Am J Psychiatry 2006; 163: 297-302.
46. Knezevic B, Ledgerwood DM. Gambling severity, impulsivity, and psychopathology:
comparison of treatment- and community-recruited pathological gamblers. Am J
Addict. 2012; 21(6):508-15.
47. Hodgins DC, el-Guebaly N. Natural and treatment-assisted recovery from gambling
problems: a comparison of resolved and active gamblers. Addiction 2000; 95: 777-
789.
48. Stea JN, Hodgins DC, Fung T. Abstinence versus Moderation Goals in Brief
Motivational Treatment for Pathological Gambling. J Gambl Stud. 2014 Apr
20.PubMed PMID: 24748014. [Epub ahead of print]
49. Dowling N, Smith D. Treatment goal selection for female pathological gambling: a
comparison of abstinence and controlled gambling. J Gambl Stud. 2007;23(3):335-45.
50. Lupi M, Martinotti G, Acciavatti T, Pettorruso M, Brunetti M, Santacroce R, et al.
Pharmacological treatments in gambling disorder: a qualitative review. Biomed Res
Int. 2014; 2014: 537306.
51. Kim SW, Grant JE. An open naltrexone treatment study in pathological gambling
disorder. Int Clin Psychopharmacol. 2001; 16:285–9.
52. Grant JE, Suck WK, Hartman BK. A double-blind, placebo-controlled study of the
opiate antagonist naltrexone in the treatment of pathological gambling urges. J Clin
Psychiatry. 2008; 69(5):783–9.
53. Toneatto T, Brands B, Selby P. A randomized, double-blind, placebo-controlled trial
of naltrexone in the treatment of concurrent alcohol use disorder and pathological
gambling. Am J Addict. 2009; 18(3):219–25.
26. Hodgins DC. Using the NORC DSM Screen for Gambling Problems (NODS) as an
outcome measure for pathological gambling: psychometric evaluation. Addict Behav.
2004; 29: 1685-90.
27. Volberg RA, Munck IM, Petry NM. A quick and simple screening method for
pathological and problem gamblers in addiction programs and practices. Am J Addict.
2011; 20: 220-7.
28. Gebauer L, LaBrie R, Shaffer HJ. Optimizing DSM-IV-TR classification accuracy: a
brief biosocial screen for detecting current gambling disorders among gamblers in the
general household population. Can J Psychiatry. 2010; 55:82-90.
29. Himelhoch SS, Miles-McLean H, Medoff DR, Kreyenbuhl J, Rugle L, Bailey-Kloch M,
et al. Evaluation of brief screens for gambling disorder in the substance use treatment
setting. Am J Addict. 2015 May 12. doi: 10.1111/ajad.12241.[e-pub ahead of print]
30. Johnson EE, Hamer R, Nora RM, Tan B, Eisenstein N, Engelhart C. The Lie/Bet
Questionnaire for screening pathological gamblers. Psychol Rep. 1997;80(1):83-8.
31. Stinchfield R. Reliability, validity, and classification accuracy of the South Oaks
Gambling Screen (SOGS). Addict Behav. 2002; 27: 1-19.
32. Winters KC, Stinchfield RD, Botzet A, Slutske WS. Pathways of youth gambling
problem severity. Psychol Addict Behav. 2005;19(1):104-107.
33. Dowling NA, Cowlishaw S, Jackson AC, Merkouris SS, Francis KL, Christensen DR.
Prevalence of psychiatric co-morbidity in treatment-seeking problem gamblers: A
systematic review and meta-analysis. Aust N Z J Psychiatry. 2015;49(6):519-539.
34. Grall-Bronnec M, Wainstein L, Augy J, Bouju G, Feuillet F, Vénisse JL, et al. Attention
deficit hyperactivity disorder among pathological and at-risk gamblers seeking
treatment: a hidden disorder. Eur Addict Res. 2011; 17:231-40.
35. Ibáñez A, Blanco C, Donahue E, Lesieur HR, Pérez de Castro I, Fernández-Piqueras J,
et al. Psychiatric comorbidity in pathological gamblers seeking treatment. Am J
Psychiatry. 2001; 158:1733-5.
36. Ledgerwood DM, Petry NM. Psychological experience of gambling and subtypes of
pathological gamblers. Psychiatry Res. 2006 ;144:17-27.
37. Kruedelbach N, Walker HI, Chapman HA, Haro G, Mateu C, Leal C. Comorbidity on
disorders with loss of impulse-control: pathological gambling, addictions and
personality disorders. Actas Esp Psiquiatr. 2006; 34:76-82.
38. Westphal JR, Johnson LJ, Stodghill S, Stevens L. Gambling in the south: implications
for physicians. South Med J. 2000; 93:850-8.
39. Ladouceur R. Jeu pathologique [Pathological gambling]. In R. Ladouceur, O. Fontaine,
& J. Cottraux (Eds.), Thérapie cognitive et comportementale (pp. 123-128). Paris:
Masson, 1993.
54. Grant JE, Potenza MN, Hollander E, Nurminen T, Smits G, Kallio A. Multicenter
investigation of the opioid antagonist nalmefene in the treatment of pathological
gambling. Am J Psychiatry.2006;163:303–12.
55. Grant JE, Odlaug BL, Potenza MN, Hollander E, Kim SW. Nalmefene in the treatment
of pathological gambling: multicentre, double-blind, placebo-controlled study. BrJ
Psychiatry. 2010; 197:330–1.
56. Hollander E, DeCaria CM, Finkell JN, Begaz T, Wong CM, Cartwright C. A
randomized double-blind fluvoxamine/placebo crossover trial in pathologic
gambling. Biol Psychiatry. 2000;47:813-7.
57. Blanco C, Petkova E, Ibáñez A, Sáiz-Ruiz J. A pilot placebo-controlled study of
fluvoxamine for pathological gambling. Ann Clin Psychiatry. 2002;14:9–15.
58. Kim SW, Grant JE, Adson DE, Chul Shin Y, Zaninelli R. A double-blind placebo-
controlled study of the efficacy and safety of paroxetine in the treatment of
pathological gambling. . J Clin Psychiatry. 2002;63:501–7.
59. Grant JE, Kim SW, Potenza MN, Blanco C, Ibáñez A, Stevens L, et al. Paroxetine
treatment of pathological gambling: a multi-centre randomized controlled trial. Int
Clin Psychopharmacol. 2003; 18:243–9.
60. Saiz-Ruiz J, Blanco C, Ibáñez A, Masramon X, Gomez MM, Madrigal M et al. Sertraline
treatment of pathological gambling: a pilot study. J Clin Psychiatry. 2005;66:28–33.
61. Grant JE, Potenza MN. Escitalopram treatment of pathological gambling with co-
occurring anxiety: an open-label pilot study with double-blind discontinuation. Int
Clin Psychopharmacol. 2006; 21:203–9.
62. Black DW, Shaw M, Forbush KT, Allen J. An open-label trial of escitalopram in the
treatment of pathological gambling. Clin Neuropharmacol. 2007; 30:206–12.
63. Hollander E, Pallanti S, Allen A, Sood E, Rossi NB. Does sustained-release lithium
reduce impulsive gambling and affective instability versus placebo in pathological
gamblers with bipolar spectrum disorders? Am J Psychiatry.2005;162:137–45.
64. Berlin HA, Braun A, Simeon D, Koran LM, Potenza MN, McElroy SL, et al. A double-
blind, placebo-controlled trial of topiramate for pathological gambling. World J Biol
Psychiatry. 2013; 14:121–8.
65. McElroy SL, Nelson EB, Welge JA, Kaehler L, Keck PE Jr. Olanzapine in the treatment
of pathological gambling: a negative randomized placebo-controlled trial. J Clin
Psychiatry. 2008;69:433-40.
66. Fong T, Kalechstein A, Bernhard B, Rosenthal R, Rugle L. A double-blind, placebo-
controlled trial of olanzapine for the treatment of video poker pathological gamblers.
Pharmacol Biochem Behav. 2008; 89:298-03.
67. Zack M, Poulos CX. Effects of the atypical stimulant modafinil on a brief gambling
episode in pathological gamblers with high vs. low impulsivity. J Psychopharmacol.
2009; 23:660–71.
68. Grant JE, Kim SW, Odlaug BL. N-acetyl cysteine, a glutamate-modulating agent, in the
treatment of pathological gambling: a pilot study. Biol Psychiatry.2007;62:652–7.
69. Grant JE, Odlaug BL, Chamberlain SR, Potenza MN, Schreiber LR, Donahue CB, et al.
A randomized, placebo-controlled trial of N-acetylcysteine plus imaginal
desensitization for nicotine-dependent pathological gamblers. J Clin Psychiatry.
2014;75:39-45.
70. Grant JE, Chamberlain SR, Odlaug BL, Potenza MN, Kim SW. Memantine shows
promise in reducing gambling severity and cognitive inflexibility in pathological
gambling: a pilot study. Psychopharmacology. 2010; 212: 603–12.
71. Thomas A, Bonanni L, Gambi F, Di Iorio A, Onofrj M. Pathological gambling in
parkinson disease is reduced by amantadine. Ann Neurol. 2010; 68:400–04.
72. Black DW, McNeilly DP, Burke WJ, Shaw MC, Allen J. An open-label trial of
acamprosate in the treatment of pathological gambling. Ann Clin Psychiatry. 2011;
23:250–6.
73. Dannon PN, Rosenberg O, Schoenfeld N, Kotler M. Acamprosate and baclofen were
not effective in the treatment of pathological gambling: preliminary blind rater
comparison study. Front Psychiatry.2011;2: 1-4.
74. Grant JE, Odlaug BL, Chamberlain SR, Hampshire A, Schreiber LR, Kim SW. A proof of
concept study of tolcapone for pathological gambling: relationships with COMT
genotype and brain activation. Eur Neuropsychopharmacol. 2013; 23:1587-96.
75. Rash CJ, Petry NM. Psychological treatments for gambling disorder. Psychol Res
Behav Manag. 2014; 7:285-95.
76. Sylvain C, Ladoucer R, Boisvert JM. Cognitive and behavioural treatment of
pathological gambling: a controlled study. J Consult Clin Psychol. 1997; 65:727–32.
77. Ladouceur R, Sylvain C, Boutin C. Cognitive treatment of pathological gambling. J
Nerv Ment Dis. 2001; 189: 774–80.
78. Ladouceur R, Sylvain C, Boutin C, Lachance S, Douet C, Leblond J. Group therapy for
pathological gamblers: a cognitive approach. Behav Res Ther. 2003; 41:587–96.
79. Echeburúa E, Fernández-Montalvo J, Báez C. Relapse prevention in the treatment of
slot-machine pathological gambling: Long-term outcome. Behav Ther.
2000;31:351–64.
80. Milton S, Crino R, Hunt C, Prosser E. The effect of compliance-improving
interventions on the cognitive-behavioural treatment of pathological gambling. J
Gambl Stud. 2002; 2:207-29.
96. Hodgins DC, Shead NW, Makarchuk K. Relationship satisfaction and psychological
distress among concerned significant others of pathological gamblers. J Nerv Ment
Dis. 2007; 195: 65-71.
97. Grant JE, Donahue CB, Odlaug BL, Kim SW, Miller MJ, Petry NM. Imaginal
desensitisation plus motivational interviewing for pathological gambling: randomised
controlled trial. Br J Psychiatry. 2009; 195:266-7.
98. Stewart RM, Brown RI. An outcome study of Gamblers Anonymous. Br J
Psychiatry.1988; 152:284-8.
99. Toneatto T, Dragonetti R. Effectiveness of community-based treatment for problem
gambling: a quasi-experimental evaluation of cognitive-behavioural vs. twelve-step
therapy. Am J Addict. 2008; 17:298-03.
100. Marceaux JC, Melville CL. Twelve-step facilitated versus mapping-enhanced
cognitive-behavioural therapy for pathological gambling: a controlled study. J Gambl
Stud. 2011; 27:171-90.
101. Slutske WS, Blaszczynski A, Martin NG. Sex differences in the rates of recovery,
treatment-seeking, and natural recovery in pathological gambling: results from an
Australian community-based twin survey. Twin Res Hum Genet. 2009; 12: 425-432.
102. Blaszczynski A, Nower L. A pathways model of problem and pathological gambling.
Addiction. 2002; 97:487-99.
Prabhat Chand
Arun Kandasamy
Pratima Murthy
On behalf of
Indian Psychiatric Society
Specialty Section on Substance Use Disorders
2016
Pathological Internet Use (“Internet Addiction”)
CONTENTS
Executive Summary
1. Introduction
2. Assessment
2.1 Assessment of Internet use
2.2 Assessment of comorbidity
2.3 Assessment of temperament
3. Management
3.1 Psychological Intervention
3.1.1 Cognitive Behaviour Therapy
3.1.2 Others
3.1.3 Effectiveness
3.2 Pharmacological
3.2.1 Anti-depressants
3.2.2 Stimulants
4. Psychological versus Pharmacological
5. Conclusion
EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
The literature regarding Internet addiction or pathological Internet use has been
increasing very fast along with increasing presence of Internet dependent activities in
the day-to-day life. There are different terms being used by different researchers about
excessive use of Internet i.e. pathological Internet use, compulsive Internet use,
problematic Internet use, Internet addiction, Internet dependency etc. The common
theme in all these terminology is inability to control one's use of the Internet which
leads to negative consequences in daily life. Disagreement regarding diagnostic criteria
and the lack of large epidemiological studies have resulted difficulty in establishing true
prevalence as well as assessment of pathological Internet use.
Assessment of temperament and comorbidities along with the nature of Internet use is
essential in the clinical practice. Excessive Internet use can also be expression of
ongoing emotional difficulty and ongoing poor coping mechanism. There is lack of
evidence based research in the management of Internet addiction. Cognitive
behavioural therapy for Internet addiction (CBT-IA) has been commonly used in clinical
settings. The initial stage of CBT-IA is on modifying the behaviour i.e. setting up realistic
goals, daily log of Internet use, structuring use, creating a new schedule and to learn to
control Internet usage. The second stage aims at reducing maladaptive cognitions. The
last stage focusses on real problems existing in their lives that lead to addiction. Various
other types of psychological interventions like Reality Therapy, Short term treatment of
Internet and computer addiction (STICA) has also been proposed.The pharmacological
treatment specific to Internet addiction are mostly based on case series and studies from
comorbid conditions like ADHD. Escitalopram, Bupropion, Methylphenidate has
shown promise. The effective therapy for IA/PIU needs an individual approach and best
results are expected on combined psychological and pharmacological treatment.
1.INTRODUCTION
Pathological Internet use (PIU), also known as problematic Internet use (PIU), has been
increasingly reported by clinicians across the world. This rise of PIU and related
research is associated with the unprecedented growth and access to the Internet across
the world.1 At this point, neither the diagnosis of PIU nor Internet addiction (IA) appears
in any official diagnostic system as a number of researchers feel this as a manifestation of
an underlying problem and the Internet is only a medium of expression. At the same
time, there are researchers who have argued that IA/PIU is a separate psychiatric entity
like other addictions or akin to compulsive-impulsive disorders.
Specifically symptoms of Internet addiction include a) preoccupation with Internet
activities; b) increasing tolerance; c) development of psychological dependency and
withdrawal symptoms; d) inability to reduce Internet use; e) Internet use to cope with
negative moods and reduce stress; and f) replacing other activities and relationships
with recurrent Internet use despite awareness of the deleterious consequences.2,3 Block
(2008) suggested four diagnostic criteria essential to a possible diagnosis of PIU as an
addictive behaviour: (1) excessive Internet use, often associated with a loss of sense of
time or a neglect of basic drives; (2) withdrawal, including feelings of anger, depression
and tension when Internet is not accessible; (3) tolerance, including the need for better
computer equipment, more software, or more hours of use; and (4) adverse
consequences, including arguments, lying, poor school or vocational achievement,
social isolation, and fatigue.4
2. ASSESSMENT
There are no standard diagnostic criteria for diagnosing IA/PIU. There are already about
50 screening/ diagnostic instruments for IA/PIU which different researchers have used
in their studies. A comprehensive review of these scales5 suggests that a few scales like
the Internet Addiction Diagnostic Questionnaire (IADQ)6, Internet Addiction Test
(IAT)3, Compulsive Internet Use Scale7 are frequently used while others have been
largely restricted to single research groups. Even for the frequently used scales, the
psychometric properties need further exploration. Most of them have been used for
research-based screening for IA/PIU. The prevalence estimate of IA/PIU varies
depending on types of criteria used.8 However, for a clinician, the clinical interview and
a thorough mental state examination still remains the gold standard for assessment.
Based on the evidence available to date, the authors would like to suggest a framework
for the assessment of pathological Internet use in this clinical practice guideline as
follows: (i) assessment of the Internet use, (ii) assessment of comorbidity, and (iii)
assessment of temperament.
2.1 Assessment of Internet use:
l Quantity of time and frequency of Internet use has been a common factor assessed
in traditional settings. Unfortunately this may not be of use in our setting because of
the Internet access through the mobile phone 24/7. Therefore it would be more
useful to give importance to the form and content of Internet use.
l Nature of Internet use: The assessment should be about essential and non-essential
or recreational use of the net. This information will be useful because it will help us
understanding whether there is any pathology at all, and if it is pathological, what is
the severity. This information needs to be incorporated into the management plan.
l Type of use: Whether the individual is gaming or gambling, using pornography
(Cyber sexual), getting into virtual relationships through social networking sites
(Cyber relationship), online shopping, bullying, hacking, etc.
l Factors motivating use: This information will be helpful to understand how Internet
is helping the patient psychologically. It will also provide insights into what are the
motivation factors that maintain the excessive use of the Internet. For example, an
adolescent who has difficulty in communicating in the real world feels more
confident of making relationships on social networking sites as the perceived threat
is lesser from a virtual world. Such motivations can guide therapy. Temperament
plays an important role in deciding the nature of games they choose.9
2.2 Assessment of comorbidity:
Psychiatric comorbidity can both be a cause and consequence of the IA/PIU. The
temporal relation is difficult to establish like in the case in other addictive disorders. But
gamers with IA/PIU have high risk of comorbidity like depression and anxiety.10-12 Carlie
et al.13 reviewed 20 studies and reported that among people with IA/PIU, 75% had
depressive symptoms, 57% had anxiety symptoms, 100% had ADHD symptoms, 60%
had OCD symptoms and 66% had aggression. Many studies have found association of
substance use disorders with IA/PIU14-16. In view of all the above findings, a thorough
psychiatric interview is advised in all the patients reporting with IA/PIU. Repetitive
strain injury (RSI), computer vision syndrome, fatigue, obesity etc. have been reported
with excessive computer use.
2.3 Assessment of temperament:
Certain personality traits may contribute to the initiation, and maintenance of IA/PIU17.
They need to be evaluated for both internalizing and externalizing temperaments. The
emerging evidences indicate that most of the adolescents presenting with IA/PIU has
significant temperamental issues which contribute to the abnormal behaviour.
This assessment will be helpful in reframing the problem, developing a rapport and
develop a holistic management plan rather than focusing on the IA/PIU.
3. MANAGEMENT
The research on psychological and pharmacological management for IA/PIU is
online games to build his self-esteem, gradually realizes how his use of gaming is to
satisfy socializing emotional needs that are not fulfilled in real life.
Recognizing these patterns of faulty thinking helps the client to break the cycle of
Internet use and to restrict use of the Internet.
Third Phase: Harm reduction interventions
The associated problems related to personal, social and occupational functioning are
targeted in this phase. Identification and treatment of co-existing psychiatric and other
substance use helps in continued recovery and prevent relapse. The recovery process in
case of pathological Internet useis not just decreasing use but also addressing and
handling the underlying cause that leads to the compulsive use. Otherwise the chance
of relapse is very high.
Table 3 : Short-term Treatment for Internet and Computer Game Addiction (STICA)21
3.1.3 Effectiveness
There is robust evidence to suggest the effectiveness of various forms of psychological
intervention for IA.The effect size of CBT alone is 0.84-2.13(95% CI) and other
psychological treatments is 1.12-2.67 (95%CI) indicating the effectiveness as well as no
significant differences between the interventions. CBT group performed significantly
better with regard to “time spent online” and recovery from depression compared to
other groups. A higher number of female participants, older patients, or an American
sample had larger effect sizes for some outcome variables.22
3.2. Pharmacological
Pharmacological treatment for IA is mostly extrapolated from the treatment of
comorbidities i.e. depression, ADHD or substance use. Recent neuroimaging studies
point towards the involvement of limbic and prefrontal cortex just as in other
addictions, indicating the possible effectiveness of anti-craving drugs like opioid and
glutamate antagonists.
3.2.1. Anti-depressants
Escitalopram in the dose range of 20-30 mg/day for 10 weeks in an open label study on
19 patients as well as acase-report was associated with significant reduction of time
spent on line23. The beneficial effect persisted even after patients were randomized to
drug or placebo group. Bupropion, used among patients with gaming addiction with or
without depression, resulted in considerable degree of reduction in craving and time
spent on gaming. This improvement was not associated with any change in
depression.24 Neuroimaging studies on brain activity of patients treated with Bupropion
(left dorsolateral prefrontal cortex, left occipital lobe) did not differ from that of healthy
control.25, 26
3.2.2. Stimulants
In view of the high comorbidity of ADHD i.e. 30-50% with IA, methylphenidate has
been used for ADHD children addicted to video gaming. Methylphenidateinthe dose
range of 18-54 mg/day used among sixty two drug naïve children showed significant
benefit on both IA scale, ADHD rating score and Visual continuous performance test
(CPT)12
Other drugs like memantine, a glutamate agonist, naltrexone, an opioid antagonist,
mood stabilizers, atypical antipsychotics have been tried without much benefit.27
4. PSYCHOLOGICAL VERSUS PHARMACOLOGICAL
Winkler et al. in a recent meta-analysis of sixteen methodologically sound studies
reported that there is no significant difference in the efficacy of improvement between
both the interventions with regard to outcome parameters like time spent online,
depression and anxiety. The effect sizes for psychological treatment (95%CI: 1.22-2.33)
and pharmacological treatment (95% CI: 0.28-2.23) were similar. At the same time
there are only three methodologically sound studies on pharmacological treatment.22
Key Recommendations
(based on limited number of studies n=16 and meta-analysis)22,27
Psychological
Cognitive Behaviour Therapy for Internet Addiction is useful in reducing time spent
online, recovery from depression (A)
Other psychological therapies that include individual CBT along with family
therapy or group therapy etc. are also effective (B)
Individual therapy is better in the initial part of intervention compared to group
therapy. (C )
The short term gains achieved in the therapy are maintained over long period
(almost upto a year) (B)
Pharmacological (based on three studies)
Preliminary evidence shows that Pharmacological treatments alone (Escitalopram,
Bupropion, Methylphenidate) are effective in short term (C ).
Lack of robust and methodologically sound studies focusing on IA.
Others
Combination of these two therapies may be recommended presently as the most
effective intervention approach
In view of high comorbidity, effective therapy requires individual approach and
must be adjusted according to the patient's needs
5. CONCLUSION
In summary, the validity of Internet Addiction as a separate diagnostic entity still
remains to be established. Nevertheless, pathological use of the Internet is a problem
that is increasingly brought to the attention of the clinician. The assessment includes
assessment of the time spent on Internet-related activities, the kind of Internet activity,
the motivating factors for pathological use of the Internet, consequent disruption to
functioning and health, presence of co-morbidity and an assessment of temperament.
Engagement in treatment can pose a challenge, particularly when the individual's
occupation is Internet-based. Management includes a combination of psychological
interventions and appropriate pharmacotherapy.
References
1. Chakraborty K, Basu D, Kumar KGV. Internet Addiction: Consensus, Controversies, and
the Way Ahead. East Asian Arch Psychiatry 2010;20:123-32.
2. Spada MM. An overview of problematic Internet use. Addictive Behaviours 2014;39:3-6.
3. Young KS. Internet addiction: The emergence of a new clinical disorder. CyberPsychol
Behaviour1998;1:237-244.
4. Block JJ. Issues for DSM-V: Internet addiction. Am J of Psychiatry 2008; 165:306-307.
5. Laconi Sp, Rodgers RF, Chabrol H. The measurement of Internet addiction: a critical
review of existing scales and their psychometric properties. Comput Human Behav
2014;41:190-202.
6. Young KS. Psychology of computer use: XL. Addictive use of the Internet: a case that
breaks the stereotype. Psychol Reports 1996;79:899-902.
7. Meerkerk GJ, van Den Eijnden RJJM, Vermulst AA, Garretsen HFL. The compulsive
Internet use scale (CIUS): some psychometric properties. CyberPsychol Behaviour
2009;12:1-6.
8. Grover S, Chakraborty K, Basu D. Pattern of Internet use among professionals in India:
Critical look at a surprising survey result. Ind Psychiatry J2010;19:94-100.
9. Demetrovics Z, Urban R, Nagygyorgy K, et al. The development of the problematic
online gaming questionnaire (POGQ). PLoS One 2012;7:e36417.
10. Batthyany D, Muller KW, Benker F, Woelfling K. [Computer game playing: clinical
characteristics of dependence and abuse among adolescents]. Wien Klin
Wochenschr2008;121:502-509.
11. Bioulac Sp, Arfi L, Bouvard MP. Attention deficit/hyperactivity disorder and video
games: A comparative study of hyperactive and control children. Eur
Psychiatry2008;23:134-141.
12. Han DH, Lee YS, Na C, et al. The effect of methylphenidate on Internet video game
play in children with attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder. Compr Psychiatry.
2009;50:251-256.
13. Carli V, Durkee T, Wasserman D, et al. The association between pathological
Internet use and comorbid psychopathology: a systematic review.
Psychopathology. 2013;46(1):1-13.
26. Han DH, Kim SM, Renshaw PF. Functional Brain Changes in Response to Treatment
of Internet Gaming Disorder. C. Montag & M Reuter (eds) Internet Addiction (ed.)
Springer; 2015:77-91.
27. Przepiorka AMg, Blachnio A, Miziak B, Czuczwar SaJ. Clinical approaches to
treatment of Internet addiction. Pharmacol Rep2014;66:187-191.
Arun Kandasamy
Lekhansh Shukla
On behalf of
Indian Psychiatric Society
Specialty Section on Substance Use Disorders
2016
Other Putative Behavioural Addictions
CONTENTS
Executive Summary
1. Introduction
1.1 Current understanding and principles
1.2 Epidemiology – Global and Indian scenario
1.3 Consequence and disease burden
1.4 Syndromes under study
1.5 Comorbidity and related considerations
3. Food addiction
3.1 Introduction and current understanding
3.2 Assessment
3.3 Pharmacological management – evidence and recommendation
3.4 Non-pharmacological interventions – evidence and recommendation
4. Sex addiction
4.1 Introduction and Current understanding
4.2 Diagnostic criteria
4.3 Assessment
4.4 Pharmacological management – evidence and recommendation
4.5 Non-pharmacological interventions – evidence and recommendation
4.6 Ethical and legal concerns
6. Exercise addiction
6.1 Introduction and current understanding
6.2 Assessment
6.3 Management
7. Conclusion
EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
Introduction: Behavioural addiction is an emerging field. There are certain similarities
between substance use disorder and behavioural addictions. Components model of
addictions suggest that any behavioural excess should be evaluated on six parameters;
salience, mood modification, tolerance, withdrawal symptoms, conflict and relapse.
Existence and prevalence of these disorders in Indian population require further studies.
Food addiction, sex addiction and compulsive buying are backed by prevalence studies
while other proposed behavioural addictions have only case reports/case series as
evidence. There is high comorbidity with mood, substance use disorders and
temperamental traits of externalizing or internalizing spectrum.
Scope and Methodology of Guidelines: A literature search of PubMed and Google
Scholar database was done, references of review articles and monographs were also
included. These guidelines are meant to support clinicians and are limited by the
scarcity of evidence available in this field.
Food addiction: Repeated binges of hyper-palatable (high fat or sugars) foods, loss of
control, negative affective states are features suggestive of food addiction. There are no
instruments which can be suggested for routine use in Indian population. Treatment of
comorbidities is strongly recommended. Combination of psychological and
pharmacological therapy is essential. Fluoxetine or Topiramate can be chosen as first
line agents along with cognitive behaviour therapy. Lifestyle modification and dietary
counselling should be provided in all cases of food addiction and/or obesity.
Sex addiction: Non-paraphilic compulsive sexual activity with features of loss of
control, tolerance, withdrawal symptoms and relapses is conceptualized as sex
addiction. PATHOS is a brief screening instrument that can be used in routine clinical
care. Treatment of comorbid mood disorder, Attention deficit hyperactive disorder
(ADHD) is recommended. Fluoxetine or Sertraline can be used as first line agents
however, evidence is not strong. Similarly, there is lack of evidence for psychotherapy
models.
Compulsive buying disorder: Irrepressible, uncontrolled excessive buying that
continues despite negative consequences is suggested as hallmark of compulsive
buying disorder. Evaluation and treatment of comorbid disorders is strongly indicated.
There is insufficient evidence to recommend any pharmacotherapy. Cognitive
behavioural therapy has shown promising improvement and is recommended as a first
line intervention.
Exercise addiction: Excessive exercise with features of salience, withdrawal, loss of
control and tolerance is proposed as exercise addiction. It should be differentiated from
eating disorders (anorexia nervosa, bulimia nervosa) and body dysmorhophobia. There
is insufficient evidence to recommend any pharmacological or non-pharmacological
treatment.
1. INTRODUCTION
1.1 Current understanding and principles
The area of behavioural addictions is an evolving field. This chapter will address
syndromes that are less established than pathological gambling and Internet use
disorder but need mention due to emerging evidence. It is emphasized that every
'behavioural excess' is not conceptualized as an addiction. Mark Griffith's components
model of addiction gives the most studied and convergent set of criteria for diagnosing
behavioural addiction. It consists of six core components: salience, mood modification,
tolerance, withdrawal symptoms, conflict, and relapse (Panel1). It should be noted that
some of the syndromes discussed in this chapter are included in official classifications
with a different name while some are not included in any official classification currently.
(3%), sex addiction (3%), exercise-addiction (3%), work addiction (10%) and shopping
addiction (6%) in US population.1 A longitudinal study reports similar one year
prevalence rates where eleven percent responders reported 'at least one excessive
behaviour'. Specifically, food addiction (7.4%), shopping addiction (4.5%), sex
addiction (2.5%) and exercise addiction (3.3%) were identified through self-diagnosis.2
In India, an ICMR funded survey identified food addiction (1.6%; 2% male & 1.2%
female), Shopping addiction (4%; male-3.2% & female-4.8%), Sex addiction (2%; 0.3%
male&0.1% female) and Exercise addiction (5.6%; 7.5% males & 3.8% females).3
1.3 Consequence and Disease Burden
Since these syndromes are relatively recent concepts they do not lend themselves to
traditional estimates of morbidity and mortality. However, they indirectly contribute to
significant disease burden globally. For example, there is a link between obesity and
food addiction. Obesity accounts for 3·4 million deaths, 3·9% of years of life lost, and
3·8% of disability-adjusted life-years (DALYs) worldwide.4 Further research is needed to
quantify disease burden due to other behavioural addictions.
1.4 Syndromes under study
Since behavioural addiction is an evolving concept there are a number of excess
behaviours that are being conceptualized in this rubric. It's noted that while some of
these syndromes have other names in official classifications, most are not diagnosable
using DSM-5 or ICD-10. It is necessary to view these conditions in perspective of
available evidence and there place in diagnostic systems. A list of these conditions
along with the literature supporting them and their relationship with existing diagnoses
is presented in Table 1.
Table 1 : List of proposed behavioural addictions
Behavioural Proposed Evidence Related DSM5 Related ICD10
Excess 'Addiction' Diagnoses Diagnoses
Food Consumption Food addiction Self-report surveys. Feeding and Eating Atypical Bulimia
Prevalence and disorders. Nervosa.
follow up studies. Binge eating Other eating
(Convenient disorder. disorder.
samples)
Sexual activities Sex addiction Self-report surveys. Nil Excessive sexual
Prevalence and drive.
follow up studies.
(Convenient
samples)
Shopping and Compulsive Self-report and Nil Other habit and
spending. buying/ Shopping prevalence studies. Impulse disorders.
addiction (Convenient
samples)
inability to alter this behaviour is that hyper-palatable foods are addictive.6 This concept
is more pertinent for patients with binge eating and clear loss of control regarding
certain calorie dense hyper-palatable food items (high fat, high sugar foods).7 There are
two important caveats to this conceptualization. Firstly, obesity is not always due to
disordered eating, other endocrine causes should be ruled out. Secondly, overeating
itself does not indicate an addictive process, for many individuals it is due to large
potions, liberal snacking and poor food choices.8
3.2 Assessment
3.2.1 Brief Overview
First Assessment is an opportunity of establishing rapport and further engagement
which is required for a more nuanced understanding of patient'sproblems. There can be
different contexts in which patient presents for example; referral by a physician or
specialist, pre-bariatric surgery referral, self-referral or being brought by family for
'disordered eating'. A final formulation may not be reached till a number of interviews
are conducted. This should be communicated to patient and family.
3.2.2 Clinical History
A detailed history should include; purpose and context of current visit, comorbid
psychiatric or physical disorders, current medications if any, substance use history,
history of other behavioural addictions, premorbid personality and temperament.
Family history of substance use disorders, obesity, metabolic disorders and current
living arrangement is important. Important findings that demand a more detailed
evaluation for food addiction, based on available literature are highlighted in Panel2.
There are certain differential diagnoses that should be considered and are highlighted in
Panel3. It should be kept in mind that Binge eating disorder and Food addiction are
competing formulations and cannot be delineated at present.9
how to incorporate this information into daily lives (behaviour therapy). Lifestyle
management has been shown to result in a modest (typically 3–5 kg) weight loss
compared with no treatment or usual care.14
FOOD ADDICTION
Key Features: Repeated binges, loss of control, consumption of hyper-palatable
l
term.
4. SEX ADDICTION
4.1 Introduction and current understanding.
Excessive, compulsive sexual desire and activities have been variously named as – sex
addiction, compulsive sexual behaviour, sex dependency and impulsive-compulsive
sexual disorder. Despite being reported and postulated since 1812 by Benjamin Rush it
was not included in DSM 5 due to lack of adequate evidence.20 Current
conceptualization of sex addiction is a non-paraphilic excessive sexual behaviours with
features of impulsivity, compulsivity and causing significant personal distress, social or
medical comorbidity. This conceptualization and resultant criteria has high internal
consistency, inter-rater reliability and cross-validity with measures of hyper-sexuality,
impulsivity, stress-proneness and emotional dysregulation.21
4.2 Diagnostic criteria
There are multiple sets of criteria proposed by different groups working in the field.
There is a significant similarity between these criteria and criteria for substance use
disorders. Criteria proposed by Carnes et al is mentioned in Panel6 as it has been
studied most extensively and has longitudinal stability.22
250 © Indian Psychiatric Society 2016
Other Putative Behavioural Addictions
4.3 Assessment
4.3.1 Brief overview
There are multiple considerations during assessment like – context of assessment,
confidentiality, privacy, legal implications and need to remain non-judgmental.
Context of assessment can be self-referral, marital conflict, under duress or for other
psychiatric problems. Multiple interviews may be required to establish adequate
comfort level.
4.3.2 Clinical History
Clinical history should focus on detailed sexual and relationship history, fantasies,
internal conflict and compulsivity. A clear understanding of gender identity, sexual
orientation and sexual preferences is necessary to avoid misdiagnosis. A frank
discussion regarding sexual preferences and conflicts with law is required.
have sexual addiction. Similar to the CAGE, this mnemonic six- item screener (extracted
from the SAST-R) was found to have acceptable internal consistency (0.94–0.77) and
using the cut-off score of 3, demonstrated good sensitivity and specificity ratings.24 See
Panel 8 for a list of PATHOS items.
SEX ADDICTION
Key Features: Failure to resist impulses, desire to control or stop, increasing time
l
therapy.
Recommended: Fluoxetine 20-60mg/day.
l
Treatment Goals: Control of high risk contacts and commitment to long term
l
therapy.
Group therapy and individual psychodynamic therapy has also been proposed but with
no efficacy data for comparison. Thus CBT is recommended as a treatment for
compulsive buying disorder. (Evidence category 1B, strength of recommendation A).
6. EXERCISE ADDICTION
6.1 Introduction and current understanding.
Exercise addiction has been variously referred to as compulsive exercise, obligatory
exercise or exercise abuse. Initially believed to be a 'positive addiction'33 it is
increasingly realized that some individuals have patterns of exercise that are
dysfunctional.34 It remains a rare condition but is more common in individuals related to
professional sports. In such cases it is difficult to delineate it from high levels of
commitment and competitiveness. Further, there is substantial debate if this entity exists
separate from eating disorders.35
6.2 Assessment
Excessive exercise should be evaluated keeping in mind the components model of
7. Gearhardt AN, White MA, Masheb RM, Morgan PT, Crosby RD, Grilo CM. An
examination of the food addiction construct in obese patients with binge eating
disorder. Int J Eat Disord. 2012;45(5):657-63.
8. Moreno C, Tandon R. Should overeating and obesity be classified as an addictive
disorder in DSM-5? Curr Pharm Des. 2011;17(12):1128-31.
9. Gearhardt AN, White MA, Masheb RM, Grilo CM. An Examination of Food Addiction in
a Racially Diverse Sample of Obese Patients with Binge Eating Disorder in Primary Care
Settings. Compr Psychiatry. 2013;54(5):500-5.
10. Gearhardt AN, Corbin WR, Brownell KD. Preliminary validation of the Yale Food
Addiction Scale. Appetite. 2009;52(2):430-6.
11. Reas DL, Grilo CM. Review and Meta-analysis of Pharmacotherapy for Binge-eating
Disorder. Obesity. 2008;16(9):10.1038/oby.2008.333.
12. Reas DL, Grilo CM. Current and Emerging Drug Treatments for Binge Eating Disorder.
Expert Opin Emerg Drugs. 2014;19(1):99-142.
13. Crow S. Treatment of Binge Eating Disorder. Curr Treat Options Psychiatry.
2014;1(4):307-14.
14. Wadden TA, Butryn ML, Wilson C. Lifestyle modification for the management of
obesity. Gastroenterology. 2007;132(6):2226-38.
15. Hay PJ, Bacaltchuk J. Psychotherapy for bulimia nervosa and binging. Cochrane
Database Syst Rev. 2003(1):Cd000562.
16. Telch CF, Agras WS, Linehan MM. Group dialectical behaviour therapy for binge-eating
disorder: A preliminary, uncontrolled trial. Behaviour Therapy. 2000;31(3):569-82.
17. Hilbert A, Bishop ME, Stein RI, Tanofsky-Kraff M, Swenson AK, Welch RR, et al. Long-
term efficacy of psychological treatments for binge eating disorder. Br J Psychiatry.
2012;200(3):232-7.
18. Wilson GT, Vitousek KM, Loeb KL. Stepped care treatment for eating disorders. J
Consult Clin Psychol. 2000;68(4):564-72.
19. Ronel N, Libman G. Eating Disorders and Recovery: Lessons from Overeaters
Anonymous. Clin. Soc. Work J. 2003;31(2):155-71.
20. Kafka MP. Hypersexual disorder: a proposed diagnosis for DSM-V. Arch Sex Behav.
2010;39(2):377-400.
21. Reid RC, Carpenter BN, Hook JN, Garos S, Manning JC, Gilliland R, et al. Report of
findings in a DSM-5 field trial for hypersexual disorder. J Sex Med. 2012;9(11):2868-77.
22. Carnes PJ. Sexual addiction and compulsion: recognition, treatment, and recovery. CNS
Spectr. 2000;5(10):63-72.
23. Carnes P, Green B, & , Carnes S. The same yet different: Refocusing the Sexual Addiction
Screening Test (SAST) to reflect orientation and gender. Sexual Addiction Compulsivity.
2010;17(1):7-30.
24. Carnes PJ, Green BA, Merlo LJ, Polles A, Carnes S, Gold MS. PATHOS: A brief screening
application for assessing sexual addiction. J Addict Med. 2012;6(1):29-34.
25. Assumpção AA, Garcia FD, Garcia HD, Bradford JMW, Thibaut F. Pharmacologic
Treatment of Paraphilias. Psychiatric Clinics of North America. 2014;37(2):173-81.
26. Khan O, Ferriter M, Huband N, Powney MJ, Dennis JA, Duggan C. Pharmacological
interventions for those who have sexually offended or are at risk of offending. Cochrane
Database Syst Rev. 2015;2:Cd007989.
27. Kafka MP, Prentky R. Fluoxetine treatment of nonparaphilic sexual addictions and
paraphilias in men. J Clin Psychiatry. 1992;53(10):351-8.
28. Raymond NC, Grant JE, Coleman E. Augmentation with naltrexone to treat compulsive
sexual behaviour: a case series. Ann Clin Psychiatry. 2010;22(1):56-62.
29. Model Guidelines under Section 39 of The Protection of Children from Sexual Offences
Act, 2012 New Delhi: MINISTRY OF WOMEN AND CHILD DEVELOPMENT 2013
[cited 2015 15/09/2015]. Available from: http://wcd.nic.in/act/POCSO%20-
%20Model%20Guidelines.pdf.
30. Dittmar H. Compulsive buying--a growing concern? An examination of gender, age, and
endorsement of materialistic values as predictors. Br J Psychol. 2005;96(Pt 4):467-91.
31. Black DW. A review of compulsive buying disorder. World Psychiatry. 2007;6(1):14-8.
32. Jon EG, Marc NP, Donald WB. Epidemiology and Phenomenology of Compulsive
Buying Disorder. 'Oxford University Press'.
33. Glasser W. Positive addiction. New York: Harper and Row; 1976.
34. Adams J, Kirkby R. Exercise Dependence and Overtraining: The Physiological and
Psychological Consequences of Excessive Exercise. Sports Medicine, Training and
Rehabilitation. 2001;10(3):199-222.
35. Blaydon MJ, Lindner KJ. Eating disorders and exercise dependence in triathletes. Eat
Disord. 2002;10(1):49-60.
DUAL DIAGNOSIS
DUAL DIAGNOSIS :
PSYCHOTIC DISORDERS
On behalf of
Indian Psychiatric Society
Specialty Section on Substance Use Disorders
2016
Dual Diagnosis : Psychotic Disorders
CONTENTS
Executive Summary
1. Introduction
1.1. Concept of dual diagnosis
1.2. Epidemiology of dual diagnosis: psychotic disorders
1.3. Importance of dual diagnosis: psychotic disorders
2. Scope and methodology of the guideline
2.1. Overview of the guidelines
2.2. Scope of the guidelines
2.2.1. Psychotic dual diagnosis
2.3. Methodology of guideline development
3. Assessment and formulation
3.1. General issues
3.2. Treatment aims / goals
3.3. Deciding treatment setting
3.4. Assessment of dual diagnosis: psychotic disorders
3.4.1. General overview
3.4.2. Clinical history
3.4.3. Physical examination
3.4.4. Assessing risk
3.4.4.1. Violence
3.4.4.2. Suicidality
3.4.5. Rating scales
3.4.6. Investigations
3.5. Recommendations for practice
4. Interventions in psychotic dual diagnosis
4.1. Motivation enhancement intervention
4.2. Pharmacological measures
4.2.1. For substance use disorder
4.2.1.1. Short term management
4.2.1.1.1. Interaction of anti-psychotic medications
with substance of abuse and medicines
used for its short term management
(management of withdrawals)
EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
The term 'dual diagnosis' refers to the co-occurrence of at least one psychoactive
substance use disorder and at least one non-substance psychiatric disorder. Persons
with dual diagnoses, in general, pose certain unique assessment and management
challenges. This is also true for persons with dual diagnoses who have psychotic
disorder as the psychiatric disorder. With respect to the management of persons with
dual diagnosis (having psychotic disorder as the psychiatric disorder) the following
recommendations can be made -
l Detailed history and physical examination should be undertaken (S)
l Risk for violence towards self or others need to be evaluated (S)
l Rating scales should be applied (B)
l Routine and special investigations should be performed as appropriate (B)
l Motivational interviewing can be used to improve retention in treatment and
outcome (A)
l Motivational interviewing techniques may be modified to suit needs of psychotic
dual diagnosis patients (C)
l Most of the medications used for management of substance use disorders remain to
be systematically studied in psychotic dual diagnosis patients
l Naltrexone (A), acamprosate (A) and disulfiram (A) are effective in management of
alcohol use disorders
l Varenicline (A) and Bupropion (sustained release) (A) are effective in management of
tobacco use disorders
l Most of the first generation anti-psychotics and many of the second generation anti-
psychotics remain to be systematically studied in psychotic dual diagnosis patients
l Atypical antipsychotics are considered the first line of management in psychotic dual
diagnosis patients (D)
l Risperidone (A), olanzapine (A) and flupenthixol (B) are effective in management of
psychotic dual diagnosis patients
l Haloperidol (A), risperidone (A), olanzapine (A) and flupenthixol (B) are effective in
reducing substance use among psychotic dual diagnosis patients
l Long acting depot preparations may be used in case of compliance issues (D)
l There is some support for use of electroconvulsive therapy, but there is a need to
further research its role in psychotic dual diagnosis patients (C)
l Integrated psychosocial management is found to be better than individual stage-wise
management (B)
lAssertive outreach to improve engagement with treatment services has been found to
be helpful (B)
lCognitive behavioural interventions, social skills training and group interventions
have also shown benefit in dual diagnosis patients with psychotic disorders (B)
lVarious Psychosocial treatments work to similar extent for dual diagnosis patients
with psychosis (A)
l Contingency management may be useful for homeless dual diagnosis patients (A)
lHousing first approach requires further consideration as a harm reduction approach
in homeless population (B)
1. INTRODUCTION
1.1 CONCEPT OF DUAL DIAGNOSIS
The term 'Dual diagnosis' has been defined in various ways. It generally refers to the
presence of at least one (psychoactive) substance use disorder (SUD) and one
psychiatric disorder in the same person.1,2 Previously various terms have been used to
represent this co-occurrence of substance use disorders and psychiatric disorders. These
include Mentally Ill Chemical Abusers (MICA), Chemical Abusing Mentally Ill (CAMI),
Mentally Ill Substance Abusers (MISA), and Substance Abusing Mentally Ill (SAMI).
Over the past few years the terms 'Individuals with Co-occurring Psychiatric and
Substance Use disorders (ICPSUD)' and'Co-occurring disorders' are beign increasingly
used to represent those having both substance use disorders and psychiatric disorders.
For the purpsoe of the current guidelines the term 'dual diagnosis' shall be used to
represent this set of population as it coninues to be one of the most commonly used
terms in medical lietrature.
Individuals with a wide range of psychiatric disorders are more likely to have a co-
morbid substance use disorders (SUD) compared to the general population. Similarly,
those having a substance use disorder have increased chances of having a co-morbid
psychiatric disorder. Substance use disorders and psychotic disorders tend to co-occur
together3,4,5 and this co-morbidity is the focus of the current chapter.
The co-occurrence rate of SUD and psychotic disorders is greater than what would be
expected by chance. There are different possible reasons for this greater by chance
association of SUD and psychiatric disorders.6 These are represented by the common
factor model, bidirectional model, secondary substance use disorder model and
secondary psychiatric disorder models. The general issues and concepts of dual
diagnosis are applicable to the co-morbidity of substance use disorders and psychotic
disorders. These have been covered in the previous clinical practice guidelines for the
assessment and management of substance use disorders published by Indian Psychiatric
Society.7
1.2 EPIDEMIOLOGY OF DUAL DIAGNOSIS: PSYCHOTIC DISORDERS
Studies conducted worldwide have shown high rates of co-occurrence of SUD
associated with any psychiatric disorder. This is especially true for the clinical
population based studies. The rate of co-occurrence of SUD and psychiatric disorders
has varied from 15% in the general population to 80% in clinical samples from both
mental health and addiction treatment settings. However, few of these studies have
specifically calculated the prevalence of the co-morbidity of SUD with a psychotic
disorder. Even the studies that have analyzed the rate of this co-occurrence have been
limited by small sample size. Epidemiological studies that have assessed co-morbidity
of substance use disorders with psychotic disorders and found that alcohol and drug
dependence are twice as common in persons with a psychotic disorder.9
The Epidemiological Catchment Area (ECA) study revealed that 37% of people with
alcohol use disorders and 53% with other drug use disorders had co-morbid psychiatric
conditions. Amongst people with the diagnosis of schizophrenia, 47% had a substance
abuse or dependence disorder. Individuals with a diagnosis of schizophrenia were also
three times more likely to be alcohol abusers and six times more likely to abuse other
substances as compared to those without schizophrenia.10 It also estimated that even
after adjusting for baseline psychopathology and socio-demographic variables a
lifetime diagnosis of alcohol abuse/dependence predicted an eight-fold increased risk
of reporting at least one psychotic symptom in the follow-up period. Rates of cigarette
smoking among people with schizophrenia were between 70 and 88%.10
The National Co-morbidity Survey (NCS) also reported that alcohol and drug use
disorders are quite often co-morbid with other psychiatric disorders. In the revised NCS
(NCS-R), the prevalence rate for co-morbid SUD with non-affective psychosis over the
lifetime was 26.8% and prevalence in the year prior to the assessment was 15.6%.11
The studies that have focused specifically on psychotic disorders (including
schizophrenia) also have found high co-morbidity of psychotic disorders12 and
substance use disorders.12 In the Clinical Antipsychotic Trials in Intervention
Effectiveness (CATIE) study,12 at least one substance abuse or dependence was reported
in 60.3% of the sample.In an epidemiologically representative British sample of patients
with first episode psychosis Barnett et al.13 found the prevalence of substance use to be
twice as much as in the general population. Cannabis and alcohol were the most
frequently abused substances with 38% reporting polysubstance abuse. Kavanaghet
al.14 reported on substance use related variables in an Australian sample of patients with
both affective and non-affective psychosis. The prevalence of substance use disorders
was comparable in both groups with men having greater prevalence than women.
Younger age group was associated with use of illicit drugs whereas lower educational
attainment was associated with cannabis use. Addington et al.15 studied patients
admitted to an early psychosis program in Canada and confirmed earlier reports of
greater prevalence in men and younger age groups. The most prevalent substances were
alcohol and cannabis, in keeping with several previous observations.
There is a relative paucity of studies from India with regard to epidemiology co-
occurring SUD and psychotic disorders. Though characteristics of Hemp Insanity had
been described from India more than 80 years ago,16 there have been no
epidemiological studies that have systematically assessed the prevalence of co-morbid
SUD and psychotic disorders in general population. The prevalence of SUD among
persons diagnosed with psychotic disorders has been found to vary across clinical
population based studies. In a study conducted in central India, 54.3% of consecutively
admitted male schizophrenia patients were found to have an additional substance use
disorder17. Another study found substance use disorders apart from tobacco to be
present in less than 20% of the sample of patients with psychotic disorders.22 A study by
Basu et al found that psychotic disorders were present in about 3% of patients treated for
substance use disorders in a de-addiction centre. Another study found that psychotic
disorders was present in about 2% of patients being treated for alcohol use disorder.19
The course of the psychotic disorder had been reported not to be associated with
substance use in a previous study from India.20 The varied findings observed across these
studies are, in part, reflection of the different settings across which these studies have
been carried. Additionally, the study criteria, diagnostic paradigms used and sample
selection were also different across these studies. There is a need for representative
community based epidemiological studies to ascertain the rates of co-morbid substance
use disorders and psychotic disorders in the country.
1.3 IMPORTANCE OF DUAL DIAGNOSIS: PSYCHOTIC DISORDERS
Substance misuse has been identified as both a risk factor for onset as well as
progression of psychiatric disorders.11 On the other hand, impaired psychological status
may also contribute to relapse or an increase in substance use. Substance abuse is
associated with a wide range of deleterious effects in persons with a psychotic disorder.
Co-morbid SUD in persons with psychotic disorders (including schizophrenia) makes
them vulnerable even to premature death due to various factors such as vulnerability to
medical illnesses, accidental deaths, and suicide.21,22 Thus, appropriate recognition and
management of dual diagnosis is of paramount importance.
Additionally, co-morbid SUD and psychotic disorders poses various clinical challenges
during management. First, the motivation of patients with substance use disorders and
psychotic disorders may be low.23 This has been attributed to the perceived benefits as a
consequence of substance use including relaxation, elevation of mood, and countering
dysphoria in some of the previous studies.24,25 Second, engagement into the treatment
process might be difficult on the account of paranoia towards treatment services, and
fear of forced detention and coercive treatment. Also, patients with dual diagnosis that
includes psychosis may have poor insight into their illness or may not regard the
substance use as a problem. Additionally, stigma associated with both the disorders may
deter the patients from utilizing the available services.26 The risk of suicide, violence and
the presence of medical co-morbidities may be higher among patients with dual
diagnosis as compared to the patients with the either of the two disorders.22,27,28,29 The risk
of therapeutic non-adherence is high,30 and so is the chance of occurrence of social
problems like homelessness and social isolation.31 The patients with substance use and
psychotic disorders have a poorer prognosis as compared to patients with either SUD or
psychosis, as they are likely to be hospitalized at an earlier age, have longer durations of
illness and hospital stay, and frequent relapses and hospitalizations.,32,33 These factors
make the treatment of patients with substance use disorders and psychosis more
challenging than that of either disorder alone. This justifies the need for separate
guidelines for the treatment of co-occurring SUD and psychotic disorders. The dual
diagnosis of SUD and psychotic disorders shall be referred to as 'psychotic dual
diagnosis' or 'dual diagnosis: psychotic disorders' in the subsequent sections.
2. SCOPE AND METHODOLOGY OF THE GUIDELINE
2.1. OVERVIEW OF THE GUIDELINES
Management of dual diagnoses in general and psychotic dual diagnoses in particular,
can be challenging. The current guidelines aim to offer guidance to clinicians who
manage patients diagnosed with both substance use disorders (SUD) and psychotic
illnesses. This shall include persons who have both SUD and psychotic disorders
irrespective of the nature of association between these two disorders.
2.2. SCOPE OF THE GUIDELINES
The current guidelines are aimed primarily at clinicians who deal with patients with co-
morbid SUD and psychotic disorders. However, the clinicians should keep in mind the
specific characteristics of the patients and the treatment setting before applying these
guidelines to individual patient. In other words, some degree of fine tuning or
individualization may be needed on a case to case basis. Finally, the treating clinician
must take into consideration the more recent evidence that would have accumulated
since writing of these guidelines.
These guidelines are meant for application by qualified and trained clinicians in de-
addiction centers and general hospital treatment settings, though it may be applicable in
other settings as well. The guidelines mainly focus on management, although some
relevant discussion on assessment is also included. The guidelines shall address the
issues specific to the psychotic dual diagnosis. The issues related to assessment and
management of SUD, in general, have been covered in the 'Clinical Practice Guidelines
for the Assessment and Management of Substance Use Disorders Treatment' published
by Indian Psychiatric Society (IPS) and can be accessed from there.34 Also, general issues
related to assessment and management for dual diagnosis have also been covered in
'Clinical Practice Guidelines for the Assessment and Management of Substance Use
Disorders Treatment' published by Indian Psychiatric Society (IPS) and can be accessed
from there.7
2.2.1. PSYCHOTIC DUAL DIAGNOSIS
For the purpose of the current guidelines 'psychotic dual diagnosis' shall refer to the co-
occurrence of one SUD and a psychotic disorder in the same individual. The dual
diagnosis of SUD and psychotic disorders shall be referred to as 'psychotic dual
PsycINFO
l
EMBASE
l
Google
l Scholar
Search terms used^ Diagnosis,
l Dual (Psychiatry)”
Psychotic
l Disorders”
Schizophrenia”
l
Bipolar disorder”
l
Induced psychosis”
l
low severity substance use disorder'. This approach although simple, provides valuable
guidance on prioritizing the various clinical needs of the patient.1
3.2. TREATMENT AIMS / GOALS
The aims of treatment of psychotic dual diagnosis are as follows:36,37,38
l Address acute and life threatening conditions (substance intoxication and
withdrawal, acute psychiatric symptoms like suicidality, co-morbid medical illness)
l Promote reduction/abstinence from substance of use
l Control the symptoms of psychiatric disorder
l Address the co-morbid medical illnesses, if any
l Address psychosocial issues
l Increase motivation
l Enhance coping and inculcate relapse prevention skills
l Provide psycho-education regarding illness, ensure compliance, regular follow-ups
l Improve socio-occupational functioning
l Promote maintenance of recovery through continued treatment and/orparticipation
in self-help groups
l Ensure community re-integration and social/occupational rehabilitation
The goals of treatment may be divided into short and long term goals for the sake of
convenience36. The short term goals include management of acute psychotic phase (with
management of associated agitation, aggression and disruptive behaviour) along with
management of intoxication, withdrawal and imminent medical issues. A rather unique
problem faced in treating psychotic dual diagnosis patients is their lesser engagement in
treatment and low motivation to reduce substance use.39 Presence of acute psychotic
symptoms and impaired judgment result in lower levels of motivation to reduce
substance use which in turn can destabilize the psychotic symptoms. This can initiate a
vicious feed-forward cycle were psychotic disorders and accompanying substance use
fuel each other and hamper improvement. Motivation enhancement and efforts to
retain the patient in the treatment facility thus assume significant importance in this
group of patients. However one must chose the appropriate time for such interventions.
Long term treatment goals are maintenance of abstinence, relapse prevention, control of
features of psychotic disorders and socio-occupational rehabilitation.
3.3. DECIDING TREATMENT SETTING
Outpatient setting, inpatient setting, day care setting amongst others are some of the
common settings where patients with psychotic dual diagnosis are likely to be treated.
This, in turn, could be located in an exclusive de-addiction facility, a general psychiatric
care facility or a specialized dual diagnosis treatment setting. The decision about
treatment setting needs to take care into account various factors. These include-
l Nature of acute psychiatric symptoms i.e. active psychotic symptoms
l Suicidality and self-harm attempts
l History or likelihood of future violence
l Severity of withdrawal symptoms/ intoxication
l Associated medical illnesses
l Severity of substance dependence
l Prior abstinence attempts
l Level of motivation of the patient
l Presence of social supports
l Patient and physician preference
In psychotic dual diagnosis patients, presence of active psychotic symptoms, associated
aggression and unmanageability can pose a threat to patient and/ or others. Hence an
inpatient treatment setting is often warranted in such situations.
3.4. ASSESSMENT OF DUAL DIAGNOSIS: PSYCHOTIC DISORDERS
3.4.1 GENERAL OVERVIEW
Assessment is a continuous process as new information may emerge at any point in the
course of treatment. Initial assessments are carried out with an aim to reach at a working
(definitive/ provisional or tentative) diagnosis and formulate a management plan. The
subsequent assessments are made to confirm the diagnosis (if not definitive), fill in the
gaps in information, carry out specialized assessment (as family dynamics etc.), and
observe response to interventions (including effects and side effects).Special attention
must be paid in cases of psychotic dual diagnosis patients with regards to the risk of
harm to self or others. Assessment typically includes history taking, physical
examination, mental status examination, use of scales and instruments, psychological
assessment, and relevant investigations. These steps are summarized in Figure 1.
3.4.2. CLINICAL HISTORY
In psychotic dual diagnosis patients, clinical history should be obtained from multiple
sources including patient, family members, significant others including friends and
medical records). Other sources of information like previous medical records should be
carefully reviewed. Efforts should be made to obtain information from co-workers, law-
enforcement officials (in case of legal repercussions related to substance use, violent
behaviour) to obtain a clear picture of the clinical symptoms and dysfunction.
Investigations
(biochemical/neuro For detection of substance; for medical complications
imaging, etc)
A detailed history regarding substance use should typically include the age of initiation,
frequency and amount of use, development of various features of 'addiction', last dose,
motivation, complications due to substance use in various domains (physical,
psychological, financial, social, familial, vocational and legal), abstinence attempts and
reasons for relapse. History of psychiatric illness should be ascertained including onset,
progression, course, severity and dysfunction.
Short lasting psychotic symptoms can be seen in the context of intoxication and must be
carefully delineated from a psychiatric disorder. Additionally, efforts should be made to
ascertain the possibility of any causal association (and directionality of causation)
between the SUD and psychotic disorder. Efforts should be made to delineate the
presence of an independent psychotic disorder from a substance induced psychotic
disorder. Temporal sequence of development of symptoms, and the course of
psychiatric symptoms in a controlled setting ensuring abstinence provide valuable clues
in establishing this distinction. This can have relevant treatment implications as
substance induced psychotic disorders tend to be self remitting once the offending
substance use stops. Relevant history to negate the possibility of delirium or organic
diseases presenting with psychiatric manifestations must also be clearly obtained.
Other aspects of the history like treatment history, medical history, family history, early
Box 1. Commonly used rating scales/ diagnostic instruments for the assessment of
dual diagnosis patients
l Dartmouth Assessment of Lifestyle Instrument (DALI)
l Brief Psychiatric Rating Scale (BPRS)
l Beck's Depression Inventory (BDI)
l Chemical Use, Abuse and Dependence (CUAD) scale
l Psychiatric Research Interview for Substance and Mental Disorders (PRISM)
diagnosis for with SUD or psychotic disorders these are important to identify presence
of co-morbid medical disorders (as a complication of SUD or otherwise); confirming(or
refuting) presence of substance in body fluids, monitoring treatment adherence,
monitoring side effects of treatment among others.
The investigations for SUD are guided mainly by the nature and route of substance
being used. Complete hemogram, renal function tests, liver function tests, blood sugar
and electrolytes are some of the commonly requested investigations. In patients with
alcohol use disorders, liver function tests may need to be supplanted by additional
investigations such as ultrasound abdomen, serum ammonia, upper GI endoscopy. In
case of injecting drug users, tests for hepatitis B and C, HIV may be indicated. A urine
screen for various substances in case of an unclear history or to additionally buttress
historical findings may also need to be performed. Those prescribed anti-psychotic
medications need to be monitored for blood glucose, lipid profile and liver function.
3.5 RECOMMENDATIONS FOR PRACTICE
The alphabet in parenthesis represents strength of evidence (for details refer to the
introductory chapter)
Only the issues specific to the psychotic dual diagnosis shall be discussed in this section.
Management of various SUD and dual diagnosis have been addressed in the 'Clinical
Practice Guidelines for the Assessment and Management of Substance Use Disorders
Treatment' published by Indian Psychiatric Society (IPS) and can be accessed from
there.7
4.1 MOTIVATION ENHANCEMENT INTERVENTIONS
A common factor contributing to the refusal or avoidance of treatment by psychotic dual
diagnosis patients is their low motivation to reduce substance use. Lack of insight
consequent to presence of psychotic illness, strong emotions, and the continuing resort
to alcohol and other readily available substances as self-medication are some of the
reason why these patients exhibit resistance to quitting substance use. Motivational
Interviewing (MI) has been recommended as an essential intervention in the early stages
of working with the patients with dualdiagnosis. Such an approach acknowledges that
individuals may not be aware that their substance use is causing problems for
themselves and others. They may not consider that they have a problem; even if they do,
decreasing or stopping use may not be on their agenda.44 Accessing treatment is not
considered equivalent to being motivated and activated to manage their own problems
with living. Hence, people living with SUD and psychotic disorders may require
assistance to move from the stage of pre-contemplation to that of contemplating of
change49,50,51,52,53 Motivational Interviewing (MI) emphasizes personal choice,
responsibility, and awareness of the risks and benefits of continued substance use and
helps the individual move towards the action stage and consequently bring about
changes with regards to their substance use behaviour.
4.2. PHARMACOLOGICAL MEASURES
4.2.1 FOR SUBSTANCE USE DISORDER
4.2.1.1 SHORT TERM MANAGEMENT
The short term management goals include treatment strategies to deal with intoxication
and withdrawal states and detoxification. Treatment of withdrawals should be initiated
along with the treatment of psychotic disorder.54
There are no empirical studies for withdrawal management for patients with psychotic
dual diagnosis. Use of typical withdrawal management regimens has been mentioned
for psychotic dual diagnosis patients. Also inpatient detoxification is recommended for
patients who are unable to stop/ reduce their substance use from out-patient.55 The
clinicians are advised to refer to the previous clinical practice guidelines for the
assessment and management of substance use disorders published by Indian Psychiatric
Society for detailed information on short term management of SUD.7
Cocaine and stimulant intoxication may present with symptoms of psychosis (e.g.
psychotic spectrum disorders and alcohol abuse.65 However, one must ensure that the
patient is capable of providing written informed consent before disulfiram therapy is
instituted.66
Acamprosate was found to be safe in a randomized trial among patients with co-morbid
schizophrenia spectrum disorders and comorbid alcohol dependence. However, the
trial failed to establish superiority of acamprosate over placebo in this trial.67
Limited evidence suggests utility of baclofen in the treatment of dual diagnosis
patients.64,68,69,70
In spite of limited published literature on effectiveness of medications used in long-term
management of alcohol in patients with co-morbid psychotic dual diagnosis, these
medications are commonly used in this population.71
4.2.2.1.2 FOR OPIOID USE DISORDERS
Buprenorphine and methadone72 are the primary agents used for opioid substitution
whereas naltrexone,62,73 is the main antagonist agent used in long term management of
opioid use disorders.
Opioid substitution therapy with methadone and buprenorphine remains to be
systematically studied among psychotic dual diagnosis patients. In a small study of
methadone maintenance therapy among people with opiate dependence and
schizophrenia, the best improvement was observed among those who were prescribed
a combination of methadone and clozapine.74 In a retrospective study on
buprenorphine treatment outcome in dually diagnosed heroin dependent patients with
psychotic dual disorders were found to have comparatively lower retention rates.75
Consensus recommendations from west have supported both methadone and
buprenorphine as safe treatment options.66
4.2.2.1.3 FOR TOBACCO USE DISORDERS
Bupropion, varenicline and nicotine replacement therapy (NRT) have all been studied
for the management of tobacco dependence in patients with psychotic dual
diagnosis.76,77,78 Bupropion (sustained release) has been found to increase smoking
abstinence rates in smokers with schizophrenia.79,80 Also, it does not increase the risk of
seizures in this population group.78 However, there is limited evidence to support use of
NRT in this population with lower than expected benefits, although it has been found to
be safe and well tolerated.66 There are randomized controlled trials and observational
studies that have established efficacy of varenicline in smoking cessation among
patients with psychotic dual disorders.81,82 However, one needs to be cautious with
regards to psychiatric adverse effects reported with use of varenicline.78 There are
reports of emergence and worsening of psychosis associated with use of veranicline.83
The alphabet in parenthesis represents strength of evidence (for details refer to the
introductory chapter)
other psychotic disorders. The clinicians are advised to read these guidelines in
conjunction with guidelines on management of psychotic disorders.
The management of psychotic disorder includes starting an antipsychotic
agent85,86,87,88,89,90,91 and optimal titration of dose based on the improvement of baseline
target symptoms.
4.2.2.1. FIRST GENERATION ANTI-PSYCHOTICS
There is limited literature that has explored effectiveness of first generation anti-
psychotics among patients with psychotic dual disorders. However, in spite of concerns
with regards to propensity of first generation antipsychotics to exacerbate substance use
consequent to extrapyramidal side effects and worsening of negative symptoms and
dysphoria, small open label trials have suggested favorable outcomes with regards to
co-morbid SUD among patients with psychotic dual diagnosis who were treated with
flupenthixol.92,93 Improvement in SUD was reported in spite of limited improvement in
psychotic features in one of these studies.93 However, long-acting injectable depot
risperidone was found to be associated with better substance use and psychosis
outcomes over six months in an open label randomized trial among patients with co-
morbid SUD and schizophrenia.94 Another randomized trial reported a significantly
higher reduction in craving for cocaine patients treated with haloperidol compared with
patients treated with olanzapine. However, there were no differences in SUD and
psychosis outcomes in this study.89 On the other hand, another study found olanzapine
to be associated with significant reductions in craving and SUD as compared to
haloperidol in a randomized trial among individuals with co-morbid cocaine use
disorder and psychotic disorder.86
4.2.2.2. SECOND GENERATION ANTI-PSYCHOTICS
Second generation antipsychotics have been considered as first line agents in primary
psychotic disorders because of the decreased risk for extrapyramidal side effects and
tardive dyskinesia. Some evidence suggests additional utility of these agents in treating
substance use disorders.87,90,91 Only clozapine,90,91 has been shown to be clearly more
effective than other agents, that too in those who have failed previous trials of other
medications. Some evidence, mainly from case reports and series, suggest clozapine's
beneficial role in psychotic dual diagnosis as it has additional beneficial effects on
substance use as well.95,96 However, there are no prospective, randomized controlled
trials that have established superiority of clozapine in such population.55
Risperidone was found to be associated with significantly less cue-elicited craving and
substance related relapses in a six week open label study among patients with co-
morbid cocaine use disorder and schizophrenia.97 However, there was no significant
improvement in psychotic features.A double-blind, randomized controlled trial over 14
weeks comparing the efficacy of olanzapine with risperidone in patients with co-morbid
cocaine/cannabis use disorder and schizophrenia found comparable treatment
adherence rates in the two groups. Risperidone was associated with a significantly
greater reduction in cannabis craving.98 Olanzapine has also shown to improve
retention in treatment and SUD during opioid agonist maintenance treatment in the
patients with co-morbid opioid use disorders and psychotic disorders.99 However, long-
acting injectable depot risperidone was found to be associated with better substance use
and psychosis outcomes over six months in an open label randomized trial among
patients with co-morbid SUD and schizophrenia.94 Another study found olanzapine to
be associated with significant reductions in craving and SUD as compared to
haloperidol in a randomized trial among individuals with co-morbid cocaine use
disorder and psychotic disorder.86
Similarly, there is some evidence that second generation anti-psychotics can have some
beneficial effect among those with psychotic disorder when used in conjunction with
nicotine replacement therapy.100
Other antipsychotics like aripiprazole and quetiapine have also been found to control
substance use and psychosis although the evidence is limited by its quantity as well as
quality.87,88
Second generation anti-psychotics have been recommended as a first line agents in
management of psychotic dual disorders.55 While there is some evidence to suggest
benefit of second generation antipsychotic over first generation antipsychotics,
comparison of various atypical antipsychotics has not established or refuted superiority
of one medicine over another equivocally. In view of the potentially life threatening
adverse effects associated with use of clozapine, other second generation anti-
psychotics such as olanzapine and risperidone have been recommended as preferred
medications for this population.55 Among these agents, choice of a particular agent may
depend upon the desired side-effect profile, availability and cost of the medications.
Long-acting injectable antipsychotic medication may be considered for patients with
recurrent relapses related to therapeutic non-adherence.93,94
The recommendations with regards to use of anti-psychotics in management of
psychotic dual diagnosis have been presented in Table 3. These recommendations need
to be seen in light of limitations of the existing evidence (including limited research on
anti-psychotics in this population) as highlighted earlier.
4.2.2.3 ELECTROCONVULSIVE THERAPY (ECT)
The efficacy of ECT has been well established in patients with psychotic disorders.101,102
ECT is often reserved for patients who do not respond to less invasive methods of
treatment. It is also considered as a viable treatment option for patients who present with
catatonia or have high risk of suicide or violence. The literature on dual diagnosis
288 © Indian Psychiatric Society 2016
Dual Diagnosis : Psychotic Disorders
psychotic patients has also supported the use of ECT as an effective treatment modality,
but has been restricted to case reports and case series.103,104
Table 3 :
Recommended anti-psychotic medications and Electroconvulsive Therapy (ECT) for
management of SUD among patients with psychotic dual diagnosis
Olanzapine (A)
l
Risperidone (A)
l
Aripiprazole (C)
l
Quetiapine (C)
l
Olanzapine (A)
l
Risperidone (A)
l
Table 5 :
Interaction between medications used for management of withdrawal
from substances and anti-psychotics
Component Description
Case management Multidisciplinary
l case management
Assertive
l outreach
Rehabilitation Provision
l of long-term support in the
community
Housing Supported
l and independent
Pharmacotherapy Provision
l of antipsychotic medication,
Improvement
l of compliance by providing
education and medication supervision
6. SPECIAL POPULATIONS
6.1. PRISON POPULATION
Studies have reported that more than 90% of prison inmates reported drug or alcohol
use. In spite of this, only limited research on dual diagnosis has been carried out in the
prison setting. A recent review of mental health care in prisons from the Sainsbury
Centre for Mental Health (SCMH) found a 'big gap' in dual diagnosis services in prison
and a 'lack of co-ordinated care' in prison and on release for those with a dual diagnosis.
It has been found feasible to use instruments such Addiction Severity Index and Mini
International Neuropsychiatric Interview (MINI) to assess patients with dual diagnosis in
prison setting. A review of existing prison based treatments of dual diagnosis reported
that well-run treatment programs often ease the burden of correctional
administration.128,129,130 However, it has been recommended that dual diagnosis patients
should be treated in specialized facilities rather than in the jails itself.
However, management of dual diagnosis in this population group remains unexplored
in Indian setting.
6.2. HOMELESS POPULATION
Patients with a dual diagnosis are more likely to have had difficulties with education,
employment, accommodation, and hence more liable to social exclusion and
homelessness as compared to those with either a SUD or a psychiatric disorder.131 Co-
morbid substance disorder and schizophrenia has been shown to be associated with a
variety of poorer outcomes, including housing instability and homelessness. Integrated
care involving mental health, substance abuse, and housing interventions has been
reported to be beneficial among this population group.118 In fact, housing first programs
favoring immediate housing and consumer choice have been recommended as viable
alternative to standard care in this population group.131,132
However, management of dual diagnosis in this population group remains unexplored
in Indian setting.
6.3. RECOMMENDATIONS FOR PRACTICE
l Jail diversion services may reduce time spent in jail without increasing risk to the
public (B)
l Service utilization of jail diversion services is required to be improved (B)
l Contingency management may be useful for homeless dual diagnosis patients (A)
l Housing first approach requires further consideration as a harm reduction
approach in homeless population (B)
References
1. Basu D, Gupta N. Management of “dual diagnosis” patients: consensus, controversies
and considerations. Indian J Psychiatry; 2000;42:34-47.
2. Drake ER, Wallach AM. Dual diagnosis: 15 years of progress. Psychiatr Serv
2000;51:1126–9.
3. Barnes RT, Mutsatsa HS, Hutton BS, Watt CH, Joyce ME. Comorbid substance use and
age at onset of schizophrenia. Br J Psychiatry 2006;188:237–42.
4. Mauri CM, Volonteri SL, De Gaspari FI, Colasanti A, Brambilla AM, Cerruti L.
Substance abuse in first-episode schizophrenic patients: a retrospective study. Clin
Pract Epidemiol Ment Health 2006;2:4
5. Wade D, Harrigan S, Edwards J, Burgess MP, Whelan G, McGorry DP. Course of
substance misuse and daily tobacco use in first-episode psychosis. Schizophr Res
2006;81:145–50.
6. Kosten RT, Ziedonis MD. Substance abuse and schizophrenia: Editors' introduction.
Schizophr Bull 1997;23:181–6.
7. Basu D, Sarkar S. Clinical practice guidelines for the management of dual diagnosis. In,
Basu D, Dalal PK (eds). Clinical Practice Guidelines for the Assessment and
Management of Substance Use Disorders. Hyderabad: Indian Psychiatric Society;
2014, 469-513.
8. Flynn MP, Brown SB. Co-occurring disorders in substance abuse treatment: Issues and
prospects. J Subst Abus Treat 2008; 34:36–47.
9. Hartz MS, Pato NC, Medeiros H, Cavazos-Rehg P, Sobell LJ, Knowles AJ, et al.
Comorbidity of severe psychotic disorders with measures of substance use. JAMA
Psychiatry 2014;71:248–54.
10. Kessler CR, McGonagle AK, Zhao S, Nelson BC, Hughes M, Eshleman S, et al. Lifetime
and 12-month prevalence of DSM-III-R psychiatric disorders in the United States:
results from the National Comorbidity Survey. Arch Gen Psychiatry 1994;51:8–19.
11. Kessler CR, Crum MR, Warner AL, Nelson BC, Schulenberg J, Anthony CJ. Lifetime co-
occurrence of DSM-III-R alcohol abuse and dependence with other psychiatric
disorders in the National Comorbidity Survey. Arch Gen Psychiatry 1997;54:313–21.
12. Naber D, Lambert M. The CATIE and CUtLASS studies in schizophrenia. CNS drugs
2009;23:649–59.
13. Barnett HJ, Werners U, Secher MS, Hill EK, Brazil R, Masson MKI, et al. Substance use
in a population-based clinic sample of people with first-episode psychosis. Br J
Psychiatry 2007;190:515–20.
14. Kavanagh D, Baker A, Teesson M. Co-morbidity of mental disorders and substance
misuse - introduction. 2004;23(4):405–6.
30. Bartels SJ, Teague GB, Drake RE, Clark RE, Bush PW, Noordsy DL. Substance abuse in
schizophrenia: service utilization and costs. J Nerv Ment Dis 1993;181:227–32.
31. Compton MT, Weiss PS, West JC, Kaslow NJ. The associations between substance use
disorders, schizophrenia-spectrum disorders, and Axis IV psychosocial problems. Soc
Psychiatry Psychiatr Epidemiol 2005;40:939–46.
32. Linszen DH, Dingemans PM, Lenior ME. Cannabis abuse and the course of recent-
onset schizophrenic disorders. Arch Gen Psychiatry 1994;51:273–9.
33. Foti DJ, Kotov R, Guey LT, Bromet EJ. Cannabis use and the course of schizophrenia:
10-year follow-up after first hospitalization. Am J Psychiatry 2010;167:987–93.
34. Basu D, Dalal PK, editors. Clinical Practice Guidelines for the assessment and
management of substance use disorders. Indian Psychiatric Society 2014.
35. Ries R, Sloan K, Miller N. Concept, diagnosis, and treatment of dual diagnosis. Curr
Psychiatr Ther 1997;173–80.
36. Matheson SL, Shepherd AM, Carr VJ. How much do we know about schizophrenia and
how well do we know it?: Evidence from the Schizophrenia Library. Psychol Med
2014;44:3387–405.
37. Lehman AF, Myers CP, Corty E. Assessment and classification of patients with
psychiatric and substance abuse syndromes. Psychiatr Serv 1989;40:1019-25;
38. Ruiz P, Strain E. Lowinson and Ruiz's substance abuse: A comprehensive textbook.
2011. Lippincott Williams and Wilkins, Philadelphia, USA.
39. Barrowclough C, Haddock G, Lobban F, Jones S, Siddle R, Roberts C, et al. Group
cognitive–behavioural therapy for schizophrenia. Br J Psychiatry 2006;189:527–32.
40. McLoughlin BC, Pushpa-Rajah J, Gillies D, Rathbone J, Variend H. Cannabis and
schizophrenia. Cochrane Database Syst Rev 2014;10:CD004837.
41. Van Dorn R, Volavka J, Johnson N. Mental disorder and violence: is there a relationship
beyond substance use? Soc Psychiatry Psychiatr Epidemiol 2012;47:487–503.
42. Rosenberg SD, Drake RE, Wolford GL, Mueser KT, Oxman TE, Vidaver RM, et al.
Dartmouth Assessment of Lifestyle Instrument (DALI): A substance use disorder screen
for people with severe mental illness. Am J Psychiatry; 2014; 155:232-8.
43. Lykke J, Hesse M, Austin SF, Oestrich I. Validity of the BPRS, the BDI and the BAI in
dual diagnosis patients. Addict Behav 2008;33:292–300.
44. McGovern MP, Morrison DH. The chemical use, abuse, and dependence scale
(CUAD): Rationale, reliability, and validity. J Subst Abus Treat 1992;9:27–38.
45. Samet S, Smith M, Endicott J. Psychiatric Research Interview for Substance and Mental
Disorders (PRISM): reliability for substance abusers. Am J Psychaitr
1996;153:1195–201.
46. Sheehan DV, Lecrubier Y, Sheehan KH, Amorim P, Janavs J, Weiller E, et al. The Mini-
International Neuropsychiatric Interview (MINI): the development and validation of a
structured diagnostic psychiatric interview for DSM-IV and ICD-10. J Clin Psychiatry
1998;59:22–33.
47. Martino S, Carroll K, Kostas D, Perkins J, Rounsaville B. Dual diagnosis motivational
interviewing: a modification of motivational interviewing for substance-abusing
patients with psychotic disorders. J Subst Abus Treat 2002;23:297–308.
48. Martino S, Carroll KM, Nich C, Rounsaville BJ. A randomized controlled pilot study of
motivational interviewing for patients with psychotic and drug use disorders. Addiction
2006;101:1479–92.
49. Santa Ana EJ, Wulfert E, Nietert PJ. Efficacy of group motivational interviewing (GMI)
for psychiatric inpatients with chemical dependence. J Consult Clin Psychol
2007;75:816-22.
50. Hulse GK, Tait RJ. Five-year outcomes of a brief alcohol intervention for adult in-
patients with psychiatric disorders. Addiction 2003;98:1061–8.
51. Graeber DA, Moyers TB, Griffith G, Guajardo E, Tonigan S. A pilot study comparing
motivational interviewing and an educational intervention in patients with
schizophrenia and alcohol use disorders. Community Ment Health J
2003;39:189–202.
52. Swanson AJ, Pantalon MV, Cohen KR. Motivational interviewing and treatment
adherence among psychiatric and dually diagnosed patients. J Nerv Ment Dis
1999;187:630–5.
53. Smeerdijk M, Keet R, Dekker N, van Raaij B, Krikke M, Koeter M, et al. Motivational
interviewing and interaction skills training for parents to change cannabis use in young
adults with recent-onset schizophrenia: a randomized controlled trial. Psychol Med
2012;42:1627–36.
54. Ramanujam R, Padma L, Swaminath G, Thimmaiah RS. A comparative study of the
clinical efficacy and safety of lorazepam and chlordiazepoxide in alcohol dependence
Syndrome. J Clin Diagn Res JCDR 2015;9:FC10-3.
55. Lubman DI, King JA, Castle DJ. Treating comorbid substance use disorders in
schizophrenia. Int Rev Psychiatry 2010;22:191–201.
56. Taylor D, Paton C, Kapur S. The Maudsley prescribing guidelines in psychiatry . John
Wiley & Sons; 2015.
57. McCance-Katz EF, Sullivan LE, Nallani S. Drug interactions of clinical importance
among the opioids, methadone and buprenorphine, and other frequently prescribed
medications: a review. Am J Addict; 2010;19:4–16.
58. Petrakis IL, O'Malley S, Rounsaville B, Poling J, McHugh-Strong C, Krystal JH.
Naltrexone augmentation of neuroleptic treatment in alcohol abusing patients with
schizophrenia. Psychopharmacology 2004;172:291–7.
59. Donovan DM, Anton RF, Miller WR, Longabaugh R, Hosking JD, Youngblood M.
Combined pharmacotherapies and behavioural interventions for alcohol dependence
(The COMBINE Study): examination of posttreatment drinking outcomes. J Stud
Alcohol Drugs 2008;69:5–13.
60. Petrakis IL, Nich C, Ralevski E. Psychotic spectrum disorders and alcohol abuse: a
review of pharmacotherapeutic strategies and a report on the effectiveness of
naltrexone and disulfiram. Schizophr Bull 2006;32:644–54.
61. Maxwell S, Shinderman MS. Use of naltrexone in the treatment of alcohol use disorders
in patients with concomitant major mental illness. J Addict Dis 2000;19:61–9.
62. Batki SL, Dimmock JA, Wade M, Gately PW, Cornell M, Maisto SA, et al. Monitored
naltrexone without counseling for alcohol abuse/dependence in schizophrenia-
spectrum disorders. Am J Addict 2007;16:253–9.
63. Larson EW, Olincy A, Rummans TA, Morse RM. Disulfiram treatment of patients with
both alcohol dependence and other psychiatric disorders: A review. Alcohol Clin Exp
Res 1992;16:125–30.
64. Mueser KT, Noordsy DL, Fox L, Wolfe R. Disulfiram treatment for alcoholism in severe
mental illness. Am J Addict 2003;12:242–52.
65. Petrakis IL, Nich C, Ralevski E. Psychotic spectrum disorders and alcohol abuse: a
review of pharmacotherapeutic strategies and a report on the effectiveness of
naltrexone and disulfiram. Schizophr Bull 2006;32:644–54.
66. Ziedonis DM, SMELSON D, Rosenthal RN, Batki SL, Green AI, Henry RJ, et al.
Improving the care of individuals with schizophrenia and substance use disorders:
consensus recommendations. J Psychiatr Pract 2005;11.
67. Ralevski E, O'Brien E, Jane JS, Dean E, Dwan R, Petrakis I. Effects of acamprosate on
cognition in a treatment study of patients with schizophrenia spectrum disorders and
comorbid alcohol dependence. J Nerv Ment Dis 2011;199:499–505.
68. Agabio R, Marras P, Addolorato G, Carpiniello B, Gessa GL. Baclofen suppresses
alcohol intake and craving for alcohol in a schizophrenic alcohol-dependent patient: a
case report. J Clin Psychopharmacol 2007;27:319–20.
69. Dore GM, Lo K, Juckes L, Bezyan S, Latt N. Clinical experience with baclofen in the
management of alcohol-dependent patients with psychiatric comorbidity: a selected
case series. Alcohol Alcohol 2011;46:714–20.
70. Agabio R, Marras P, Addolorato G, Carpiniello B, Gessa GL. Baclofen suppresses
alcohol intake and craving for alcohol in a schizophrenic alcohol-dependent patient: a
case report. J Clin Psychopharmacol 2007;27:319–20.
71. Murthy P, Chand P. Treatment of dual diagnosis disorders. Curr Opin Psychiatry
2012;25:194–200.
72. White JM, Lopatko OV. Opioid maintenance: a comparative review of
pharmacological strategies.Expert Opin Pharmacother. 2007 Jan;8(1):1-11.
302 © Indian Psychiatric Society 2016
Dual Diagnosis : Psychotic Disorders
73. Larney S, Gowing L, Mattick RP, Farrell M, Hall W, Degenhardt L. A systematic review
and meta-analysis of naltrexone implants for the treatment of opioid dependence. Drug
Alcohol Rev 2014;33:115–28.
74. Unglaub W, Kandel M, Zenner D, Wodarz N, Klein H. [Neuroleptic treatment of opiate
addicts with a comorbid schizophrenia in a methadone maintenance program].
Psychiatr Prax 2003;30:121–4.
75. Gerra G, Leonardi C, D'Amore A, Strepparola G, Fagetti R, Assi C, et al. Buprenorphine
treatment outcome in dually diagnosed heroin dependent patients: A retrospective
study. Prog Neuro-Psychopharmacology Biol Psychiatry 2006;30:265–72.
76. Saxon AJ, Baer JS, Davis TM, Sloan KL, Malte CA, Fitzgibbonsm K, et al. Smoking
cessation treatment among dually diagnosed individuals: Preliminary evaluation of
different pharmacotherapies. Nicotine & Tob Res 2003;5:589–96.
77. Meszaros ZS, Abdul-Malak Y, Dimmock JA, Wang D, Ajagbe TO, Batki SL. Varenicline
treatment of concurrent alcohol and nicotine dependence in schizophrenia: a
randomized, placebo-controlled pilot trial. J Clin Psychopharmacol 2013;33:243–7.
78. Tsoi DT, Porwal M, Webster AC. Interventions for smoking cessation and reduction in
individuals with schizophrenia. Cochrane Database Syst Rev 2013; 2:CD007253
79. Evins AE, Mays VK, Cather C, Goff DC, Rigotti NA, Tisdale T. A pilot trial of bupropion
added to cognitive behavioural therapy for smoking cessation in schizophrenia.
Nicotine & Tob Res 2001;3:397–403.
80. George TP, Vessicchio JC, Termine A, Bregartner TA, Feingold A, Rounsaville BJ, et al.
A placebo controlled trial of bupropion for smoking cessation in schizophrenia. Biol
Psychiatry 2002;52:53–61.
81. Nahvi S, Wu B, Richter KP, Bernstein SL, Arnsten JH. Low incidence of adverse events
following varenicline initiation among opioid dependent smokers with comorbid
psychiatric illness. Drug Alcohol Depend 2013;132:47–52.
82. Williams JM, Anthenelli RM, Morris CD, Treadow J, Thompson JR, Yunis C, et al. A
randomized, double-blind, placebo-controlled study evaluating the safety and efficacy
of varenicline for smoking cessation in patients with schizophrenia or schizoaffective
disorder. J Clin Psychiatry 2012;73:654–60.
83. DiPaula BA, Thomas MD. Worsening psychosis induced by varenicline in a
hospitalized psychiatric patient. Pharmacother J Hum Pharmacol Drug
Ther2009;29:852–7.
84. Lubman DI, Berk M. Pharmacotherapy for co-occurring alcohol and drug disorders in
schizophrenia and bipolar disorder: where is the evidence? Acta Neuropsychiatr
2010;22:95–7.
85. Littrell KH, Petty RG, Hilligoss NM, Peabody CD, Johnson CG. Olanzapine treatment
for patients with schizophrenia and substance abuse. J Subst Abus Treat
2001;21:217–21.
86. Smelson DA, Ziedonis D, Williams J, Losonczy MF, Williams J, Steinberg ML, et al. The
efficacy of olanzapine for decreasing cue-elicited craving in individuals with
schizophrenia and cocaine dependence: a preliminary report. J Clin Psychopharmacol
2006;26:9–12.
87. Beresford TP, Clapp L, Martin B, Wiberg JL, Alfers J, Beresford HF. Aripiprazole in
schizophrenia with cocaine dependence: a pilot study. J Clin Psychopharmacol
2005;25:363–6.
88. Potvin S, Stip E, Lipp O, Élie R, Mancini-Marië A, Demers M-F, et al. Quetiapine in
patients with comorbid schizophrenia-spectrum and substance use disorders: an open-
label trial. Curr Med Res Opin 2006;22:1277–85.
89. Sayers SL, Campbell EC, Kondrich J, Mann SC, Cornish J, O'Brien C, et al. Cocaine
abuse in schizophrenic patients treated with olanzapine versus haloperidol. J Nerv
Ment Dis 2005;193:379–86.
90. Brunette MF, Drake RE, Xie H, McHugo GJ, Green AI. Clozapine use and relapses of
substance use disorder among patients with co-occurring schizophrenia and substance
use disorders. Schizophr Bull 2006;32:637–43.
91. Green AI, Burgess ES, Dawson R, Zimmet SV, Strous RD. Alcohol and cannabis use in
schizophrenia: effects of clozapine vs. risperidone. Schizophr Res 2003;60:81–5.
92. Schilkrut R, Cabrera J, Morales E, Herrera L. Neuroleptics in the treatment of drug
dependence in schizophrenics. A study with flupenthixol decanoate.
Psychopharmacology 1988;96:342.
93. Soyka M, Aichmüller C, Beneke M, Glaser T, Hornung-Knobel S, Wegner U.
Flupenthixol in relapse prevention in schizophrenics with comorbid alcoholism:
results from an open clinical study. Eur Addict Res 2003;9:65–72.
94. Rubio G, Martínez I, Ponce G, Jiménez-Arriero MA, López-Muñoz F, Álamo C. Long-
acting injectable risperidone compared with zuclopenthixol in the treatment of
schizophrenia with substance abuse comorbidity. Can J Psychiatry 2006;51:531-9.
95. Albanese MJ, Khantzian EJ, Murphy SL, Green AI. Decreased substance use in
chronically psychotic patients treated with clozapine. Am J Psychiatry 1994; 151:
780-1.
96. Tsuang JW, Eckman TE, Shaner A, Marder SR. Clozapine for substance-abusing
schizophrenic patients. Am J Psychiatry 1999;156.
97. Kaune M, Williams J, Ziedonis D. Risperidone decreases craving and relapses in
individuals with schizophrenia and cocaine dependence. Can J Psychiatry
2002;47:671–5.
98. Akerele E, Levin FR. Comparison of olanzapine to risperidone in substance-abusing
individuals with schizophrenia. Am J Addict 2007;16:260–8.
111. Bellack AS, DiClemente CC. Treating substance abuse among patients with
schizophrenia. Psychiatr Serv 1999;50:75–80.
112. Ziedonis DM, Stern R. Dual recovery therapy for schizophrenia and substance abuse.
Psychiatr Ann 2001;31:255-64.
113. Carey KB. Substance use reduction in the context of outpatient psychiatric treatment:
A collaborative, motivational, harm reduction approach. Community Ment Health J
1996;32:291–306.
114. Shaner A, Eckman T, Roberts LJ, Fuller T. Feasibility of a skills training approach to
reduce substance dependence among individuals with schizophrenia. Psychiatr Serv
2003;54:1287–9.
115. Vogel HS, Knight E, Laudet AB, Magura S. Double trouble in recovery: Self-help for
people with dual diagnoses. Psychiatr Rehabil J 1998;21:356-64.
116. Luciano A, Bryan E, Carpenter-Song E, Woods M, Armstrong K, Drake R. Long-term
sobriety strategies for men with co-occurring disorders. J Dual Diagn. 10(4):212–9.
117. Hunt GE, Siegfried N, Morley K, Sitharthan T, Cleary M. Psychosocial interventions for
people with both severe mental illness and substance misuse. Schizophr Bull
2014;40:18–20.
118. Drake RE, Yovetich NA, Bebout RR, Harris M, McHugo GJ. Integrated treatment for
dually diagnosed homeless adults. J Nerv Ment Dis 1997;185:298–305.
119. Ziedonis DM. Integrated treatment of co-occurring mental illness and addiction:
clinical intervention, program, and system perspectives. CNS spectrums
2004;9:892–904.
120. Herman SE, Frank KA, Mowbray CT, Ribisl KM, Davidson II WS. Longitudinal effects
of integrated treatment on alcohol use for persons with serious mental illness and
substance use disorders. J Behav Health Serv & Res 2000;27:286–302.
121. Mangrum LF, Spence RT, Lopez M. Integrated versus parallel treatment of co-
occurring psychiatric and substance use disorders. J Subst Abus Treat 2006;30:79–84.
122. Morrens M, Dewilde B, Sabbe B, Dom G, De Cuyper R, Moggi F. Treatment outcomes
of an integrated residential programme for patients with schizophrenia and substance
use disorder. Eur Addict Res 2011;17:154–63.
123. Drake RE, McHugo GJ, Clark RE, Teague GB, Xie H, Miles K, et al. Assertive
community treatment for patients with co-occurring severe mental illness and
substance use disorder: a clinical trial. Am J orthopsychiatry 1998;68:201-15.
124. Manuel JI, Covell NH, Jackson CT, Essock SM. Does assertive community treatment
increase medication adherence for people with co-occurring psychotic and substance
use disorders? J Am Psychiatr Nurses Assoc 2011;17:51–6.
125. Torchalla I, Nosen L, Rostam H, Allen P. Integrated treatment programs for individuals
with concurrent substance use disorders and trauma experiences: A systematic review
and meta-analysis. J Subst Abus Treat 2012;42:65–77.
126. Clark RE, Teague GB, Ricketts SK, Bush PW, Xie H, McGuire TG, et al. Cost-
effectiveness of assertive community treatment versus standard case management for
persons with co-occurring severe mental illness and substance use disorders. Health
Serv Res 1998;33:1285-308.
127. Chen S, Barnett PG, Sempel JM, Timko C. Outcomes and costs of matching the
intensity of dual-diagnosis treatment to patients' symptom severity. J Subst Abus Treat
2006;31:95–105.
128. Butler T, Indig D, Allnutt S, Mamoon H. Co-occurring mental illness and
substance use disorder among Australian prisoners. Drug Alcohol Rev
2011;30:188–94.
129. Draine J, Blank A, Kottsieper P, Solomon P. Contrasting jail diversion and in-jail
services for mental illness and substance abuse: do they serve the same clients?
Behav Sci & law 2005;23:171–81.
130. Steadman HJ, Naples M. Assessing the effectiveness of jail diversion programs for
persons with serious mental illness and co-occurring substance use disorders.
Behav Sci & law 2005;23:163–70.
131. Lester KM, Milby JB, Schumacher JE, Vuchinich R, Person S, Clay OJ. Impact of
behavioural contingency management intervention on coping behaviours and
PTSD symptom reduction in cocaine-addicted homeless. J Trauma Stress
2007;20:565–75.
132. Tracy K, Babuscio T, Nich C, Kiluk B, Carroll KM, Petry NM, et al. Contingency
management to reduce substance use in individuals who are homeless with co-
occurring psychiatric disorders. Am J Drug Alcohol Abus 2007;33:253–8.
SK Mattoo
Shubh Mohan Singh
On behalf of
Indian Psychiatric Society
Specialty Section on Substance Use Disorders
2016
Dual Diagnosis : Non-Psychotic Disorders
CONTENTS
Executive Summary
1. Introduction
2. Scope and introduction of guideline
3. Results
3.1 General considerations and treatment setting
3.2 Screening, assessment and treatment
3.3 Mood disorders
3.3.1 Major depressive disorder (MDD) and Bipolar disorder (BPAD)
3.3.2 Pharmacotherapy
3.3.3 Psychotherapeutic and psychosocial management
3.3.4 Conclusions
3.4 Anxiety disorders
3.4.1 General considerations
3.4.2 Pharmacotherapy
3.4.3 Psychotherapeutic and psychosocial management
3.5. Personality disorders
3.5.1 General considerations
3.5.2 Borderline personality disorder
3.5.3 Antisocial personality disorder
EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
Dual diagnosis disorders (DD) denotes the co-existence of substance use disorders
(SUD) and other non-substance use psychiatric disorders in the same individual. Non-
psychotic DD include the co-occurrence of substance use disorders with mood
disorders, anxiety disorders, and personality disorders. The presence of DD predicts
poor prognosis with respect to both the SUD and the non-SUD. Therefore, treatment
options for DD need to be carefully considered. There is some evidence to show that the
traditional treatment models of consecutive or insulated care of the SUD and the non-
SUD may not be as effective as integrated or simultaneous care of the DD. The authors
have attempted to review this are keeping in view the requirements of the mental health
professional in India.
A review of literature reveals that there is scarcity of data. However, the following
recommendations can be made.
All patients should be screened for the possibility of DD at initial assessment unless
acute stabilization is required when this may be deferred. For this purpose, screening
instruments may be used. If there is any indication of DD, then a more thorough
assessment to confirm the diagnosis and get other relevant details should be done. The
treatment of DD should be conceptualized in two phases, acute and maintenance or
stabilization phase.
In DD with mood disorders, literature search indicates the following recommendations.
In alcohol SUD and major depressive disorder (MDD), mirtazapine, add-on naltrexone
or alone, add-on naltrexone to sertraline and add-on disulfiram as second choice can be
tried. In alcohol SUD with bipolar disorder, add-on naltrexone as first choice followed
by add-on lamotrigine or alone, add-on valproic acid or alone, add-on disulfiram as
second-choice and add-on gabapentin, add-on topiramate, lithium as third choice can
be recommended. In cannabis SUD with Bipolar disorder, add-on valproic acid to
lithium as first choice and lithium, or add-on valproic acid as second-choice may be
recommended. In Cocaine SUD with MDD, add-on risperidone or alone can be
recommended. In Cocaine with Bipolar disorder, add-on valproic acid to lithium as first
choice followed by add-on lamotrigine or alone, lithium, add-on valproic acid or alone,
add-on quetiapine or alone, add-on rispridone or alone as second choice can be
recommended. In Opioid SUD with MDD/Bipolar disorder no evidence based
recommendation is possible. However, treatment as usual for the affective disorder is
likely to be effective. As regards psychotherapy, in MDD and bipolar disorder,
motivational interviewing and Contingency management may be useful.
In DD with anxiety disorders, the evidence base is again scarce. Selective serotonin
reuptake inhibitors are likely to be affective. Benzodiazepines should not be withheld
1. INTRODUCTION
Dual diagnosis disorders (DD) denotes the co-existence of substance use disorders
(SUD) and other non-substance use psychiatric disorders in the same individual.1 This
co-occurrence is observed to be much higher than that would be expected by chance
alone and about 50% of people with severe mental disorders are affected by SUD.2 This
finding has been borne out in epidemiological studies done across the world across
different diagnostic groups.3 The reasons for this association are complex and various
etiological theories have been proposed.4 It is also been observed that people with DD
have higher rates of negative outcomes such as relapses, involvement in crime,
homelessness, infections and hospitalization.5 Traditional models of psychiatric care in
which services for mental disorders and SUD run separately and parallel to each other
often prove to be less than effective in the optimum management of people with DD.
Thus, despite the heterogeneity inherent in individuals with DD, the current trend is to
consider patients with DD as belonging to a distinct group with special needs and to
integrate services in such a way that both the SUD and the psychiatric disorder are
managed simultaneously by one service with equal importance paid to both.6
Notwithstanding the clinical and public health importance of DD, research in this area
has suffered due to lack of standardised definitions and nomenclature.1,7 Major
nosological systems do not have any special category for DD and stress upon the group
of substance-induced disorders in which there is evidence of a plausible association
between substance intoxication and/or withdrawal and the mental disorder with proof
of the symptoms of the latter not being due to an independent mental disorder.8,9
In addition, other than some notable exceptions, major treatment guidelines for mental
disorders have not given adequate importance to DD.10 There are some treatment
guidelines that are exclusively devoted to DD11-14 and its assessment.15 Indian data in this
field are scarce with regards to both epidemiology and treatments.16 However, given the
rates of mental disorders and SUD in the Indian population, it is likely that DD represent
a major source of psychiatric morbidity in India as well.17
This guideline attempts to synthesize available data regarding the management of non-
psychotic DD in the form of clinical practice guidelines (CPG) that are especially
applicable to the Indian context.
2. SCOPE AND METHODOLOGY OF THE GUIDELINE
CPGs are systematically developed statements to assist practitioner and patient
decisions about appropriate health care for specific clinical circumstances. The authors
have tried to maintain a high standard and quality for these guidelines. Thus, the
Appraisal of Guidelines for Research & Evaluation (AGREE) Instrument II has been used
as a template for this exercise as far as possible.18 AGREE instrument is a tool that
assesses the methodological rigor and transparency in which a guideline is developed.
© Indian Psychiatric Society 2016 315
Newer and Emerging Addictions in India
We have prepared this guideline in accordance to AGREE II, the newer revised version.
We endeavoured to follow a structured and rigorous development methodology, to
conduct an internal assessment to ensure that the guidelines are sound, and to evaluate
guidelines by other groups for potential adaptation to our own context. Categories of
strength of evidence available are based upon the AGREE II guideline.19
For the purpose of this guideline, non-psychotic disorders include the group of affective
disorders, anxiety disorders and personality disorders.
We have reviewed the available literature with regards to non-psychotic disorders, DD,
substance abuse and clinical management up to July 2015. Through a process of
consultation between the authors, relevant data were retained. Treatment guidelines
were then generated on the basis of available level of evidence.
3. RESULTS
The following sections present the results of the literature review. Each section will be
followed by a section of recommendations along with strength of available evidence.
This is presented with reference to the Indian context and the proposed audience in
mind.
3.1 General considerations and treatment setting
The presentation and management of patients with DD can take place in varied settings.
These include dedicated substance abuse services, mental health services, or dedicated
DD services. The literature review reveals that there are subtle differences in
recommendations with respect to different treatment settings.12,14,15 However, the
authors opine that considering the state of mental health services in India, our
recommendations will be common with regards to treatment setting. These
recommendations can be considered appropriate for an inpatient, outpatient or
emergency mental health service that is manned by psychiatrists and other mental
health professionals.
3.2 Screening, Assessment and Treatment
Screening is the process for evaluating the possibility of the presence of a particular
problem. Assessment on the other hand is the process of evaluating the nature of that
problem and developing specific strategies.
While it is perhaps intuitive that screening and assessment should be an integral and
important part of any management protocol in DD, objective data is scarce in this
population. Treatment guidelines however explicitly mention and advocate screening
and assessment of all patients presenting at mental health and substance abuse services
for the possibility of DD unless there are immediate contraindications such as
intoxication, pain, distress, or need of emergency treatment.14,15 If present, these need to
be managed immediately.
316 © Indian Psychiatric Society 2016
Dual Diagnosis : Non-Psychotic Disorders
The process should start with a proper history taking including family history, past
history, a physical examination and necessary laboratory investigations. As mentioned
before, the high degree of co-occurrence should ensure that the clinicians have a high
index of suspicion so that necessary details are enquired into and a clinical diagnosis is
possible. In case there is history of substance use in a setting of psychiatric symptoms,
the possibility of substance-induced disorders should be entertained and ruled out. This
is because these disorders are generally self-limiting.
In addition to clinical assessment, the use of appropriate screening instruments may be
recommended. These can include instruments such as K-10, PsyCheck, or MINI for
patients presenting with substance abuse related complaints or instruments such as
CAGE, ASSIST, AUDIT for patients presenting with complaints related to psychiatric
disorders other than substance use disorders.15 Indian data in this area are scarce. There
are some data with regard to use of screening instruments especially with respect to
alcohol use disorders20 and also the development of screening questionnaires in
vernacular for detection of common mental disorders21, depressive disorders22 and
alcohol dependence.23 However, these have not specifically addressed populations
with DD.
If clinical assessment, and/or screening indicate the presence of DD, a comprehensive
diagnostic assessment should be carried out for all patients.24 Several authors have
pointed out that diagnosis in DD may be difficult and may require multiple
assessments.24 This should be followed by treatment planning and outcome evaluation.
Treatment planning can vary on a case-to-case basis. Outcome evaluation should also
include documentation of current substance use patterns to evaluate the severity of
current use and to serve as a baseline for the future and pre-morbid baseline
functionality.24 The temptation to consider one of the other diagnosis as primary should
be avoided.25
Phases of treatment can be divided into acute treatment and stabilization followed by
maintenance and rehabilitation.25 Acute management involves observation, making a
diagnosis, management of acute conditions such as intoxication or withdrawal,
management of psychiatric symptoms and stabilization to as close to the baseline as
possible. Maintenance phase seeks to prevent relapse and recurrence through
continued medical and psychosocial interventions.25
Recommendations
Strength of all recommendations for this section: D
l All patients should be comprehensively assessed and screened unless acute
stabilization is required
l Initial assessment should include a proper history, clinical and laboratory evaluation
l Relevant screening instruments can be used
© Indian Psychiatric Society 2016 317
Newer and Emerging Addictions in India
There is somewhat greater evidence for the use of lithium alone or in association with
other drugs in BPAD DD. Lithium has been shown to be effective in adolescents with
BPAD and secondary SUD (Level Ib).45 There is also some evidence base for the use of
lithium as add-on with valproic acid or alone in DD with alcohol, cannabis and cocaine
SUD (Level Ib).44-46
Antidepressants:
There is some evidence for the use of antidepressants in MDD comorbid with DD. No
studies were found for BPAD comorbid with SUD.
Among the tricyclic antidepressants, the evidence base is as follows. There is level Ib
evidence supporting the use of amitriptyline, desipramine and imipramine in DD with
alcohol SUD.47-50 Imipramine has also been used with benefit as add-on to methadone in
opioid dependence with MDD.51,52
The evidence base for selective serotonin reuptake inhibitors is also confined to MDD.
There is level Ib evidence supporting the use of fluoxetine, escitalopram, nefazodone
and sertraline in alcohol SUD comorbid with MDD.53-58
Level IB evidence also exists for the use of mirtazapine for the same indication.47, 59
Level Ib evidence exists for the use of sertraline in cocaine SUD comorbid with
depressive symptoms.60 There is also a negative study for the use of venlafaxine in
patients cocaine SUD comorbid with MDD.61
Antipsychotics:
The evidence base for the use of antipsychotics in DD MDD is meagre. There is a level 4
study supporting the use of risperidone in cocaine SUD.62
Antipsychotics have been studied more often in the context of DD BPAD. There is
evidence supporting the use of add-on and alone quetiapine and risperidone in
polysubstance abuse (level 3), alcohol, cocaine, amphetamines and
methamphetamines (level 2).62-68 However, there are negative studies with quetiapine as
well.69
Others:
The other agents that have been studied in DD MDD are buprenorphine in heroin SUD
(level 4)70, disulfiram in alcohol SUD (level 2)71, memantine in alcohol SUD (level 2)53,54
and naltrexone add-on or alone (level 2)58,72, naltrexone with sertraline.58
The other agents that have been studied in BPAD DD are add-on disulfiram in alcohol
SUD (level 2)72,73, methadone in heroin SUD (level 3)74 and add-on naltrexone in alcohol
SUD (level 2).72,75,76
with sertraline or placebo in alcohol SUD and posttraumatic stress disorder (PTSD) was
equivocal.95 There are studies that have investigated the possible utility of buspirone. A
category II a study in subjects with generalized anxiety disorder (GAD) and alcohol
SUD showed that buspirone was useful in measures of anxiety and drinking.96 A couple
of studies with buspirone in subjects with alcohol SUD and GAD, and subjects with
opioid dependence on methadone found no significant improvements in substance or
anxiety outcome parameters.97,98
The use of benzodiazepines in this group of patients is controversial. Whereas a
common sense approach would indicate that such agents should be used with
circumspection, actual data is sparse. Some studies suggest that those with SUD are
more prone to abusing and developing dependence to benzodiazepines.99 However
there are some studies to the contrary as well which suggest that with careful monitoring
and selection, benzodiazepines can be gainfully used in patients with SUD and anxiety
disorders.100,101
3.4.3 Psychotherapeutic and psychosocial management
While there is ample evidence for the use of non-pharmacological therapies in the form
of behaviour therapies (BT) in anxiety disorders, the evidence base for the use of BT in
DD is mixed. A category III study showed that subjects with panic disorder with and
without agoraphobia and SUD had worse outcomes than those without when subjected
to CBT.102 Similarly, a category IIa study investigating the use of CBT in patients with
panic disorder and alcohol SUD found that CBT performed no better than treatment as
usual.103 Another category Ib study investigating the role of CBT in patients with alcohol
SUD and comorbid anxiety disorders showed that while CBT was effective in improving
anxiety outcomes, alcohol outcomes were not significantly different.104 Another
category Ib study showed that evidence based psychotherapy for PTSD in patients with
alcohol SUD did not perform better than supportive counselling and
pharmacotherapy.105 On the other hand, studies have shown that subjects with various
anxiety disorders and alcohol SUD respond equally well when compared to those
without alcohol SUD when subjected to various forms of BT.106-108 However these
studies were not as robust as the former.
Another interesting development is the testing of integrated treatments designed
specifically for comorbid anxiety disorders and SUD. These include the following. An
integrated CBT protocol for alcohol SUD and panic disorder has been developed.109 A
category 1b trial showed that integrated treatment was associated with reductions in
anxiety and alcohol use.110 Other integrated therapies have been devised for PTSD
comorbid with alcohol SUD. Therapies devised in this population group are seeking
safety111, integrated CBT112 and COPE (concurrent treatment of PTSD and substance use
disorders using prolonged exposure).113 Evidence base suggests that these treatments are
well tolerated and do not worsen PTSD symptoms.92 However, much more research
evidence is needed before these therapies enter the mainstream. The issue of paucity of
trained personnel to deliver these therapies in a country such as India is also pertinent.
Recommendations
l Given the association of anxiety symptoms and different phases of substance use, a
proper diagnostic exercise is essential before making a diagnosis of DD.
l Selective serotonin reuptake inhibitors may be useful in anxiety disorders with SUD.
l Benzodiazepines should be used with caution but should not be withheld when
indicated.
l Non-pharmacological methods of treatment in form of integrated, specific behaviour
therapies are recommended.
3.5 Personality disorders (PD)
PD, specially the antisocial personality disorder are commonly comorbid with
substance abuse.2 Similar findings have been reported for borderline personality
disorder as well.114 People with SUD are found to have a higher prevalence of PD than
the general population and the comorbidity of these conditions is associated with
greater impairment.114 While the comorbidity of PD and SUD is beyond doubt, there are
very few well-designed studies that have specifically looked at treatment protocols for
the same. Most studies concern with treatment strategies for individuals with PD where
some members of the population have SUD. Therefore, most guidelines in this section
are extrapolated rather than from direct evidence. There are some well-regarded
Cochrane reviews of management strategies for borderline and antisocial PD.115-119 The
British Association of Psychopharmacology has also issued updated guidelines on
treatment options for substance abuse and comorbidities that includes PD.120 Health
Canada also has a section on management options for the treatment of this DD.121 There
is a recent review on the treatment considerations in DD with borderline PD.122
3.5.1 General considerations
It is a commonly held notion that people with PD do not respond well to treatment
strategies for SUD. However, this has been refuted and it has been suggested that people
with PD and SUD can benefit as much as people without this comorbidity to standard
treatments for SUD.123 There is some evidence to suggest that this is the case across
different PD, SUD and outcomes120 (level 4 evidence). These outcomes include
measures of substance abuse, high-risk behaviours, overall mortality and suicidality.
However, evidence also suggests that treatment for this DD does not improve the
symptoms of the PD per se and that such patients should also have dedicated treatment
for the PD120 (level 4 evidence). Whether any particular treatment modality is
specifically useful for both the SUD and the PD simultaneously is uncertain. There is
some evidence to suggest that successful treatment of SUD in patient with this DD may
predict improvement in the PD.124
As with other disorders, it is essential to make a proper diagnostic assessment. However,
screening instruments for PD are not easily available. Diagnosis would mostly require a
proper clinical interview and to gather as much information from as many informants as
possible (Level 4 evidence). Issues of anger and impulse control are often clues to the
presence of PD. As in other DD, concurrent, integrated treatment is the best choice for
this DD121 (level 4 evidence).
3.5.2 Borderline Personality Disorder
The 5 evidence base for treatment options in borderline PD and SUD DD is scant.
Psychotherapy: Dialectical behaviour therapy (DBT) has some evidence base in this
population. There are a couple of RCTs that have examined DBT in this population with
significant results125,126 (Level Ib evidence). In addition, there is one study of dynamic
deconstructive psychotherapy in this population.127
Pharmacotherapy: There is some evidence to suggest that disulfiram and naltrexone can
be used in patients with borderline and antisocial PD and alcohol SUD128 (Class Ib
evidence).
3.5.3 Antisocial Personality Disorder
The evidence base for treatment options in antisocial PD and SUD DD is scant.
Psychotherapy: there is some evidence (Level IIb) regarding the usefulness of
contingency management in abstinence from substance use in patients with cocaine
SUD.129 A similar study found that structured behavioural approach improved
behavioural measures but not necessarily substance related measures in patients with
opioid SUD (level Ib evidence).130
Pharmacotherapy: In double blind placebo controlled study, nortriptyline was found to
be useful in patients with antisocial PD and alcohol SUD.131 Desipramine was found to
be inferior to placebo in patients with cocaine SUD and antisocial PD.132
Recommendations
l The evidence base in this area is scanty.
l Interventions for SUD in patients without PD are likely to be as effective in patients
with PD.
l Successful treatment of SUD may benefit symptoms of PD.
l Dialectical behaviour therapy can be recommended in borderline PD with SUD.
l Contingency management can be recommended in antisocial PD with SUD.
References
1. Basu D, Gupta N. Management of "dual diagnosis" patients?: Consensus, controversies
and considerations. Indian J Psychiatry. 2000;42(1):34-47.
2. Regier DA, Farmer ME, Rae DS, et al. Comorbidity of mental disorders with alcohol and
other drug abuse: Results from the epidemiologic catchment area (ECA) study. JAMA.
1990 Nov 21;264(19):2511-8.
3. Kessler RC. The epidemiology of dual diagnosis. Biol Psychiatry. 2004 Nov
15;56(10):730-7.
4. Mueser KT, Drake RE, Wallach MA. Dual diagnosis: A review of etiological theories.
Addict Behav. 1998 Nov;23(6):717-34.
5. Drake RE, Essock SM, Shaner A, Carey KB, Minkoff K, Kola L, et al. Implementing Dual
Diagnosis Services for Clients With Severe Mental Illness. Psychiatr Serv. 2001 Apr
1;52(4):469-76.
6. Drake RE, Wallach MA. Dual diagnosis: 15 years of progress. Psychiatr Serv Wash DC.
2000 Sep;51(9):1126-9.
7. Hryb K, Kirkhart R, Talbert R. A Call for Standardized Definition of Dual Diagnosis.
Psychiatry Edgmont. 2007 Sep;4(9):15-6.
8. American Psychiatric Association. Diagnostic and statistical manual of mental
disorders. 5th ed. Washington, DC: American Psychiatric Association; 2013.
9. World Health Organization. The ICD-10 classification of mental and behavioural
disorders: clinical descriptions and diagnostic guidelines. Geneva: World Health
Organization; 1992.
10. Perron BE, Bunger A, Bender K, Vaughn MG, Howard MO. Treatment Guidelines for
Substance Use Disorders and Serious Mental Illnesses: Do They Address Co-Occurring
Disorders? Subst Use Misuse. 2010 Jun;45(0):1262-78.
11. Beaulieu S, Saury S, Sareen J, Tremblay J, Schütz CG, McIntyre RS, et al. The Canadian
Network for Mood and Anxiety Treatments (CANMAT) task force recommendations for
the management of patients with mood disorders and comorbid substance use
disorders. Ann Clin Psychiatry Off J Am Acad Clin Psychiatr. 2012 Feb;24(1):38-55.
12. Center for Substance Abuse Treatment. Substance Abuse Treatment for Persons With
Co-Occurring Disorders [Internet]. Rockville (MD): Substance Abuse and Mental
Health Services Administration (US); 2005 [cited 2015 Aug 3]. Available from:
http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK64197/
13. Dual diagnosis: good practice handbook [Internet]. 2007 [cited 2015 Mar 8]. Available
from: http://www.turning-point.co.uk/media/170796/
dualdiagnosisgoodpracticehandbook.pdf
14. Queensland health dual diagnosis clinical guidelines [Internet]. Queensland health;
role impairment of commonly occurring chronic physical disorders: results from the
National Comorbidity Survey. J Occup Environ Med Am Coll Occup Environ Med.
2003 Dec;45(12):1257-66.
28. Watkins KE, Cuellar AE, Hepner KA, Hunter SB, Paddock SM, Ewing BA, et al. The cost-
effectiveness of depression treatment for co-occurring disorders: a clinical trial. J Subst
Abuse Treat. 2014 Feb;46(2):128-33.
29. Goldstein BI, Bukstein OG. Comorbid substance use disorders among youth with
bipolar disorder: opportunities for early identification and prevention. J Clin Psychiatry.
2010 Mar;71(3):348-58.
30. Kessler RC, Nelson CB, McGonagle KA, Liu J, Swartz M, Blazer DG. Comorbidity of
DSM-III-R major depressive disorder in the general population: results from the US
National Comorbidity Survey. Br J Psychiatry Suppl. 1996 Jun;(30):17-30.
31. Brady KT, Sonne SC, Malcolm RJ, Randall CL, Dansky BS, Simpson K, et al.
Carbamazepine in the treatment of cocaine dependence: subtyping by affective
disorder. Exp Clin Psychopharmacol. 2002 Aug;10(3):276-85.
32. Campbell JL, Thomas HM, Gabrielli W, Liskow BI, Powell BJ. Impact of desipramine or
carbamazepine on patient retention in outpatient cocaine treatment: preliminary
findings. J Addict Dis. 1994;13(4):191-9.
33. Campbell J, Nickel EJ, Penick EC, Wallace D, Gabrielli WF, Rowe C, et al. Comparison
of desipramine or carbamazepine to placebo for crack cocaine-dependent patients. Am
J Addict Am Acad Psychiatr Alcohol Addict. 2003 Apr;12(2):122-36.
34. Albanese MJ, Clodfelter RC, Khantzian EJ. Divalproex sodium in substance abusers
with mood disorder. J Clin Psychiatry. 2000 Dec;61(12):916-21.
35. Brady KT, Sonne SC, Anton R, Ballenger JC. Valproate in the treatment of acute bipolar
affective episodes complicated by substance abuse: a pilot study. J Clin Psychiatry.
1995 Mar;56(3):118-21.
36. Azorin J-M, Bowden CL, Garay RP, Perugi G, Vieta E, Young AH. Possible new ways in
the pharmacological treatment of bipolar disorder and comorbid alcoholism.
Neuropsychiatr Dis Treat. 2010;6:37-46.
37. Perugi G, Toni C, Frare F, Ruffolo G, Moretti L, Torti C, et al. Effectiveness of adjunctive
gabapentin in resistant bipolar disorder: is it due to anxious-alcohol abuse comorbidity?
J Clin Psychopharmacol. 2002 Dec;22(6):584-91.
38. Rubio G, López-Muñoz F, Alamo C. Effects of lamotrigine in patients with bipolar
disorder and alcohol dependence. Bipolar Disord. 2006 Jun;8(3):289-93.
39. Brown ES, Nejtek VA, Perantie DC, Orsulak PJ, Bobadilla L. Lamotrigine in patients with
bipolar disorder and cocaine dependence. J Clin Psychiatry. 2003 Feb;64(2):197-201.
40. Brown ES, Perantie DC, Dhanani N, Beard L, Orsulak P, Rush AJ. Lamotrigine for
bipolar disorder and comorbid cocaine dependence: a replication and extension study.
J Affect Disord. 2006 Jul;93(1-3):219-22.
41. Guille C, Sachs G. Clinical outcome of adjunctive topiramate treatment in a sample of
refractory bipolar patients with comorbid conditions. Prog Neuropsychopharmacol
Biol Psychiatry. 2002 Oct;26(6):1035-9.
42. Huguelet P, Morand-Collomb S. Effect of topiramate augmentation on two patients
suffering from schizophrenia or bipolar disorder with comorbid alcohol abuse.
Pharmacol Res Off J Ital Pharmacol Soc. 2005 Nov;52(5):392-4.
43. Dorus W, Ostrow DG, Anton R, Cushman P, Collins JF, Schaefer M, et al. Lithium
treatment of depressed and nondepressed alcoholics. JAMA. 1989 Sep
22;262(12):1646-52.
44. Nunes EV, McGrath PJ, Wager S, Quitkin FM. Lithium treatment for cocaine abusers
with bipolar spectrum disorders. Am J Psychiatry. 1990 May;147(5):655-7.
45. Geller B, Cooper TB, Sun K, Zimerman B, Frazier J, Williams M, et al. Double-blind and
placebo-controlled study of lithium for adolescent bipolar disorders with secondary
substance dependency. J Am Acad Child Adolesc Psychiatry. 1998 Feb;37(2):171-8.
46. Kemp DE, Gao K, Ganocy SJ, Elhaj O, Bilali SR, Conroy C, et al. A 6-month, double-
blind, maintenance trial of lithium monotherapy versus the combination of lithium and
divalproex for rapid-cycling bipolar disorder and Co-occurring substance abuse or
dependence. J Clin Psychiatry. 2009 Jan;70(1):113-21.
47. Altintoprak AE, Zorlu N, Coskunol H, Akdeniz F, Kitapcioglu G. Effectiveness and
tolerability of mirtazapine and amitriptyline in alcoholic patients with co-morbid
depressive disorder: a randomized, double-blind study. Hum Psychopharmacol. 2008
Jun;23(4):313-9.
48. Mason BJ, Kocsis JH, Ritvo EC, Cutler RB. A double-blind, placebo-controlled trial of
desipramine for primary alcohol dependence stratified on the presence or absence of
major depression. JAMA. 1996 Mar 13;275(10):761-7.
49. Nunes EV, McGrath PJ, Quitkin FM, Stewart JP, Harrison W, Tricamo E, et al.
Imipramine treatment of alcoholism with comorbid depression. Am J Psychiatry. 1993
Jun;150(6):963-5.
50. McGrath PJ, Nunes EV, Stewart JW, Goldman D, Agosti V, Ocepek-Welikson K, et al.
Imipramine treatment of alcoholics with primary depression: A placebo-controlled
clinical trial. Arch Gen Psychiatry. 1996 Mar;53(3):232-40.
51. Nunes EV, Quitkin FM, Donovan SJ, Deliyannides D, Ocepek-Welikson K, Koenig T, et
al. Imipramine treatment of opiate-dependent patients with depressive disorders. A
placebo-controlled trial. Arch Gen Psychiatry. 1998 Feb;55(2):153-60.
52. Kleber HD, Weissman MM, Rounsaville BJ, Wilber CH, Prusoff BA, Riordan CE.
Imipramine as treatment for depression in addicts. Arch Gen Psychiatry. 1983
Jun;40(6):649-53.
53. Muhonen LH, Lahti J, Sinclair D, Lönnqvist J, Alho H. Treatment of alcohol dependence
in patients with co-morbid major depressive disorder--predictors for the outcomes with
memantine and escitalopram medication. Subst Abuse Treat Prev Policy. 2008;3:20.
54. Muhonen LH, Lönnqvist J, Juva K, Alho H. Double-blind, randomized comparison of
memantine and escitalopram for the treatment of major depressive disorder comorbid
with alcohol dependence. J Clin Psychiatry. 2008 Mar;69(3):392-9.
55. Kranzler HR, Burleson JA, Korner P, Del Boca FK, Bohn MJ, Brown J, et al. Placebo-
controlled trial of fluoxetine as an adjunct to relapse prevention in alcoholics. Am J
Psychiatry. 1995 Mar;152(3):391-7.
56. Torrens M, Fonseca F, Mateu G, Farré M. Efficacy of antidepressants in substance use
disorders with and without comorbid depression. A systematic review and meta-
analysis. Drug Alcohol Depend. 2005 Apr 4;78(1):1-22.
57. Brown ES, Bobadilla L, Nejtek VA, Perantie D, Dhillon H, Frol A. Open-label
nefazodone in patients with a major depressive episode and alcohol dependence. Prog
Neuropsychopharmacol Biol Psychiatry. 2003 Jun;27(4):681-5.
58. Pettinati HM, Oslin DW, Kampman KM, Dundon WD, Xie H, Gallis TL, et al. A double-
blind, placebo-controlled trial combining sertraline and naltrexone for treating co-
occurring depression and alcohol dependence. Am J Psychiatry. 2010 Jun;167(6):668-
75.
59. Yoon S-J, Pae C-U, Kim D-J, Namkoong K, Lee E, Oh D-Y, et al. Mirtazapine for patients
with alcohol dependence and comorbid depressive disorders: a multicentre, open
label study. Prog Neuropsychopharmacol Biol Psychiatry. 2006 Sep 30;30(7):1196-
201.
60. Mancino MJ, McGaugh J, Chopra MP, Guise JB, Cargile C, Williams DK, et al. Clinical
efficacy of sertraline alone and augmented with gabapentin in recently abstinent
cocaine-dependent patients with depressive symptoms. J Clin Psychopharmacol. 2014
Apr;34(2):234-9.
61. Raby WN, Rubin EA, Garawi F, Cheng W, Mason E, Sanfilippo L, et al. A randomized,
double-blind, placebo-controlled trial of venlafaxine for the treatment of depressed
cocaine-dependent patients. Am J Addict Am Acad Psychiatr Alcohol Addict. 2014
Feb;23(1):68-75.
62. Albanese MJ, Suh JJ. Risperidone in cocaine-dependent patients with comorbid
psychiatric disorders. J Psychiatr Pract. 2006 Sep;12(5):306-11.
63. Brown ES, Jeffress J, Liggin JDM, Garza M, Beard L. Switching outpatients with bipolar
or schizoaffective disorders and substance abuse from their current antipsychotic to
aripiprazole. J Clin Psychiatry. 2005 Jun;66(6):756-60.
64. Longoria J, Brown ES, Perantie DC, Bobadilla L, Nejtek VA. Quetiapine for alcohol use
and craving in bipolar disorder. J Clin Psychopharmacol. 2004 Feb;24(1):101-2.
91. Lai HMX, Cleary M, Sitharthan T, Hunt GE. Prevalence of comorbid substance use,
anxiety and mood disorders in epidemiological surveys, 1990-2014: A systematic
review and meta-analysis. Drug Alcohol Depend. 2015 Sep 1;154:1-13.
92. McHugh RK. Treatment of co-occurring anxiety disorders and substance use
disorders. Harv Rev Psychiatry. 2015 Apr;23(2):99-111.
93. Randall CL, Johnson MR, Thevos AK, Sonne SC, Thomas SE, Willard SL, et al.
Paroxetine for social anxiety and alcohol use in dual-diagnosed patients. Depress
Anxiety. 2001;14(4):255-62.
94. Thomas SE, Randall PK, Book SW, Randall CL. A complex relationship between co-
occurring social anxiety and alcohol use disorders: what effect does treating social
anxiety have on drinking? Alcohol Clin Exp Res. 2008 Jan;32(1):77-84.
95. Brady KT, Sonne S, Anton RF, Randall CL, Back SE, Simpson K. Sertraline in the
treatment of co-occurring alcohol dependence and posttraumatic stress disorder.
Alcohol Clin Exp Res. 2005 Mar;29(3):395-401.
96. Tollefson GD, Montague-Clouse J, Tollefson SL. Treatment of comorbid generalized
anxiety in a recently detoxified alcoholic population with a selective serotonergic
drug (buspirone). J Clin Psychopharmacol. 1992 Feb;12(1):19-26.
97. Malcolm R, Anton RF, Randall CL, Johnston A, Brady K, Thevos A. A placebo-
controlled trial of buspirone in anxious inpatient alcoholics. Alcohol Clin Exp Res.
1992 Dec;16(6):1007-13.
98. McRae AL, Sonne SC, Brady KT, Durkalski V, Palesch Y. A randomized, placebo-
controlled trial of buspirone for the treatment of anxiety in opioid-dependent
individuals. Am J Addict Am Acad Psychiatr Alcohol Addict. 2004 Feb;13(1):53-63.
99. Busto UE, Romach MK, Sellers EM. Multiple drug use and psychiatric comorbidity in
patients admitted to the hospital with severe benzodiazepine dependence. J Clin
Psychopharmacol. 1996 Feb;16(1):51-7.
100. Mueller TI, Goldenberg IM, Gordon AL, Keller MB, Warshaw MG. Benzodiazepine
use in anxiety disordered patients with and without a history of alcoholism. J Clin
Psychiatry. 1996 Feb;57(2):83-9.
101. Mueller TI, Pagano ME, Rodriguez BF, Bruce SE, Stout RL, Keller MB. Long-term use of
benzodiazepines in participants with comorbid anxiety and alcohol use disorders.
Alcohol Clin Exp Res. 2005 Aug;29(8):1411-8.
102. Martinsen EW, Olsen T, Tønset E, Nyland KE, Aarre TF. Cognitive-behavioural group
therapy for panic disorder in the general clinical setting: a naturalistic study with 1-
year follow-up. J Clin Psychiatry. 1998 Aug;59(8):437-42; quiz 443.
103. Bowen RC, D'Arcy C, Keegan D, Senthilselvan A. A controlled trial of cognitive
behavioural treatment of panic in alcoholic inpatients with comorbid panic disorder.
Addict Behav. 2000 Aug;25(4):593-7.
104. Schadé A, Marquenie LA, van Balkom AJLM, Koeter MWJ, de Beurs E, van den Brink
W, et al. The effectiveness of anxiety treatment on alcohol-dependent patients with a
comorbid phobic disorder: a randomized controlled trial. Alcohol Clin Exp Res. 2005
May;29(5):794-800.
105. Foa EB, Yusko DA, McLean CP, Suvak MK, Bux DA, Oslin D, et al. Concurrent
naltrexone and prolonged exposure therapy for patients with comorbid alcohol
dependence and PTSD: a randomized clinical trial. JAMA. 2013 Aug 7;310(5):488-95.
106. McEvoy PM, Shand F. The effect of comorbid substance use disorders on treatment
outcome for anxiety disorders. J Anxiety Disord. 2008 Aug;22(6):1087-98.
107. Kaysen D, Schumm J, Pedersen ER, Seim RW, Bedard-Gilligan M, Chard K. Cognitive
processing therapy for veterans with comorbid PTSD and alcohol use disorders.
Addict Behav. 2014 Feb;39(2):420-7.
108. Ciraulo DA, Barlow DH, Gulliver SB, Farchione T, Morissette SB, Kamholz BW, et al.
The effects of venlafaxine and cognitive behavioural therapy alone and combined in
the treatment of co-morbid alcohol use-anxiety disorders. Behav Res Ther. 2013
Nov;51(11):729-35.
109. Kushner MG, Sletten S, Donahue C, Thuras P, Maurer E, Schneider A, et al. Cognitive-
behavioural therapy for panic disorder in patients being treated for alcohol
dependence: Moderating effects of alcohol outcome expectancies. Addict Behav.
2009;34(6-7):554-60.
110. Kushner MG, Maurer EW, Thuras P, Donahue C, Frye B, Menary KR, et al. Hybrid
cognitive behavioural therapy versus relaxation training for co-occurring anxiety and
alcohol disorder: a randomized clinical trial. J Consult Clin Psychol. 2013
Jun;81(3):429-42.
111. Najavits LM, Weiss RD, Shaw SR, Muenz LR. "Seeking safety": outcome of a new
cognitive-behavioural psychotherapy for women with posttraumatic stress disorder
and substance dependence. J Trauma Stress. 1998 Jul;11(3):437-56.
112. McGovern MP, Lambert-Harris C, Acquilano S, Xie H, Alterman AI, Weiss RD. A
cognitive behavioural therapy for co-occurring substance use and posttraumatic stress
disorders. Addict Behav. 2009 Oct;34(10):892-7.
113. Brady KT, Dansky BS, Back SE, Foa EB, Carroll KM. Exposure therapy in the treatment
of PTSD among cocaine-dependent individuals: preliminary findings. J Subst Abuse
Treat. 2001 Jul;21(1):47-54.
114. Skodol AE, Oldham JM, Gallaher PE. Axis II Comorbidity of Substance Use Disorders
Among Patients Referred for Treatment of Personality Disorders. Am J Psychiatry
[Internet]. 1999 May 1 [cited 2015 Sep 14]; Available from:
http://ajp.psychiatryonline.org/doi/10.1176/ajp.156.5.733
115. Gibbon S, Duggan C, Stoffers J, Huband N, Völlm BA, Ferriter M, et al. Psychological